Yamaha RX-V1071 de handleiding

Categorie
AV-ontvangers
Type
de handleiding
En 1
Owner’s Manual
Be sure to read “Safety Brochure” (supplied booklet) before using this unit.
AV Receiver
English for Canada, Europe and Oceania
En 2
CONTENTS
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
What you can do with this unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Part names and functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Front display (indicators) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10
Rear panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
General setup procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
1 Connecting speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Basic speaker configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
Advanced speaker configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Input/output jacks and cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
2 Connecting a TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
3 Connecting playback devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Connecting video devices (BD/DVD players, etc.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Connecting audio devices (CD players, etc.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Connecting to the jacks on the front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
4 Connecting the FM/AM antennas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
5 Connecting to the network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
6 Connecting other devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Connecting video/audio recording devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
Connecting a device with analog multi-channel output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
Connecting a device compatible with SCENE link playback (remote connection) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
Connecting a device compatible with the trigger function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
7 Connecting the power cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
8 Selecting an on-screen menu language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
9 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) . . . . . . . . . 41
Measuring at one listening position (single measure) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Checking the measurement results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Reloading the previous YPAO results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Error messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Warning messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Basic playback procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Selecting an HDMI output jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Selecting the input source and favorite settings at once (SCENE) . . 49
Configuring scene assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Selecting the sound mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Enjoying sound field effects (CINEMA DSP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Enjoying unprocessed playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (Pure Direct) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Enjoying compressed music with enhanced sound (Compressed Music Enhancer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Enjoying surround sound with headphones (SILENT CINEMA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Listening to FM/AM radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Selecting a frequency for reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Registering favorite radio stations (preset) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Radio Data System tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Operating the radio on the TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Playing back iPod music/videos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Connecting an iPod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Playback of iPod contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Playing back music via Bluetooth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
FEATURES
SETUP
PLAYBACK
En 3
Connecting a Bluetooth receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
Pairing Bluetooth components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
Establishing a wireless connection and playing back . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Playing back music stored on a USB storage device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Connecting a USB storage device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Playback of USB storage device contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Playing back music stored on PCs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Media sharing setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Playback of PC music contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Listening to Internet radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Preparing for Zone2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Controlling Zone2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
Useful functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Registering favorite items (shortcut) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
Controlling this unit from the web browser (web control) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
Viewing the current status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83
Configuring settings in accordance with a playback source (Option menu)
. . . 84
Option menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
Configuring input sources (Input menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Input menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Scene menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu)
. . . . 92
Sound Program menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
Configuring various functions (Setup menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Setup menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
Speaker (Manual Setup) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Multi Zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Viewing information about this unit (Information menu) . . . . . . . . 110
Types of information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) . . . . . 112
ADVANCED SETUP menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Changing the speaker impedance setting (SPEAKER IMP.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Turning on/off the remote control sensor (REMOTE SENSOR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Selecting the remote control ID (REMOTE CON AMP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Switching the video signal type (TV FORMAT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Removing the limitation on HDMI video output (MONITOR CHECK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Backing up/recovering the settings (RECOV./BACKUP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Restoring the default settings (INITIALIZE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Updating the firmware (FIRM UPDATE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Checking the firmware version (VERSION) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Controlling external devices with the remote control . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Setting the remote control code for a TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Setting the remote control codes for playback devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Programming from other remote controls (learning) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Resetting remote control codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Updating the firmware of this unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
CONFIGURATIONS
En 4
Frequently asked questions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Power and system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
FM/AM radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
USB and network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Error indications on the front display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Audio information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Video information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Video signal flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Information on HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
HDMI Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
HDMI signal compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Reference diagram (rear panel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Trademarks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
APPENDIX
En 5
Accessories
Check that the following accessories are supplied with this product.
Remote control Batteries (AAA, R03, UM-4) (x 2)
YPAO microphone Power cable
Insert into the remote control in the correct polarity (+/-)
AM antenna FM antenna
Easy Setup Guide CD-ROM (Owner’s Manual)
Safety Brochure
*The figure of the supplied power cable
differs depending on regions.
*The figure of the supplied FM antenna
differs depending on regions.
Operating range of the remote control
Aim the remote control directly at the remote control sensor on this unit during operation.
Some features are not available in certain regions.
Design and specifications are subject to change in part as a result of improvements, etc. In case of
differences between the manual and product, the product has priority.
This manual mainly explains operations using the supplied remote control.
This manual describes both the “iPod” and “iPhone” as the “iPod”. “iPod” means both “iPod” and
“iPhone” unless the explanation describes exceptions.
” indicates the cautions concerning operations or setup of the unit.
” indicates the explanations for better use.
30° 30°
Within 6 m
En 6
FEATURES
What you can do with this unit
Supports 2 to 7 channel (plus front presence)
speaker system and up to 2 subwoofer
connections. Allows you to enjoy favorite
acoustic spaces in various styles.
Plus, bi-amp connections, channel
expansion (with external power-amp)
and multi-zone configurations to
enhance your system
p.19
Automatically optimizing the speaker
settings to suit your room (YPAO)
p.41
Sound field reproductions like actual
movie theaters and concert halls from
stereo or multi-channel audio sources
(CINEMA DSP)
p.52
Enjoying compressed music with
enhanced sound (Compressed Music
Enhancer)
p.55
Ready for any kind of contents
iPod
p.60
Network
p.70 to p.73
USB
p.67
Bluetooth
p.65
*Requires optional Bluetooth receiver for playback via Bluetooth
Operating external
devices with the supplied
remote control
p.115
Operating the TV, AV
receiver and BD/DVD
player in combination
(HDMI Control)
p.131
Selecting the input source
and favorite settings at once
(SCENE)
p.49
AV receiver (this unit)
Speakers
USB device
Network contents
via Bluetooth
iPod
BD/DVD player
HDMI Control
Audio/Video
Remote control
of this unit
TV remote control
Audio
Audio
HDMI Control
Audio
Video
TV
En 7
Full of useful functions!
Connecting various devices (p.31)
A number of HDMI jacks and various input/output jacks
on this unit allow you to connect video devices such as
BD/DVD players, audio devices such as CD players,
game consoles and camcorders, and so on.
Playing back TV audio in surround sound
with a single HDMI cable connection
(Audio Return Channel: ARC) (p.25)
When using a TV that supports ARC, you only need a
single HDMI cable to connect the TV and this unit to
output video to the TV, input audio from the TV, and
transmit HDMI Control signals.
Creating stereoscopic sound fields (p.54)
Connection of front presence speakers enables to
create a natural stereoscopic sound field in your room
(CINEMA DSP 3D). Even when no front presence
speakers are connected, this unit automatically creates
Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) to produce 3D surround
sound.
Listening to FM/AM radio (p.56)
This unit is equipped with the built-in FM/AM tuner.
You can register favorite radio stations as presets.
Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (p.55)
When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, this unit plays
back the selected source with the least circuitry. It
allows you to enjoy Hi-Fi sound quality.
Easy operation with a TV screen
You can navigate the various contents (iPod, USB,
network, etc.), view the information, or configure the
settings using the on-screen menu.
At time like this
I want to connect a playback device using HDMI for video
and non-HDMI for audio...
Use “Audio Select” in the “Option” menu to specify the type
of an audio input jack to be used for the corresponding
input source (p.86).
Video and audio are not synchronized...
Use “Lipsync” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the delay
between video and audio output (p.101).
I want to hear audio from the TV speakers...
Use “Audio Output” in the “Setup” menu to select whether
to output audio signals through this unit and the TV (p.104).
I want to this unit to be turned off automatically when not in
use...
Use “Auto Power Down” in the “Setup” menu to set the
amount of time for auto-standby (p.107).
I want to change the on-screen menu language...
Use “Language” in the “Setup” menu to select a language
from English, Japanese, French, German, Spanish and
Russian (p.110).
I want to update the firmware...
Use “UPDATE” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to update
the firmware of this unit (p.114). If this unit is connected to
the Internet, the corresponding message will be displayed
on the TV when a newer firmware is available (p.119).
There are many other settings to customize this unit.
For details, see the following pages.
Input settings (p.87)
Scene settings (p.90)
Sound program and surround decoder settings (p.93)
Various function settings (p.96)
Information view (audio signal, video signal, etc.) (p.111)
System settings (p.112)
Turntable
BD/DVD
player
Game
console
Camcorder
TV
CD player
HDMI Control
TV audio
Video from
external device
En 8
Front panel
1 MAIN ZONE
Turns on/off (standby) this unit.
2 Standby indicator
Lights up when this unit is in standby mode under any of the
following conditions.
- HDMI Control is enabled (p.131)
- The standby through function is enabled (p.104)
- The network standby function is enabled (p.105)
- The iPod is being charged (p.88)
- An iPod wireless system is connected (p.61)
3 Front display
Displays information (p.10).
4 Remote control sensor
Receives remote control signals (p.5).
5 PURE DIRECT
Enables/disables Pure Direct (p.55).
6 INPUT
Selects an input source.
7 Front panel door
For protecting controls and jacks (p.9).
8 VOLUME
Adjusts the volume.
Part names and functions
SCENE
MULTI ZONE
HDMI IN
VIDEO AUX
TONE/BALANCEOPTIONON SCREEN
DISPLAYRETURN
STRAIGHT
1
ENTER
ZONE 2
2 3 4
ZONE CONTROL
INFO MEMORY
YPAO MIC
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
USB
iPod/iPhone
PROGRAM FM AM TUNING/CH
PRESET
R OPTICALL AUDIOVIDEOS VIDEO
PURE DIRECT
VOLUMEINPUT
MAIN ZONE
NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V1071
5321
6 7 8
4
Opening the front panel door
To use controls or jacks behind the front panel door, gently
press the bottom of the door to open it. Keep the door closed
when not using controls or jacks behind the front panel door.
En 9
Inside of the front panel cover
9 ON SCREEN
Displays the on-screen menu on the TV.
0 Menu operation keys
Cursor keys Select a menu or parameter.
ENTER Confirms a selected item.
RETURN Returns to the previous screen.
A OPTION
Displays the option menu (p.84).
B DISPLAY
Display the status information on the TV (p.83).
C TONE/BALANCE
Adjusts the high-frequency range and low-frequency range
of sounds output from speakers and headphones (p.85).
Adjusts the right/left channel volume balance for Zone2
(p.79).
D STRAIGHT
Enables/disables the straight decode mode (p.54).
E PROGRAM
Selects a sound program or a surround decoder (p.51).
F SCENE
Selects the registered input source, sound program, HDMI
output and various settings at once. Additionally, you can
turn on this unit when it is in standby mode (p.49).
G MULTI ZONE
ZONE 2 Enables/disables the audio output to
Zone2 (p.78).
ZONE CONTROL Switches the zones (main or Zone2) to
operate with the front panel controllers
(p.78).
H INFO
Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.83).
I MEMORY
Registers FM/AM radio stations as preset stations (p.56).
Registers USB/network contents as shortcuts (p.80).
J FM/AM
Switches between FM and AM (p.56).
K PRESET
Selects a preset FM/AM radio station (p.57).
Selects a USB/network content from shortcuts (p.80).
L TUNING/CH
Selects the radio frequency (p.56).
M USB jack
For connecting a USB storage device (p.67) or an iPod via
USB (p.60).
N YPAO MIC jack
For connecting the supplied YPAO microphone (p.41).
O PHONES jack
For connecting headphones.
P VIDEO AUX jacks
For connecting camcorders, game consoles, etc (p.34).
SCENE
MULTI ZONE
HDMI IN
VIDEO AUX
TONE/BALANCEOPTIONON SCREEN
DISPLAYRETURN
STRAIGHT
1
ENTER
ZONE 2
2 3 4
ZONE CONTROL
INFO MEMORY
YPAO MIC
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
USB
iPod/iPhone
PROGRAM FM AM TUNING/CH
PRESET
R OPTICALL AUDIOVIDEOS VIDEO
9 0 A CB D E F H I KJ L
M N O P
G
En 10
Front display (indicators)
1 HDMI
Lights up during normal HDMI communication.
IN
Lights up when HDMI signals are being input.
OUT1/OUT2
Indicate the HDMI OUT jacks currently outputting an HDMI
signal.
2 STEREO
Lights up when this unit is receiving a stereo FM radio signal.
TUNED
Lights up when this unit is receiving an FM/AM radio station
signal.
3 ZONE 2
Lights up when the audio output to Zone2 is enabled.
4 SLEEP
Lights up when the sleep timer is on.
5 PARTY
Lights up when this unit is in the party mode.
6 Information display
Displays the current status (input name, sound mode name,
etc). You can switch the information by pressing INFO (p.83).
7 MUTE
Flashes when audio is muted.
8 Volume indicator
Indicates the current volume.
9 ADAPTIVE DRC
Lights up when Adaptive DRC (p.85) is working.
0 ENHANCER
Lights up when Compressed Music Enhancer (p.55) is
working.
A CINEMA DSP
Lights up when CINEMA DSP (p.52) is working.
CINEMA DSP
Lights up when CINEMA DSP 3D (p.54) is working.
B Cursor indicators
Indicate the remote control cursor keys currently operational.
C Speaker indicators
Indicate speaker terminals from which signals are output.
Front speaker (L)
Front speaker (R)
Center speaker
Surround speaker (L)
Surround speaker (R)
Surround back speaker (L)
Surround back speaker (R)
Surround back speaker
Front presence speaker (L)
Front presence speaker (R)
Subwoofer
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBL SBRSB
SL
SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
TUNED PARTY
2
987
A0 BCB
1 4 53
6
3
En 11
Rear panel
1 PHONO jacks
For connecting a turntable (p.33).
2 DOCK jack
For connecting an optional Yamaha products such as iPod
dock (p.61), iPod wireless system (p.61), and Bluetooth
receiver (p.65).
3 AV1~4 jacks
For connecting video/audio playback devices to input video/
audio signals (p.31).
4 NETWORK jack
For connecting to the network (p.36).
5 AV OUT jacks
For outputting video/audio to a recording device (VCR, tape
deck, etc.) (p.37).
6 MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT
(composite video/S-video) jacks
For connecting a TV compatible with composite video or S-
video to output video signals (p.29).
For connecting a Zone2 video monitor (p.76).
7 HDMI OUT 1~2 jacks
For connecting HDMI-compatible TVs to output video/audio
signals (p.25). When using ARC, TV audio signal is input
through the HDMI OUT 1 jack.
8 COMPONENT VIDEO (AV1~4) jacks
For connecting video playback devices compatible with
component video to input video signals (p.32).
9 HDMI (AV1~7) jacks
For connecting HDMI-compatible playback devices to input
video/audio signals (p.31).
0 MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT
(component video) jacks
For connecting a TV compatible with component video to
output video signals (p.29).
For connecting a Zone2 video monitor (p.76).
A REMOTE IN/OUT jacks
For connecting a Yamaha product compatible with SCENE
link playback (p.38), or connecting an infrared signal
receiver/emitter to operate devices including this unit from
another room (p.77).
B TRIGGER OUT 1~2 jacks
For connecting devices that support the trigger function
(p.38).
C RS-232C terminal
This is a control expansion terminal for custom installation.
Consult your dealer for details.
D ANTENNA jacks
For connecting FM and AM antennas (p.35).
E AUDIO1~4 jacks
For connecting audio playback devices to input audio
signals (p.33).
F MULTI CH INPUT jacks
For connecting a device that supports multi-channel output
to input audio signals (p.37).
G ZONE OUT jacks
For connecting an external amplifier used in Zone2 to output
audio (p.76).
H PRE OUT jacks
For connecting subwoofers with built-in amplifier (p.18) or an
external power amplifier (p.23).
I SPEAKERS terminals
For connecting speakers (p.14).
J AC IN
For connecting the supplied power cable (p.39).
+12V 0.1A MAX.
AC IN
TRIGGER
OUT
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
YP
B
P
R
OPTICAL
AV O UT
R
L
HDMI OUT
ARC
1
1
2
2
HDMI
(1 BD/DVD)
MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT
IN OUT
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV 7
1
2
REMOTE
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUDIO 4
MULTI CH INPUT
ZONE OUT
AUDIO 3AUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
ZONE 2FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONTSURROUND BACKSURROUND
BI–AMP
ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/
R
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
L R R RL L L
SINGLE
RS-232C
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTER
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
GND
EXTRA SP
YP
B
P
R
YP
B
P
R
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
AV 1
AV 3
COMPONENT VIDEO
A
AV 2
B
C
AV 4
D
42 C153 6 8 9 0 A B
D E F G H I J
7
En 12
Remote control
1 Remote control signal transmitter
Transmits infrared signals.
2 MAIN/ZONE2
Switches the zones (main or Zone2) to operate with the
remote control (p.78).
3 SOURCE
Turns on/off an external device.
SOURCE/RECEIVER
Switches the devices (this unit or external device) to operate
with the remote control (p.116). You can operate this unit
when this key lights up in orange, and an external device
when this key lights up in green.
RECEIVER
Turns on/off (standby) this unit.
4 Input selection keys
Select an input source to play back.
AV1~7 AV1~7 jacks
V-AUX VIDEO AUX jacks (on the front panel)
AUDIO1~4 AUDIO1~4 jacks
MULTI MULTI CH INPUT jacks
PHONO PHONO jacks
DOCK DOCK jack
TUNER FM/AM radio
NET NETWORK jack (press repeatedly to select a
desired network source)
USB USB jack (on the front panel)
5 Radio keys
Operate the FM/AM radio when “TUNER” is selected as the
input source.
FM Switches to FM radio.
AM Switches to AM radio.
MEMORY Registers FM/AM radio stations as presets.
PRESET Selects a preset station.
TUNING Selects the radio frequency.
6 INFO
Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.83).
7 SLEEP
Switches this unit to standby mode automatically after a
specified period of time has elapsed (sleep timer). Press
repeatedly to set the time (120 min, 90 min, 60 min, 30 min, off).
8 PARTY
Turns on/off the party mode (p.79).
9 SCENE
Selects the assigned input source, sound program, HDMI
output and various settings at once. Additionally, you can
turn on this unit when it is in standby mode (p.49).
0 ON SCREEN
Displays the on-screen menu on the TV.
A Menu operation keys
Cursor keys Select a menu or a parameter.
ENTER Confirms a selected item.
RETURN Returns to the previous screen.
B MODE
Switches between stereo and monaural for FM radio reception.
Switches the iPod operation modes (p.63).
C Numeric keys
Enter numerical values such as radio frequencies.
D TV operation keys
Operate TV input, TV volume, etc (p.115).
E CODE SET
Registers remote control codes of external devices on the
remote control (p.115).
F Sound mode keys
Select a sound mode (p.51).
G OPTION
Displays the option menu (p.84).
H VOLUME
Adjusts the volume.
I DISPLAY
Displays the status information on the TV (p.83).
J MUTE
Mutes the audio output.
K External device operation keys
Operate playback and menu display etc. for external
devices (p.116).
L HDMI OUT
Selects HDMI OUT jacks to be used for video/audio output
(p.48).
To operate external devices with the remote control, register a
remote control code for each device in advance (p.115).
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PART Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 2 3 4
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
123 4
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
123 4
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
F
H
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
B
A
C
D
J
I
G
E
K
L
En 13
SETUP
Now all the preparations are complete. Enjoy playing movies, music, radio, etc. with this unit!
General setup procedure
1 Connecting speakers (p.14)
Basic speaker configuration (p.15)
Select the speaker layout and connect the speakers to this unit.
Advanced speaker configuration (p.19)
Apply bi-amp connections, channel expansion (using an external power amplifier) or multi-zone configurations
to enhance the system.
2 Connecting a TV (p.25)
Connect a TV to this unit.
3 Connecting playback devices (p.31)
Connect video devices (BD/DVD players, etc.) and audio devices (CD players, etc.) to this unit.
4 Connecting the FM/AM antennas (p.35)
Connect the supplied FM/AM antennas to this unit.
5 Connecting to the network (p.36)
Connect this unit to the network.
6 Connecting other devices (p.37)
Connect external devices such as recording devices.
7 Connecting the power cable (p.39)
After all the connections are complete, plug in the power cable.
8
Selecting an on-screen menu language (p.40)
Select a desired on-screen menu language (default: English).
9
Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) (p.41)
Optimize the speaker settings such as volume balance and acoustic parameters to suit your room (YPAO).
En 14
This unit has 7 built-in amplifiers. You can connect 2 to 9 speakers and up to 2 subwoofers (with built-in amplifier) to create the favorite acoustic space in your room.
You can also apply bi-amp connections, channel expansion (using an external power amplifier) or multi-zone configurations to enhance your system (p.19).
Functions of each speaker
We recommend using front presence speakers to have a full effect of the stereoscopic sound fields.
However, this unit creates Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center and surround speakers
to produce stereoscopic sound fields even when no front presence speakers are connected (p.54).
Use “Ideal speaker layout” (diagram on the right) as reference. You do not need to exactly adjust the
speaker layout to this diagram since the YPAO function of this unit will automatically optimize the speaker
settings (distance, etc.) to suit the speaker layout.
When using only one surround back speaker, place it straight behind the listening position (middle of “SBL
and “SBR” in the diagram).
Ideal speaker layout
1 Connecting speakers
Caution
This unit is configured for 8-ohm speakers at the factory. When connecting 6-ohm speakers, set the speaker impedance of this unit to “6 Ω MIN”. In this case, you can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers. For
details, see “Setting the speaker impedance” (p.16).
Speaker type Abbr. Function
Front (L)
Produce front right/left channel sounds (stereo sounds).
Front (R)
Center Produces center channel sounds (dialogs, vocals, etc).
Surround (L) Produce surround right/left channel sounds. Surround speakers also
produce surround back channel sounds when no surround back
speakers are connected.
Surround (R)
Surround
back (L)
Produce surround back right/left channel sounds. When no surround
back speakers are connected, Surround back channel sounds are
produced from the surround speakers.
Surround
back (R)
Front
presence (L)
Produce CINEMA DSP effect sounds. In combination with CINEMA DSP
3D (p.54), the front presence speakers create a natural stereoscopic
sound field in your room.
Front
presence (R)
Subwoofer
Produces LFE (low-frequency effect) channel sounds and reinforces
bass parts of other channels.
This channel is counted as “0.1”. You can connect 2 subwoofers (with
built-in amplifier) to this unit and place them on the right/left (or front/
rear) sides of the room.
30 cm or more
1.8 m
0.5 to 1 m
1.8 m
0.5 to 1 m
10°~30°10°~30°
1
Speaker connections
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
En 15
Basic speaker configuration
Placing speakers in your room
Depending on the number of speakers, place the speakers and subwoofer (with built-in amplifier) in your room. This section describes the representative speaker layout examples.
7.1+2 channel system
(using both surround back and front presence speakers)
This speaker system brings out the full performance of this unit and allows you to enjoy
a natural stereoscopic sound field with any contents.
The surround back speakers and front presence speakers do not produce sounds simultaneously. This unit
automatically switches the speakers to be used depending on a selected CINEMA DSP (p.52).
7.1 channel system
(using front presence speakers)
This speaker system uses the front presence speakers to produce a highly-natural
stereoscopic sound field, and is suited for enjoying 5.1-channel contents.
7.1 channel system (using surround back speakers)
This speaker system creates Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center and
surround speakers to produce a stereoscopic sound field, and also allows you to enjoy
extended surround sounds using the surround back speakers.
1
Speaker connections
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
En 16
5.1 channel system
This speaker system creates Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center and
surround speakers to produce a stereoscopic sound field, and is suited for enjoying
5.1-channel contents.
2.1 channel system
Even when no surround speakers are connected, this unit creates the virtual surround
speakers using the front speakers to allow you to enjoy multi-channel surround sound
(Virtual CINEMA DSP).
Add the center speaker to configure a 3.1-channel system.
Setting the speaker impedance
This unit is configured for 8-ohm speakers at the factory. When connecting 6-ohm
speakers, set the speaker impedance to “6 Ω MIN”. In this case, you can also use
4-ohm speakers as the front speakers.
1
Before connecting speakers, connect the supplied power cable to
this unit and then to an AC wall outlet.
2
While holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press MAIN ZONE .
3
Check that “SPEAKER IMP.” is displayed on the front display.
4
Press STRAIGHT to select “6 Ω MIN”.
5
Press MAIN ZONE to set this unit to standby mode and remove the
power cable from the AC wall outlet.
Now you are ready to connect the speakers.
MAIN ZONE
STRAIGHT
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSB PR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
8MIN
SPEAKERIMP.
SPIMP.-
1
Speaker connections
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
En 17
Connecting speakers
Connect the speakers placed in your room to this unit.
Speakers to be connected
If you have 7 speakers, use two of them as surround back speakers (*1) or front
presence speakers (*2).
You can also connect up to 2 subwoofers (with built-in amplifier) to this unit.
To use an external power amplifier (Hi-Fi amplifier, etc.) to enhance speaker output, see “Connecting an
external power amplifier” (p.23).
Cables necessary for connection (commercially available)
Speaker cables (x the number of speakers)
Audio pin cable (2 for connecting 2 subwoofers)
Connection diagram
Refer to the following diagram and connect the speakers to this unit.
When using only one surround back speaker, connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side).
Caution
Remove the power cable of this unit from an AC wall outlet and turn off the subwoofer before
connecting the speakers.
Be careful that the core of the speaker cable does not touch anything or come into contact with the
metal areas of this unit. This may damage this unit or the speakers. If the speaker cables short circuit,
“CHECK SP WIRES” will appear on the front display when this unit is turned on.
Room Speaker type Abbr.
Speaker system
(the number of channels)
Power Amp
Assign
(p.98)
7+2 7 5 2
Main zone
Front (L) ●●●●
Basic (default)
Front (R) ●●●●
Center ●●●
Surround (L) ●●●
Surround (R) ●●●
Surround
back (L)
{*1
Surround
back (R)
{*1
Front
presence (L)
{*2
Front
presence (R)
{*2
+
+
1
2
MULTI CH INPUT
ZONE OUT
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
ZONE 2
URROUND SUR. BACK
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONTSURROUND BACKSURROUND
BI–AMP
ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/
R L R R RL L L
SINGLE
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTER
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
EXTRA SP
This unit (rear)
1
Speaker connections
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
En 18
Connecting speaker cables
Speaker cables have two wires. One is for connecting the negative (-) terminal of the unit
and the speaker, and the other is for the positive (+) terminal. If the wires are colored to
prevent confusion, connect the black wire to the negative and the other wire to the positive.
a Remove approximately 10 mm of insulation from the ends of the speaker cable, and twist
the bare wires of the cable together firmly.
b Loosen the speaker terminal.
c Insert the bare wires of the cable into the gap on the side (upper right or bottom left) of the
terminal.
d Tighten the terminal.
Using a banana plug
(Canada, China and Australia models only)
a Tighten the speaker terminal.
b Insert a banana plug into the end of the terminal.
Connecting the subwoofer
Use an audio pin cable to connect the subwoofer.
FRONT
-
+
aa
c
c
b
b
d
d
+ (red)
– (black)
FRONT
+
aa
b
b
Banana plug
(
SINGLE
)
SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT
CENTER
CENTER
SUR. BACKSURRUND
1
2
FRONT
Audio pin cable
1
Speaker connections
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
En 19
Advanced speaker configuration
In addition to the basic speaker configuration (p.15), this unit also allows you to apply the following speaker configurations to enhance your system.
Using the four internal
amplifiers for front speakers to
have more high-quality sounds
(Example) (Example) (Example)
Bi-amp
connection
Combining with an external
power amplifier (Hi-Fi
amplifier, etc.) to build an
extended system
Using the excess internal
amplifiers for stereo speakers
in another room
External power
amplifier
Main zone
Zone2
Bi-amp connection Power-amp channel expansion Multi-zone configuration
1
Speaker connections
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
En 20
Available speaker configurations
When applying one of these configurations, you need to configure the “Power Amp Assign” setting (p.98) in
the “Setup” menu.
5ch BI-AMP
Main zone
Multi-zone
Power Amp Assign
(p.98)
Page
Output
channel
(max)
Bi-amp
External
power
amplifier
(required)
5 { 5ch BI-AMP 20
7 {
Surround
back
5ch BI-AMP +SB 21
7 +1 (Zone2) 7ch +1ZONE 21
Bi-amp
Speaker Connect to
FRONT and EXTRA SP (bi-amp connection)
CENTER
SURROUND
(not used)
(not used)
SUBWOOFER 1~2
1
Speaker connections
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
En 21
5ch BI-AMP +SB 7ch +1ZONE
Bi-amp
via external
amp
Speaker Connect to
FRONT and EXTRA SP (bi-amp connection)
CENTER
SURROUND
SUR.BACK (PRE OUT) via external power amplifier
(not used)
SUBWOOFER 1~2
Main zone
Zone2
When Zone2 output is enabled (p.78), the surround back speakers in the main zone do not output sound.
Speaker Connect to
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
(not used)
SUBWOOFER 1~2
Zone2 speakers EXTRA SP
1
Speaker connections
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
En 22
Connecting front speakers that support bi-amp connections
When using front speakers that support bi-amp connections, connect them to the
FRONT jacks and EXTRA SP jacks.
To enable the bi-amp function, configure the “Power Amp Assign” setting (p.98) in the
“Setup” menu after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet.
Connecting Zone2 speakers
When using Zone2 speakers, connect them to the EXTRA SP jacks.
To utilize the EXTRA SP jacks for Zone2 speakers, configure the “Power Amp Assign”
setting (p.98) in the “Setup” menu after connecting the power cable to an AC wall
outlet.
You can also connect Zone2 speakers using an external amplifier (p.76).
Caution
Before making bi-amp connections, remove any brackets or cables that connect a woofer with a
tweeter. Refer to the instruction manual of the speakers for details. When not making bi-amp
connections, make sure that the brackets or cables are connected before connecting the speaker
cables.
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONTSURROUND BACKSURROUND
BI–AMP
ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/
R L R R RL L L
SINGLE
EXTRA SP
This unit (rear)
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONTSURROUND BACKSURROUND
BI–AMP
ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/
R L R R RL L L
SINGLE
EXTRA SP
This unit (rear)
Main zone
Zone2
1
Speaker connections
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
En 23
Connecting an external power amplifier
When using an external power amplifier to enhance speaker output, connect the input
jacks of the power amplifier to the PRE OUT jacks of this unit. The same channel signals
are output from the PRE OUT jacks as from their corresponding SPEAKERS terminals.
1 FRONT jacks
Output front channel sounds.
2 SURROUND jacks
Output surround channel sounds.
3 SUR. BACK jacks
Output surround back channel sounds. When using only one external amplifier for the surround
back channel, connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side).
4 CENTER jack
Outputs center channel sounds.
(Example)
Connecting front speakers via an external power amplifier
About external power amplifiers
We recommend using power amplifiers that meet the following conditions.
- With unbalanced inputs
- With volume control bypass (or without volume control circuit)
- Output power: 100 W (8Ω) or more
When using an external amplifier that does no have the volume control bypass, turn up the volume of the
external amplifier enough and fix it.
Caution
To prevent the generation of loud noises or abnormal sounds, make sure the followings before making
connections.
- Remove the power cable of this unit and turn off the external power amplifier before connecting them.
- When using the PRE OUT jacks, do not connect speakers to the corresponding SPEAKERS
terminals.
- When using an external amplifier that does not have the volume control bypass, do not connect other
devices (except this unit) to the amplifier.
+12V 0.1A MAX.
AC IN
TRIGGER
OUT
YP
B PR
1
2
HDMI
MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT
IN OUT
AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV 7
1
2
REMOTE
T
I CH INPUT
ZONE OUT
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
ZONE 2
N
D SUR. BACK
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONTSURROUND BACKSURROUND
BI–AMP
ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/
R L R R RL L L
SINGLE
RS-232C
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTER
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
EXTRA SP
YPB PR
AV 3
O
NENT VIDEO
C
AV 4
D
1 234
This unit (rear)
+12V 0.1A MAX.
AC IN
TRIGGER
OUT
P
B PR
1
2
M
I
M
ONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT
IN OUT
AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV 7
1
2
REMOTE
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONTSURROUND BACK
BI–AMP
ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/
R RL L L
SINGLE
RS-232C
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTER
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
EXTRA SP
MAIN IN
PR
SU
R
FRONT
L
R
L
R
This unit (rear)
PRE OUT (FRONT) jacks
Main input jack
Amplifier with
volume control
bypass
(A-S2000, etc.)
1
Speaker connections
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
En 24
Video/audio jacks
HDMI jacks
Transmit digital video and digital sound through a single
jack. Use an HDMI cable.
Use a 19-pin HDMI cable with the HDMI logo. We recommend using
a cable less than 5.0 m long to prevent signal quality degradation.
To connect a device that has a DVI jack, an HDMI/DVI-D cable is
required.
The HDMI jacks of this unit support the HDMI Control, Audio Return
Channel (ARC), and 3D video transmission (through output)
features.
Video jacks
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks
Transmit video signals separated into three
components: luminance (Y), chrominance blue (PB),
and chrominance red (PR). Use a component video
cable with three plugs.
S VIDEO jack
Transmits S-video signals that include luminance (Y)
and chrominance (C) components. Use an S-video
cable.
VIDEO jacks
Transmit analog video signals. Use a video pin cable.
Audio jacks
OPTICAL jacks
Transmit digital audio signals. Use a digital optical
cable. Remove the tip protector (if available) before
using the cable.
COAXIAL jacks
Transmit digital audio signals. Use a digital coaxial
cable.
AUDIO jacks
Transmit analog stereo audio signals. Use a stereo pin
cable.
Input/output jacks and cables
AV 1
HDMI cable
Component video cable
S-video cable
AV 1
Video pin cable
Digital Optical cable
Digital coaxial cable
Stereo pin cable
En 25
Connect a TV to this unit so that videos input to this unit can be output to the TV.
You can also enjoy playback of TV audio on this unit.
The connection method varies depending on functions and video input jacks available
on your TV.
Refer to the instruction manual of the TV and choose a connection method.
Connection method 1
(HDMI Control/ARC-compatible TV)
Connect the TV to this unit with an HDMI cable.
The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “HDMI” parameters
(p.103) in the “Setup” menu.
HDMI Control is available only on the HDMI OUT 1 jack.
If you make an HDMI connection between your TV and this unit, any videos input to this unit can be output
to the TV no matter how you connect video devices to this unit. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.130).
You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.30).
2 Connecting a TV
About HDMI Control
HDMI Control allows you to operate external devices via HDMI. If you connect a TV
that supports HDMI Control to this unit with an HDMI cable, you can control this unit
(power, volume, etc.) in conjunction with TV remote control operations. You can also
control playback devices (HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD player, etc.)
connected to this unit with an HDMI cable. For details, see “HDMI Control” (p.131).
About Audio Return Channel (ARC)
ARC allows audio signals to travel both ways under HDMI Control. So if you connect
a TV that supports HDMI Control and ARC to this unit with a single HDMI cable, you
can output video/audio to the TV or input TV audio to this unit.
Does your TV support
Audio Return Channel (ARC)?
Does your TV support
HDMI Control?
Does your TV have an
HDMI input jack?
Connection method 3 (p.28)
Connection method 2 (p.27)
Connection method 1 (p.25)
Connection method 4 (p.29)
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
HDMI OUT
ARC
1 2
(1
AV 1
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUDIO 4AUDIO 3AUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
FRONT
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
GND
YPB
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
AV 1
A
AV 2
B
HDMI OUT
ARC
12
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI OUT 1 jack
HDMI input
(ARC-compatible)
This unit (rear)
TV
1 2
TV connection
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
En 26
Necessary settings
To use HDMI Control and ARC, you need to configure the following settings.
For details on settings and operations of your TV, refer to the instruction manual of the TV.
1
After connecting external devices (TV, playback devices, etc.) and
power cable of this unit, turn on this unit, TV and playback devices.
2
Configure the settings of this unit.
a Check that ARC is enabled on the TV.
b Switch the TV input to display the video from this unit.
c Press ON SCREEN.
d Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER.
e Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select “HDMI”.
f Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select “HDMI Control” and press ENTER.
g Use the cursor keys to select “On”.
h Press ON SCREEN.
3
Configure the settings for HDMI Control.
a Enable HDMI Control on the TV and playback devices (HDMI Control-compatible BD/
DVD player, etc).
b Turn off the main power of the TV and then turn off this unit and playback devices.
c Turn on this unit and playback devices and then turn on the main power of the TV.
d Switch the TV input to display the video from this unit.
e Check the followings.
On this unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected. If not,
select the input source manually.
On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed.
f Check that this unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning off the TV or
adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control.
Now the necessary settings are complete.
If you select a TV program with the TV remote control, the input source of this unit will
be automatically switched to “AUDIO1” and the TV audio will be played back on this
unit.
If TV audio cannot be heard, check that “ARC” (p.104) in the “Setup” menu is set to
“On”.
If HDMI Control does not work properly, try turning off and on (or unplugging and re-plugging) the
devices. It may solve the problem.
If any audio interruption happens while using ARC, set “ARC” (p.104) in the “Setup” menu to “Off
and use an audio cable (digital optical or stereo pin cable) to input TV audio to this unit (p.27).
“AUDIO1” is set as TV audio input at the factory. If you have connected any external device to the
AUDIO1 jacks, use “TV Audio Input” (p.103) in the “Setup” menu to change the TV audio input
assignment. To use the SCENE function (p.49), you also need to change the input assignment for
SCENE(TV).
RETURN
VOLUME
TV
CD
RADIO
ENTER
TOP
POP UP
DISPLAY
OPTIONON SCREEN
BD/DVD
RET
U
RN
V
O
L
U
M
E
TV
CD
RADI
O
TO
P
POP UP
DISPLA
Y
A
A
O
PTI
ON
BD
/
DV
D
ON SCREEN
Cursor keys
ENTER
1 2
TV connection
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
En 27
Connection method 2 (HDMI Control-compatible TV)
Connect the TV to this unit with an HDMI cable and an audio cable (digital optical or
stereo pin cable).
The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “HDMI” parameters
(p.103) in the “Setup” menu.
HDMI Control is available only on the HDMI OUT 1 jack.
If you make an HDMI connection between your TV and this unit, any videos input to this unit can be output
to the TV no matter how you connect video devices to this unit. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.130).
You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.30).
Necessary settings
To use HDMI Control, you need to configure the following settings.
For details on settings and operations of your TV, refer to the instruction manual of the
TV.
1
After connecting external devices (TV, playback devices, etc.) and
power cable of this unit, turn on this unit, TV and playback devices.
2
Configure the settings of this unit.
a Switch the TV input to display the video from this unit.
b Press ON SCREEN.
c Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER.
d Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select “HDMI”.
e Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select “HDMI Control” and press ENTER.
f Use the cursor keys to select “On”.
g Press ON SCREEN.
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
HDMI OUT
ARC
1 2
(1
AV 1
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUDIO 4AUDIO 3AUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
FRONT
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
GND
YPB
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
AV 1
A
AV 2
B
HDMI
HDMI OUT
ARC
12
OPTICAL
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
5
AUDIO
OPTICAL
R
L
OO
L
R
L
R
HDMI
HDMI
This unit (rear)
HDMI OUT 1 jack
AUDIO1 (OPTICAL or AUDIO)
jacks
Audio output
(digital optical or analog stereo)
TV
HDMI input
RETURN
VOLUME
TV
CD
RADIO
ENTER
TOP
POP UP
DISPLAY
OPTIONON SCREEN
BD/DVD
RET
U
RN
V
O
L
U
M
E
TV
CD
RADI
O
TO
P
POP UP
DISPLA
Y
A
A
O
PTI
ON
BD
/
DV
D
ON SCREEN
Cursor keys
ENTER
1 2
TV connection
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
En 28
3
Configure the settings for HDMI Control.
a Enable HDMI Control on the TV and playback devices (HDMI Control-compatible BD/
DVD player, etc).
b Turn off the main power of the TV and then turn off this unit and playback devices.
c Turn on this unit and playback devices and then turn on the main power of the TV.
d Switch the TV input to display the video from this unit.
e Check the followings.
On this unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected. If not,
select the input source manually.
On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed.
f Check that this unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning off the TV or
adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control.
Now the necessary settings are complete.
If you select a TV program with the TV remote control, the input source of this unit will
be automatically switched to “AUDIO1” and the TV audio will be played back on this
unit.
If HDMI Control does not work properly, try turning off and on (or unplugging and re-plugging) the
devices. It may solve the problem.
“AUDIO1” is set as TV audio input at the factory. If you have connected any external device to the
AUDIO1 jacks, use “TV Audio Input” (p.103) in the “Setup” menu to change the TV audio input
assignment. To use the SCENE function (p.49), you also need to change the input assignment for
SCENE(TV).
Connection method 3 (TV with HDMI input jacks)
Connect the TV to this unit with an HDMI cable and an audio cable (digital optical or
stereo pin cable).
If switch the input source of this unit to “AUDIO1” by pressing AUDIO1 or SCENE(TV),
the TV audio will be played back on this unit.
If you make an HDMI connection between your TV and this unit, any videos input to this unit can be output
to the TV no matter how you connect video devices to this unit. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.130).
You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.30).
If you have connected any external device to the AUDIO1 jacks, connect the TV to one of the AUDIO2~4
jacks. To use the SCENE function (p.49), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV).
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
HDMI OUT
ARC
1 2
(1
AV 1
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUDIO 4AUDIO 3AUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
FRONT
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
GND
YPB
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
AV 1
A
AV 2
B
HDMI
HDMI OUT
ARC
12
OPTICAL
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
5
AUDIO
OPTICAL
R
L
OO
L
R
L
R
HDMI
HDMI
This unit (rear)
HDMI OUT 1 jack
AUDIO1 (OPTICAL or AUDIO)
jacks
Audio output
(digital optical or analog stereo)
TV
HDMI input
1 2
TV connection
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
En 29
Connection method 4 (TV without HDMI input jacks)
Depending on the video input jacks available on your TV, choose one of the following
connections.
If you select “AUDIO1” as the input source by pressing AUDIO1 or SCENE(TV), the TV
audio will be played back on this unit.
If you connect your TV to this unit with a cable other than HDMI, videos input to this unit via HDMI cannot
be output to the TV. Also, analog videos that can be output to the TV differ according to the “Analog to
Analog Conversion” setting. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.130).
If you have connected any external device to the AUDIO1 jacks, connect the TV to one of the AUDIO2~4
jacks. To use the SCENE function (p.49), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV).
To use the MONITOR OUT jacks for the TV in the main zone, set “Monitor Out Assign” (p.106) in the
“Setup” menu to “Main” (default).
COMPONENT VIDEO connection (with a component video cable)
S VIDEO connection (with an S-video cable)
VIDEO (composite video) connection (with a video pin cable)
YPB PR
OPTICAL
O
UT
HDMI OUT
ARC
1 2
HDMI
(1 BD/DVD)
MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT
IN
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 4
MULTI CH INPUT
ZONE OUT
AUDIO 3AUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
ZONE 2FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
SPEAKERS
SURROUND BACKSURROUND
R
5
COAXIAL
6
L R L
SINGLE
PRE OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. B
A
(SING
YPB PR YPB PR
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
AV 1
AV 3
COMPONENT VIDEO
A
AV 2
B
C
AV 4
D
OPTICAL
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
5
AUDIO
OPTICAL
R
L
YP
B
P
R
MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT
YP
B
P
R
COMPONENT VIDEO
OO
L
R
L
R
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
P
B
Y
This unit (rear)
MONITOR OUT
(COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks
Video input (component video)
TV
AUDIO1
(OPTICAL or AUDIO) jacks
Audio output
(digital optical or analog stereo)
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
HDMI OUT
ARC
1 2
(1
AV 1
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUDIO 4AUDIO 3AUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
FRONT
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
GND
YPB
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
AV 1
A
AV 2
B
OPTICAL
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
5
AUDIO
OPTICAL
R
L
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
S VIDEO
OO
L
R
L
R
S
S
This unit (rear)
MONITOR OUT
(S VIDEO) jack
Video input (S-video)
AUDIO1 (OPTICAL or AUDIO)
jacks
Audio output
(digital optical or analog stereo)
TV
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
HDMI OUT
ARC
1 2
(1
AV 1
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUDIO 4AUDIO 3AUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
FRONT
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
GND
YPB
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
AV 1
A
AV 2
B
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
VIDEO
V
V
This unit (rear)
MONITOR OUT
(VIDEO) jack
TV
Video input
(composite video)
1 2
TV connection
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
En 30
Connecting another TV or a projector
This unit has 2 HDMI output jacks. If you connect another TV or a projector to this unit
with an HDMI cable, you can switch the TVs (or projector) to be used for watching
videos with the remote control (p.48).
HDMI Control is not available on the HDMI OUT 2 jack.
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
HDMI OUT
ARC
1 2
(1
AV 1
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUDIO 4AUDIO 3AUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
FRONT
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
GND
YPB
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
AV 1
A
AV 2
B
HDMI OUT
ARC
12
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI
This unit (rear)
HDMI OUT 2 jack
HDMI input
Projector
TV (already connected)
1 2
TV connection
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
En 31
This unit is equipped with a variety of input jacks including HDMI input jacks to allow
you to connect different types of playback devices. For information on how to connect
an iPod, a Bluetooth component or a USB storage device, see the following pages.
- Connecting an iPod (p.60)
- Connecting a Bluetooth receiver (p.65)
- Connecting a USB storage device (p.67)
Connecting video devices (BD/DVD players, etc.)
Connect video devices such as BD/DVD players, set-top boxes (STBs) and game consoles
to this unit. Depending on the video/audio output jacks available on your video device,
choose one of the following connections. We recommend using an HDMI connection if the
video device has an HDMI output jack.
Videos input to this unit via HDMI cannot be output to a TV connected to this unit with a cable other than
HDMI.
The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “Input Assignment”
setting (p.108) in the “Setup” menu. As necessary, you can assign the COMPONENT VIDEO ( , , ,
), COAXIAL (a, b, f) and OPTICAL (c, d, e) jacks to another input source.
If you make more than one audio connection for one input source, an audio signal played back on this unit
will be determined according to the “Audio Select” setting (p.86) in the “Option” menu.
HDMI connection
Connect a video device to this unit with an HDMI cable.
If you select the input source by pressing AV1~7, the video/audio played back on the
video device will be output from this unit.
3 Connecting playback devices
+12V 0.1
A
TRIG
G
OU
T
YPB PR
1
2
2
HDMI
(1 BD/DVD)
MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT
IN OUT
AV 1AV 2AV 3AV 4AV 5AV 6AV 7
1
2
REMOTE
MULTI CH INPUT
ZONE OUT
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
ZONE 2FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONTSURROUND BACKSURROUND
R L R RL L
SINGLE
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTER
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
PB PR YPB PR
AV 3
COMPONENT VIDEO
C
AV 4
D
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI
This unit (rear)
HDMI output
Video device
HDMI (AV1~7) jacks
1 2 3
Playback device connections
4 5 6 7 8 9
En 32
Component video connection
Connect a video device to this unit with a component video cable and an audio cable
(digital coaxial, digital optical or stereo pin cable). Choose a set of input jacks (on this
unit) depending on the audio output jacks available on your video device.
If you select the input source by pressing AV1~4, the video/audio played back on the
video device will be output from this unit.
S-video connection
Connect a video device to this unit with an S-video cable and an audio cable (digital
coaxial, digital optical or stereo pin cable). Choose a set of input jacks (on this unit)
depending on the audio output jacks available on your video device.
If you select the input source by pressing AV1~4, the video/audio played back on the
video device will be output from this unit.
Output jacks on video device
Input jacks on this unit
Video Audio
Component video
Digital coaxial AV1~2 (COMPONENT VIDEO + COAXIAL)
Digital optical AV3~4 (COMPONENT VIDEO + OPTICAL)
Analog stereo AV1~4 (COMPONENT VIDEO + AUDIO)
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
HDMI OUT
ARC
1 2
(1 BD/DVD)
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUDIO 4
MULTI CH INPUT
ZONE
O
AUDIO 3AUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
ZONE 2FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
SURROUND
R
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
L
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
GND
YPB PR YPB PR
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
AV 1
AV 3
COMPONENT VIDEO
A
AV 2
B
C
AV 4
D
YPB PR
YPB PR
R
L
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
CC
L
R
L
R
OO
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
P
B
Y
This unit (rear)
AV1~4
(COMPONENT VIDEO)
jacks
Video output
(component video)
Video device
Audio output
(any of digital coaxial, digital optical,
analog stereo)
Any of AV1~2 (COAXIAL),
AV3~4 (OPTICAL),
AV1~4 (AUDIO) jacks
Output jacks on video device
Input jacks on this unit
Video Audio
S-video
Digital coaxial AV1~2 (S VIDEO + COAXIAL)
Digital optical AV3~4 (S VIDEO + OPTICAL)
Analog stereo AV1~4 (S VIDEO + AUDIO)
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
HD
ARC
1
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUAUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
GND
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
S VIDEO
CC
L
R
L
R
OO
S
S
R
L
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
This unit (rear)
AV1~4
(S VIDEO) jacks
Video output
(S-video)
Video device
Audio output
(any of digital coaxial, digital optical,
analog stereo)
Any of AV1~2 (COAXIAL),
AV3~4 (OPTICAL),
AV1~4 (AUDIO) jacks
1 2 3
Playback device connections
4 5 6 7 8 9
En 33
Composite video connection
Connect a video device to this unit with a video pin cable and an audio cable (digital
coaxial, digital optical or stereo pin cable). Choose a set of input jacks (on this unit)
depending on the audio output jacks available on your video device.
If you select the input source by pressing AV1~4, the video/audio played back on the
video device will be output from this unit.
Connecting audio devices (CD players, etc.)
Connect audio devices such as CD players, MD players and a turntable to this unit.
Depending on the audio output jacks available on your audio device, choose one of the
following connections.
The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “Input Assignment”
setting (p.108) in the “Setup” menu. As necessary, you can assign the COAXIAL (a, b, f) and OPTICAL
(c, d, e) jacks to another input source.
If you make more than one audio connection for one input source, an audio signal played back on this unit
will be determined according to the “Audio Select” setting (p.86) in the “Option” menu.
Output jacks on video device
Input jacks on this unit
Video Audio
Composite video
Digital coaxial AV1~2 (VIDEO + COAXIAL)
Digital optical AV3~4 (VIDEO + OPTICAL)
Analog stereo AV1~4 (VIDEO + AUDIO)
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
O
AV OUT
R
L
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AU
D
(2
(1 BD/DVD)
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
GND
VIDEO
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
CC
L
R
L
R
OO
V
V
R
L
This unit (rear)
AV1~4 (VIDEO)
jacks
Video output
(composite video)
Video device
Audio output
(any of digital coaxial, digital optical,
analog stereo)
Any of AV1~2 (COAXIAL),
AV3~4 (OPTICAL),
AV1~4 (AUDIO) jacks
Audio output jacks on audio device Audio input jacks on this unit
Digital coaxial
AV1~2 (COAXIAL)
AUDIO2 (COAXIAL)
Digital optical
AV3~4 (OPTICAL)
AUDIO1 (OPTICAL)
Analog stereo
AV1~4 (AUDIO)
AUDIO1~4 (AUDIO)
Turntable (PHONO) PHONO
1 2 3
Playback device connections
4 5 6 7 8 9
En 34
If you select the input source by pressing AV1~4, AUDIO1~4 or PHONO, the audio
played back on the audio device will be output from this unit.
Connecting to the jacks on the front panel
Use the VIDEO AUX jacks on the front panel to temporarily connect devices such as a
game console and a camcorder to this unit.
Before making a connection, stop playback on the device and turn down the volume of
this unit.
If you select “V-AUX” as the input source by pressing V-AUX, the video/audio played
back on the device will be output from this unit.
If you connect video devices to both the HDMI IN jack and analog video/audio jacks, this unit outputs video/
audio input through the HDMI IN jack.
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
HDMI OUT
ARC
1 2
(1 BD/DVD)
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUDIO 4
MULTI CH INPUT
ZONE
O
AUDIO 3AUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
ZONE 2FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
SURROUND
R
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
L
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
GND
YPB PR YPB PR
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
AV 1
AV 3
COMPONENT VIDEO
A
AV 2
B
C
AV 4
D
R
L
PHONO
GND
R
L
PHONO
GND
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
CC
L
R
L
R
OO
L
R
L
R
This unit
(rear)
PHONO jacks
Audio output
(PHONO)
Turntable
Audio output
(any of digital coaxial, digital optical,
analog stereo)
Any of AV1~4, AUDIO1~4
(COAXIAL, OPTICAL, AUDIO) jacks
Audio device
MULTI ZONE
HDMI IN
VIDEO AUX
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ZONE 2
ZONE CONTROL
YPAO MIC
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
USB
iPod/iPhone
PROGRAM FM AM TUNING/CH
ROPTICALL AUDIOVIDEOS VIDEO
O
V RL
HDMI
S
Game console
Camcorder
This unit (front)
1 2 3
Playback device connections
4 5 6 7 8 9
En 35
Connect the supplied FM/AM antennas to this unit.
Assembling and connecting the AM antenna
Unwind the antenna cable from the AM antenna unit only the length needed.
The wires of the AM antenna have no polarity.
4 Connecting the FM/AM antennas
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
YP
B PR
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
HDMI OUT
ARC
1
1
2
2
HDMI
(1 BD/DVD)
MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT
IN OUT
AV 1AV 2AV 3AV 4AV 5AV 6AV 7
REMOTE
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUDIO 4
MULTI CH INPUT
ZONE OUT
AUDIO 3AUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
ZONE 2FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
SPEAKERS
CENTER F
R
SURROUND BACKSURROUND
R
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
L R RL
SINGLE
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTER
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
GND
YPB PR YPB PR
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
AV 1
AV 3
COMPONENT VIDEO
A
AV 2
B
C
AV 4
D
FM antenna
AM antenna
This unit (rear)
Hold down Insert Release
1 2 3 4
FM/AM antenna connections
5 6 7 8 9
En 36
Connect this unit to your router with a commercially-available STP network cable (CAT-5
or higher straight cable).
You can enjoy Internet radio or music files stored on PCs and DLNA servers such as
Network Attached Storage (NAS) on this unit.
When using a router that supports the DHCP function, the network parameters (IP address, etc.) will be
automatically assigned to this unit without configuring the network settings of this unit. If your router does
not support the DHCP function or you want to configure the network parameters manually, configure the
network settings (p.105).
You can check whether the network parameters (IP address, etc.) are properly assigned to this unit in
“Network” (p.111) in the “Information”.
Some security software installed on your PC or the firewall settings of your network devices (such as a
router) may block the access of this unit to the network devices or the Internet. In such cases, configure the
security software or firewall settings appropriately.
You can connect this unit to up to 16 music servers (PC, etc.), and each server must be connected to the
same subnet as this unit.
To use the service via the Internet, broadband connection is strongly recommended.
5 Connecting to the network
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
HDMI OUT
ARC
1 2
(1
AV 1
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUDIO 4AUDIO 3AUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
FRONT
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
GND
YPB
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
AV 1
A
AV 2
B
LAN
WAN
Network Attached Storage
(NAS)
Internet
Modem
Router
Network cable
PC
This unit (rear)
1 2 3 4 5
Network connections
6 7 8 9
En 37
Connecting video/audio recording devices
You can connect video/audio recording devices to the AV OUT jacks. These jacks
output video/audio signals selected as the input.
The AV OUT jacks cannot output video/audio signals input through the HDMI or COMPONENT VIDEO
jacks.
Connecting a device with analog multi-channel
output
You can connect an analog multi-channel output device such as a DVD player and an
SACD player to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks.
If you select “MULTI CH” as the input source by pressing MULTI, the audio played back
on the device will be output from this unit.
You can select a video source to be displayed when “MULTI CH” is selected as the input source using
“Video Out” (p.89) in the “Input” menu. When connecting a video device (DVD player, etc.) to the MULTI CH
INPUT jacks, use the input jack specified in “Video Out” for the video connection.
Since this unit does not redirect signals input to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks to accommodate for missing
speakers, make appropriate settings on the external device (DVD player, etc.) that suit to the speaker
configuration.
When “MULTI CH” is selected as the input source, sound mode selection and tone control adjustment are
not available.
6 Connecting other devices
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
A
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1 6
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
GND
MONIT
O
ZON
E
VIDEO
S VIDEO
AUDIO
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
V
L
R
L
R
OO
S
S
V
T
his unit (rear)
AV OUT jacks
Video/audio input
Video/audio
recording device
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
HDMI OUT
ARC
1 2
(1 BD/DVD)
AV 1AV 2AV
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUDIO 4
MULTI CH INPUT
AUDIO 3AUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
Z
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
SURROUND
R
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
L
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
GND
YPB PR YPB
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
AV 1
AV 3
COMPONENT VIDEO
A
AV 2
B
C
AV 4
D
MULTI CH INPUT
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
L
R
L
R
L
R
This unit (rear)
MULTI CH
INPUT jacks
Channel output
(Center)
Device with analog
multi-channel output
(Subwoofer)
(Surround
back)
(Surround)
(Front)
1 2 3 4 5 6
Other connections
7 8 9
En 38
Connecting a device compatible
with SCENE link playback (remote connection)
If you have a Yamaha product that has the capability of the SCENE control signal
transmission, you can control the Yamaha product in conjunction with a scene selection
(p.49) by connecting it to the REMOTE OUT jack with a monaural mini-jack cable.
If you connect a Yamaha product compatible with SCENE link playback to the REMOTE OUT jack, you can
start playback on the Yamaha product in conjunction with a scene selection (p.49). To enable the SCENE
link playback, specify the device type in “Device Control” (p.90) in the “Scene” menu.
You also connect an infrared signal receiver/emitter to operate devices in the main zone from Zone2 (p.77).
Connecting a device compatible
with the trigger function
The trigger function can control an external device in conjunction with operations
(power-on/off, input selection, etc.) on this unit. If you have a Yamaha subwoofer that
supports a system connection or a device with a trigger input jack, you can use the
trigger function by connecting the external device to one of the TRIGGER OUT jacks.
You can configure the trigger function settings in “Trigger Output1” and “Trigger Output2” (p.109) in the
“Setup” menu.
+12
V
T
R
YPB PR
1
2
2
HDMI
(1 BD/DVD)
MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT
IN OUT
AV 1AV 2AV 3AV 4AV 5AV 6AV 7
REMOTE
D
IO 4
MULTI CH INPUT
ZONE OUT
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
ZONE 2FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONTSURROUND BACKSURROUND
R L R RL
L
SINGLE
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTER
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
Y
PB PR YPB PR
AV 3
COMPONENT VIDEO
C
AV 4
D
IN OUT
REMOTE
IN
REMOTE
This unit (rear)
REMOTE OUT jack
Yamaha product
(DVD player, etc.)
Remote input
+12V 0.1A MAX.
AC IN
TRIGGER
OUT
P
R
1
2
T
IN OUT
AV 5AV 6AV 7
1
2
REMOTE
CENTER FRONT
BI–AMP
ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/
R RL L L
GLE
RS-232C
E
OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTER
R
ROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
EXTRA SP
+12V 0.1A MAX.
TRIGGER
OUT
1
2
This unit (rear)
TRIGGER OUT
1~2 jacks
System connection
input
Yamaha subwoofer that
supports a system connection
1 2 3 4 5 6
Other connections
7 8 9
En 39
After all the connections are complete, connect the supplied power cable to this unit
and then to an AC wall outlet.
7 Connecting the power cable
+12V 0.1A MAX.
AC IN
TRIGGER
OUT
P
R
1
2
T
IN OUT
AV 5AV 6AV 7
1
2
REMOTE
CENTER FRONT
BI–AMP
ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/
R RL L L
GLE
RS-232C
E
OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTER
R
ROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
EXTRA SP
To an AC wall outlet
This unit (rear)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Power cable connection
8 9
En 40
Select a desired on-screen menu language from English (default),
Japanese, French, German, Spanish and Russian.
1
Press RECEIVER to turn on this unit.
2
Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display
the video from this unit.
3
Press ON SCREEN.
4
Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press
ENTER.
5
Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select “Language” and
the cursor keys ( / ) to select a desired language.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
The information on the front display is provided in English only.
8 Selecting an on-screen menu language
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 2 3 4
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7 856
90
10
123 4
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
123 4
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
ON SCREEN
ENTER
RECEIVER
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Language setting
9
Cursor keys
En 41
By using the Yamaha Parametric room Acoustic Optimizer (YPAO)
function, this unit automatically detects speaker connections and
distances from the listening position, and optimizes the speaker
settings such as volume balance and acoustic parameters to suit
your room.
Please note the following when using YPAO.
Use YPAO after connecting a TV and speakers to this unit.
During the measuring process, the test tones are output at high volume. Take care
that the test tone does not frighten small children. Also, refrain from using this
function at night when it may be a nuisance to others.
During the measuring process, you cannot adjust the volume.
During the measuring process, keep the room as quiet as possible.
Do not connect headphones.
If your subwoofer supports the auto-standby function, disable it.
1
Press RECEIVER to turn on this unit.
2
Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display
the video from this unit.
3
Turned on the subwoofer and set the volume to half.
If the cross-over frequency is adjustable, set it to
maximum.
4
According to your speaker configuration, configure
the “Power Amp Assign” setting (p.98) in the
“Setup” menu.
For the basic speaker configuration (p.15): set to “Basic”
(default).
For any of the advanced speaker configurations (p.19): set
to the appropriate setting.
5
Place the YPAO microphone at ear height in your
listening position and connect it to the YPAO MIC
jack on the front panel.
9 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO)
VOLUME HIGH CUT
CROSSOVER/
MIN MAXMIN MAX
This unit (front)
YPAO microphone
Listening position
Ear height
Place the YPAO microphone at ear
height in your listening position. We
recommend using a tripod to adjust the
height. You can use the tripod screws to
fix the microphone in place.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Automatic speaker setup
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
R
ETUR
N
VO
LUM
E
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
H
T
E
NHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
UD
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
AM
PRE
S
E
T
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
ENTE
R
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
M
O
D
E
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
TO
P
MENU
P
O
P-
U
P
MEN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
MA
I
N
ZO
NE
2
R
E
C
EIVE
R
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
TE
DOCK
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
O
N
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1
4
3
M
U
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
NET
USB
BD
/
DV
D
RECEIVER
En 42
The following screen appears on the TV.
To cancel the operation, disconnect the YPAO microphone before starting
the measurement.
6
If desired, change the measuring method (multi/
single).
a Use the cursor keys to select “Multi Position” and press ENTER.
b Use the cursor keys to select a setting and then press ENTER.
Settings
If you perform the single measure, you will be able to enjoy surround sound at that
position with optimized speaker settings. If you perform the multi measure, the
speaker settings will be optimized for you to enjoy surround sound in a wider
space.
Now all preparations are complete. See the following page to start
the measurement.
When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes”:
“Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure)” (p.44)
When “Multi Position” is set to “No”:
“Measuring at one listening position (single measure)” (p.43)
Yes
Select this if your listening position is variable or you
will enjoy surround sound with your company. You can
perform the measurement at up to 8 positions to
optimize the speaker settings to suit all of those
positions (multi measure).
No (default)
Select this if your listening position is fixed in one
position. You will perform the measurement only once
to optimize the speaker settings suit to the position
(single measure).
Single measure
1 2
1
1
3
355
22
4
4
3
3
4
4
123
45
Multi measure
(5 listening positions)
Multi measure
(2 listening positions + front/back)
Multi measure
(1 listening position + 4 circumferences)
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
ENTER
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Automatic speaker setup
Cursor keys
En 43
Measuring at one listening position
(single measure)
When “Multi Position” is set to “No”, follow the procedure below to
make the measurement.
YPAO measurement is not performed correctly when any obstacles are in the
room.
During the measuring process (about 3 minutes), keep stuff in the corners or
remove it from the room.
1
To start the measurement, use the cursor keys to
select “Measure” and press ENTER.
The measurement will start in 10 seconds. Press ENTER
again to start the measurement immediately.
To cancel the measurement, press RETURN.
The following screen appears on the TV when the
measurement finishes.
If any error message (such as E-1) or warning message (such as W-1)
appears, see “Error messages” (p.46) or “Warning messages” (p.47).
To check the measurement results, select “Result”. For details, see
“Checking the measurement results” (p.45).
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Save/Cancel” and
press ENTER.
3
To save the measurement results, use the cursor
keys to select “SAVE” and press ENTER.
The corrected speaker settings are applied.
To finish the measurement without saving the result, select “CANCEL”.
4
Disconnect the YPAO microphone from this unit.
Now optimization of the speaker settings is complete.
Caution
Since the YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat, do not place the microphone
in any place where it will be subjected to direct sunlight or high temperatures
(top of an AV equipment, etc).
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
ENTER
RETURN
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Automatic speaker setup
Cursor keys
En 44
Measuring at multiple listening positions
(multi measure)
When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes”, follow the procedure below to
make the measurement.
YPAO measurement is not performed correctly when any obstacles are in the
room.
During the measuring process, keep stuff in the corners or remove it from the
room. It takes about 10 minutes to make the measurement at 8 listening positions.
If any error message (such as E-1) or warning message (such as W-1) appears,
see “Error messages” (p.46) or “Warning messages” (p.47).
1
To start the measurement, use the cursor keys to
select “Measure” and press ENTER.
The measurement will start in 10 seconds. Press ENTER
again to start the measurement immediately.
To cancel the measurement, press RETURN.
The following screen appears on the TV when the
measurement at the first position finishes.
2
Move the YPAO microphone to the next listening
position and press ENTER.
Repeat step 2 until the measurement at all listening
positions (up to 8) are made.
3
If the measurement at all listening position are
made, use the cursor keys to select “CANCEL” and
press ENTER.
If you have made the measurement at 8 listening positions,
the following screen appears automatically.
To check the measurement results, select “Result”. For details, see
“Checking the measurement results” (p.45).
4
Use the cursor keys to select “Save/Cancel” and
press ENTER.
5
To save the measurement result, use the cursor
keys to select “SAVE” and press ENTER.
The corrected speaker settings are applied.
To finish the measurement without saving the result, select “CANCEL”.
6
Disconnect the YPAO microphone from this unit.
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
ENTER
RETURN
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Automatic speaker setup
Cursor keys
En 45
Now optimization of the speaker settings is complete.
Checking the measurement results
You can check the YPAO measurement results.
1
After the measurement, use the cursor keys to
select “Result” and press ENTER.
You can also select “Result” from “Auto Setup” (p.96) in the “Setup” menu. In
this case, the previous measurement results are displayed.
The following screen appears.
1 Measurement result items
2 Measurement result details
3 The number of measured positions (when multi
measure is performed)
2
Use the cursor keys to select an item
A speaker with any problem is indicated with a red-boxed message.
3
To finish checking the results and return to the
previous screen, press RETURN.
Reloading the previous YPAO results
When the speaker settings you have configured manually are not
suitable, follow the procedure below to discard the manual settings
and reload the previous YPAO results.
1
In the “Setup” menu, select “Speaker”, “Auto
Setup” and then “Result” (p.95).
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Setup Reload” and
press ENTER.
3
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Caution
Since the YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat, do not place the microphone
in any place where it will be subjected to direct sunlight or high temperatures
(top of an AV equipment, etc).
Wiring
Polarity of each speaker
Normal: The speaker cable is connected with the
correct polarity (+/-).
Reverse: The speaker cable may be connected with
the reversed polarity (+/-).
2
3
1
Size
Size of each speaker (cross-over frequency of the
subwoofer)
Large: The speaker can reproduce low-frequency
signals effectively.
Small: The speaker cannot reproduce low-frequency
signals effectively.
Distance Distance from the listening position to each speaker
Level Output level adjustment for each speaker
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
ON SCREEN
ENTER
RETURN
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Automatic speaker setup
Cursor keys
En 46
Error messages
If any error message is displayed during the measurement, resolve the problem and perform YPAO again.
Error message Cause Remedy
E-1: No Front SP Front speakers are not detected.
Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off this unit, and then check the speaker connections.E-2: No Sur. SP Either of surround speakers is not detected.
E-3: No F.PRNS SP Either of front presence speakers is not detected.
E-4: SBRSBL A surround back speaker is connected to the R side only.
When using only one surround back speaker, you need to connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side). Follow the
on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off this unit, and then reconnect the speaker.
E-5: Noisy The noise is too loud.
Keep the room quiet and follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. If you select
“PROCEED”, the measurement starts again on the condition this unit ignores the noisy error even if noises
are detected.
E-6: Check Sur.
Any surround back speaker is connected while no surround
speakers are connected.
Surround speakers should be connected when using surround back speakers. Follow the on-screen
instructions to exit YPAO, turn off this unit, and then reconnect the speakers.
E-7: No MIC The YPAO microphone has been removed.
Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack firmly and follow the on-screen instructions to start the
measurement again.
E-8: No Signal The YPAO microphone cannot detect test tones.
Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack firmly and follow the on-screen instructions to start the
measurement again. If this error occurs repeatedly, contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service
center.
E-9: User Cancel The measurement has been canceled. Follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. To cancel the measurement, select “EXIT”.
E-10: Internal Error An internal error has occurred.
Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off and on this unit. If this error occurs repeatedly,
contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Automatic speaker setup
En 47
Warning messages
Even if any warning message is displayed after the measurement, you can save the measurement results by following on-screen instructions.
However, we recommend you perform YPAO again to use this unit with the optimal speaker settings.
Warning message Cause Remedy
W-1: Out of Phase
Any of the speaker cables may be connected with the
reversed polarity (+/-).
Select “Wiring” in “Result” (p.45) and check the cable connections (+/-) of the speaker indicated with
“Reverse”. If the speaker is connected incorrectly, turn off this unit and then reconnect the speaker cable.
Depending on the type of speakers or room environment, this message may appear even if the speakers are
connected correctly.
W-2: Over Distance
Any of the speakers is placed more than 24 m from the
listening position.
Select “Distance” in “Result” (p.45) and move the speaker indicated with “>24.0m (>80.0ft)” within 24 m of
the listening position.
W-3: Level Error
There are a significant volume differences between the
speakers.
Check the use environment and cable connections (+/-) of each speaker, and the volume of the subwoofer.
We recommend using the same speakers or speakers with as similar specifications as possible.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Automatic speaker setup
En 48
PLAYBACK
1
Turn on external devices (TV, BD/DVD player, etc.)
connected to this unit.
2
Use the input selection keys to select an input
source.
3
Start playback on the external device, or select a
radio station.
Refer to the instruction manual of the external device.
For details on the following operations, see the
corresponding pages.
- Listening to FM/AM radio (p.56)
- Playing back iPod music/videos (p.60)
- Playing back music via Bluetooth (p.65)
- Playing back music stored on a USB storage device (p.67)
- Playing back music stored on PCs (p.70)
- Listening to Internet radio (p.73)
4
Press VOLUME to adjust the volume.
To mute the audio output, press MUTE. Press MUTE again to unmute.
To adjust treble/bass parts of sound, use the “Option” menu or TONE/
BALANCE on the front panel (p.85).
On-screen input selection
a Press ON SCREEN.
b Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER.
c Use the cursor keys to select a desired input source and press
ENTER.
Selecting an HDMI output jack
1
Press HDMI OUT to select an HDMI OUT jack.
Each time you press the key, the HDMI OUT jack to be
used for signal output switches.
You can also select an HDMI output jack by selecting a scene (p.49).
When “HDMI OUT 1+2” is selected, this unit outputs video signals at the
highest resolution that both TVs connected to this unit support. (For
example, if you have connected a 1080p TV to the HDMI OUT 1 jack, and a
720p TV to the HDMI OUT 2 jack, this unit outputs 720p video signals.)
Basic playback procedure
HDMI OUT 1+2
Outputs the same signal at both the HDMI OUT 1
and HDMI OUT 2 jacks.
HDMI OUT 1
Outputs the signals at the selected HDMI OUT
jack.
HDMI OUT 2
HDMI OUT Off Does not output the signals at the HDMI OUT jacks.
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSB PR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
OUT1+2
HDMIOUTSel.
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETUR
N
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
O
PTI
ON
TUNIN
G
BD
/
DV
D
HDMI OUT
ON SCREEN
MUTE
VOLUME
ENTER
Input selection keys
Cursor keys
En 49
The SCENE function allows you to select the assigned input source, sound program, HDMI output and various settings at once.
You can use up to 12 scenes to register your favorite settings and switch them depending on a playback source.
1
Press SCENE.
The input source and settings registered to the
corresponding scene are selected. This unit turns on
automatically when it is in standby mode.
By default, the following settings are registered for each scene.
You can select SCENE1~4 by pressing SCENE on the remote control.
Additionally, you can create 8 scenes (SCENE5~12) and select those scenes from
the “Scene” menu (p.89).
You can also include other setting items (surround settings, video settings, etc.) as
the scene assignments (p.91).
On-screen scene selection
a Press ON SCREEN.
b Use the cursor keys to select “Scene” and press ENTER.
c Use the cursor keys to select a desired scene and press
ENTER.
Selecting the input source and favorite settings at once (SCENE)
SCENE (SCENE key) 1 (BD/DVD) 2 (TV) 3 (CD) 4 (RADIO)
Input
Input (p.48) AV1 AUDIO1 AUDIO2 TUNER
Audio Select (p.86) Auto Auto Auto
HDMI Output HDMI Output (p.48) OUT 1+2 OUT 1+2 OUT 1+2 OUT 1+2
Mode
Sound Program (p.51) Drama STRAIGHT STRAIGHT 7ch Stereo
Pure Direct Mode (p.102) Auto Auto Auto Auto
Sound
Tone Control (p.85):
SP (speakers), HP (headphones)
Treble/Bass: 0.0dB Treble/Bass: 0.0dB Treble/Bass: 0.0dB Treble/Bass: 0.0dB
Adaptive DRC (p.85) Off On Off Off
Enhancer (p.55) Off On Off On
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
ON SCREEN
ENTER
SCENE
Cursor keys
En 50
Configuring scene assignments
Follow the procedure below to register the current status (input
source, sound program, etc.) to a scene. As necessary, you can
select items to be included as the scene assignments (p.91).
1
Set this unit to the condition (input source, sound
program, etc.) that you want to assign to a scene.
2
Hold down the desired SCENE key until “SET
Complete” appears on the front display.
3
If you want to control the corresponding playback
device after selecting the scene, hold down the
corresponding SCENE key and input selection key
together for more than 3 seconds.
Once the setting is completed successfully, SOURCE/
RECEIVER blinks twice.
If you have not registered the remote control code of the playback device
yet, see “Setting the remote control codes for playback devices” (p.116) to
register it.
You can start playback of external devices connected to this unit via HDMI
or a Yamaha product connected to the REMOTE OUT jack, in conjunction
with a scene selection (SCENE link playback). To enable the SCENE link
playback, specify the device type in “Device Control” (p.90) in the “Scene”
menu.
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSB PR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
SETComplete
SCENE1
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
MUT
E
ENTE
R
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI
OU
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
MUTE
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
TUNER
TUNIN
G
NET
USB
SCENE
SOURCE/RECEIVER
En 51
This unit is equipped with a variety of sound programs and
surround decoders that allow you to enjoy playback sources with a
favorite sound mode (sound field effect, stereo playback, etc).
Selecting a sound program suitable for movies (p.52)
Press MOVIE repeatedly.
Selecting a sound program suitable for music or stereo
playback (p.53)
Press MUSIC repeatedly.
Selecting a surround decoder (p.54)
Press SUR.DECODE repeatedly.
Switching to the straight decode mode (p.54)
Press STRAIGHT.
Switching to the Pure Direct mode (p.55)
Press PURE DIRECT.
Enable Compressed Music Enhancer (p.55)
Press ENHANCER.
On-screen sound program/surround decoder selection
a Press ON SCREEN.
b Use the cursor keys to select “Sound Program” and press
ENTER.
c Use the cursor keys to select a sound program/surround
decoder and press ENTER.
You can change the settings of the surround programs and surround decoders in
the “Sound Program” menu (p.92).
The sound mode can be applied separately to each input source.
When you play back audio signals with sampling frequency of higher than 96 kHz
or DTS Express sources, the straight decode mode (p.54) is automatically
selected.
You can check which speakers are currently outputting sound with the speaker
indicators on the front panel (p.10) or the “Audio Signal” screen in the
“Information” menu (p.110).
Selecting the sound mode
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
S
LEEP
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
S
E
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
ON SCREEN
ENTER
MOVIE
MUSIC
SUR.DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER
PURE DIRECT
Cursor keys
En 52
Enjoying sound field effects (CINEMA DSP)
This unit is equipped with a variety of sound programs that utilize Yamaha's original
DSP technology (CINEMA DSP). It allows you to easily create sound fields like actual
movie theaters or concert halls in your room.
When you play back DTS-HD sources, the DTS decoder is automatically selected.
Sound programs suitable for movies (MOVIE)
The following sound programs are optimized for viewing video sources such as movies,
TV programs and games.
MOVIE THEATER
ENTERTAINMENT
Standard
This program creates a sound field emphasizing the surround feeling
without disturbing the original acoustic positioning of multi-channel audio
such as Dolby Digital and DTS. It has been designed with the concept of an
ideal movie theater, in which the audience is surrounded by beautiful
reverberations from the left, right and rear.
Spectacle
This program represents the spectacular feeling of large-scale movie
productions. It reproduces a broad theater sound field that matches
cinemascope and wider-screen movies with an excellent dynamic range
providing everything from very small sound effects to large, impressive
sounds.
Sci-Fi
This program clearly reproduces the finely elaborated sound design of the
latest science fiction and special effects-featuring movies. You can enjoy a
variety of cinematographically created virtual spaces reproduced with clear
separation between dialog, sound effects and background music.
Adventure
This program is ideal for precisely reproducing the sound design of action
and adventure movies. The sound field restrains reverberations but puts
emphasis on reproducing a powerful space expanded widely to the left and
right. The reproduced depth is also restrained relatively to ensure the
separation between audio channels and the clarity of the sound.
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSB PR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
Sci-Fi
MOVIETHEATER
MOVIE
Sound program category
Sound program
“CINEMA DSP” lights up
Drama
This program features stable reverberations that match a wide range of
movie genres from serious dramas to musicals and comedies. The
reverberations are modest but offer an optimum 3D feeling, reproducing
effects tones and background music softly but cubically around clear words
and center positioning in a way that does not fatigue the listener even after
long hours of viewing.
Mono Movie
This program is provided for reproducing monaural video sources such as a
classic movie in an atmosphere of a good old movie theater. The program
produces the optimum expansion and reverberation to the original audio to
create a comfortable space with a certain sound depth.
Sports
This program allows the listeners to enjoy stereo sport broadcasts and
studio variety programs with enriched live feeling. In sports broadcasts, the
voices of the commentator and sportscaster are positioned clearly at the
center while the atmosphere of the stadium expands in an optimal space to
offer the listeners a feeling of presence in the stadium.
Action Game
This program is suitable for action games such as car racing, fighting
games and FPS games. The reality of, and emphasis on, various effects
makes the player feel like they are right in the middle of the action, allowing
for greater concentration. Use this program in combination with
Compressed Music Enhancer for a more dynamic and strong sound field.
Roleplaying Game
This program is suitable for role-playing and adventure games. This
program adds depth to the sound field for natural and realistic reproduction
of background music, special effects and dialog from a wide variety of
scenes. Use this program in combination with Compressed Music Enhancer
for a more clear and spatial sound field.
Music Video
This program offers an image of a concert hall for live performance of pop,
rock and jazz music. The listener can indulge oneself in a hot live space
thanks to the presence sound field that emphasizes the vividness of vocals
and solo play and the beat of rhythm instruments, and to the surround
sound field that reproduces the space of a big live hall.
En 53
Sound programs suitable for music/stereo playback
(MUSIC)
The following sound programs are optimized for listening to music sources.
You can also select stereo playback.
CLASSICAL
LIVE/CLUB
STEREO
Hall in Munich
This program simulates a concert hall with approximately 2500 seats in
Munich, using stylish wood for the interior finishing as normal standards for
European concert halls. Fine, beautiful reverberations spread richly,
creating a calming atmosphere. The listener's virtual seat is at the center left
of the arena.
Hall in Vienna
This program simulates an approximately 1700-seat, middle-sized concert
hall with a shoebox shape that is traditional in Vienna. Pillars and ornate
carvings create extremely complex reflections from all around the audience,
producing a very full, rich sound.
Chamber
This program creates a relatively wide space with a high ceiling like an
audience hall in a palace. It offers pleasant reverberations that are suitable
for courtly music and chamber music.
Cellar Club
This program simulates a live house with a low ceiling and homey
atmosphere. A realistic, live sound field features powerful sound as if the
listener is in a row in front of a small stage.
The Roxy Theatre
This program creates the sound field of a rock music live house in Los
Angeles, with approximately 460 seats. The listener's virtual seat is at the
center left of the hall.
The Bottom Line
This program creates the sound field at stage front in The Bottom Line, a
famous New York jazz club once. The floor can seat 300 people to the left
and right in a sound field offering real and vibrant sound.
2ch Stereo
Use this program to mix down multi-channel sources to 2 channels. When
multi-channel signals are input, they are down mixed to 2 channels and
output from the front speakers (this program does not utilizes CINEMA DSP).
7ch Stereo
Use this program to output sound from all speakers. When you playback
multi-channel sources, this unit down-mixes the source to 2 channels, and
then outputs the sound from all speakers. This program creates a larger
sound field and is ideal for background music at parties, etc.
En 54
Enjoying stereoscopic sound fields
(CINEMA DSP 3D)
CINEMA DSP 3D enables to create a natural stereoscopic sound
field in your room.
CINEMA DSP 3D functions when both of the following conditions
are met.
- One of the sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo) is
selected (p.52).
- “CINEMA DSP 3D Mode” (p.85) in the “Option” menu is set to
“On” (default).
We recommend using front presence speakers to have a full effect of the
stereoscopic sound fields. However, this unit creates Virtual Presence Speaker
(VPS) using the front, center and surround speakers to produce stereoscopic
sound fields even when no front presence speakers are connected.
Enjoying sound field effects without
surround speakers (Virtual CINEMA DSP)
If you select one of the sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and
7ch Stereo) when no surround speakers are connected, this unit
automatically creates the surround sound field using the front-side
speakers.
Enjoying unprocessed playback
You can play back input sources without any sound field effect
processing.
Enjoying unprocessed sounds in original
channels (straight decode)
When the straight decode mode is enabled, each speaker
produces each channel audio signal directly (without sound field
processing). When you play back 2-channel sources such as CD,
stereo sound is heard from the front speakers. When you play back
multi-channel sources, this unit produces unprocessed multi-
channel sounds.
1
Press STRAIGHT.
Each time you press the key, the straight decode mode is
enabled or disabled.
Enjoying unprocessed multi-channel
sounds (surround decoder)
The surround decoder enables unprocessed multi-channel
playback from 2-channel sources. When a multi-channel source is
input, it works the same way as the straight decode mode.
For details on each decoder see “Glossary” (p.127).
1
Press SUR.DECODE to select a surround decoder.
Each time you press the key, the surround decoder
switches.
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
HallinVienna
CLASSICAL
MUSIC
“CINEMA DSP ” lights up
3
Pro Logic
Uses the Dolby Pro Logic decoder suitable for any
sources.
PLIIx Movie
Uses the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro
Logic II decoder) suitable for movies.
PLII Movie
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
STRAIGHT
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
ProLogic
SUR.DECODE
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
ENTE
R
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI
OU
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
MUTE
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
TUNER
TUNIN
G
NET
USB
BD
/
DV
D
SUR.DECODE
STRAIGHT
En 55
You cannot select the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoders when headphones are
connected or when “Surround Back” in the “Setup” menu is set to “None”.
To enable 6.1/7.1-channel playback from 5.1-channel sources when surround
back speakers are used, set “Extended Surround” (p.86) in the “Option” menu to
PLIIx Movie”, “ PLIIx Music” or “EX/ES”.
Enjoying pure high fidelity sound
(Pure Direct)
When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, this unit plays back the
selected source with the least circuitry to reduce the electrical
noise from other circuitry (front display, etc). It allows you to enjoy
Hi-Fi sound quality.
1
Press PURE DIRECT.
Each time you press the key, the Pure Direct mode is
enabled or disabled.
When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, the following functions are not available.
- Selecting sound programs
- Adjusting the tone control
- Operating the on-screen menu
- Viewing information on the front display (when not operated)
Enjoying compressed music with enhanced
sound (Compressed Music Enhancer)
Compressed Music Enhancer improves the sound enhancer near
to the original depth and width of compressed music sources. This
function can be used along with any other sound modes.
1
Press ENHANCER.
Each time you press the key, Compressed Music Enhancer
is enabled or disabled.
Compressed Music Enhancer does not work on the following audio sources.
- Signals of which sampling rate is over 48kHz
- High-definition streaming audio
You can also use “Enhancer” (p.86) in the “Option” menu to enable/disable
Compressed Music Enhancer.
Enjoying surround sound with headphones
(SILENT CINEMA)
You can enjoy surround or sound field effects like a multi-channel
speaker system with stereo headphones by connecting the
headphones to the PHONES jack and selecting a sound program
or a surround decoder.
PLIIx Music
Uses the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro
Logic II decoder) suitable for music.
PLII Music
PLIIx Game
Uses the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro
Logic II decoder) suitable for games.
PLII Game
Neo: 6 Cinema Uses the DTS Neo: 6 decoder suitable for movies.
Neo: 6 Music Uses the DTS Neo: 6 decoder suitable for music.
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
PUREDIRECT
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
EnhancerOn
“ENHANCER” lights up
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
S
LEEP
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
ENTE
R
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
S
E
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
ENHANCER
PURE DIRECT
En 56
You can tune into a radio station by specifying its frequency or
selecting from registered radio stations.
The radio frequencies differ depending on the country or region where the unit is
being used. The explanation of this section uses a display with frequencies used
in Europe model.
If you cannot have a good reception on the radio, adjust the direction of the FM/
AM antennas.
Selecting a frequency for reception
1
Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input
source.
2
Press FM or AM to select a band.
3
Use the following keys to set a frequency.
TUNING: Increase/decrease the frequency.
Hold down the key for about a second to search the station
automatically.
Numeric keys: Enter a frequency directly. For example, to
select 98.50 MHz, press “9”, “8”, “5” and “0” (or ENT).
“TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio
station.
“STEREO” also lights up when a stereo signal is received.
“Wrong Station!” appears when you enter a frequency that is out of
receivable range
You can switch between “Stereo” (stereo) and “Mono” (monaural) for FM
radio reception by pressing MODE. When signal reception for FM radio
station is unstable, switching to “Mono” may improve it.
Registering favorite radio stations (preset)
You can register up to 40 radio stations as presets. Once you
registered stations, you can easily tune into those stations by
selecting the preset number.
You can automatically register FM radio stations with strong signals using “Auto
Preset” (p.59).
Registering a radio station
Select a radio station manually and register it to a preset number.
1
Follow “Selecting a frequency for reception” (p.56)
to tune into a desired radio station.
2
Hold down MEMORY for more than 2 seconds.
The radio station will be registered to the preset number
“01” for the first time. After that, it will be registered to an
empty preset number (next to the lastly-registered preset
number).
Listening to FM/AM radio
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CLR
PR
STEREO
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
FM87.50MHz
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
FM98.50MHz
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
PresetOK
01:FM98.50MHz
Preset
Preset number
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
I
NF
O
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
ENTE
R
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
ENT
FM
AM
MEMORY
TUNING
MODE
TUNER
Numeric keys
En 57
To select a preset number to which the station will be registered, press
MEMORY once after tuning into a desired radio station, use PRESET or
numeric keys to select a preset number, and then press MEMORY again.
Selecting a preset station
Tune into a registered radio station by selecting the preset number.
1
Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input
source.
2
Press PRESET repeatedly to select a desired radio
station.
You can also enter a preset number (01 to 40) directly by
using the numeric keys after pressing PRESET once.
“No Presets” appears when no radio stations are registered.
“Wrong Num.” appears when an invalid number is entered.
“Empty” appears when a preset number not in use is entered.
To clear preset stations, use “Clear Preset” or “Clear All Preset” (p.59).
Radio Data System tuning
(Europe model only)
Radio Data System is a data transmission system used by FM
stations in many countries. This unit can receive various Radio Data
System data such as “Program Service”, “Program Type,” “Radio
Text” and “Clock Time” when tuning into a Radio Data System
broadcasting station.
Displaying the Radio Data System
information
1
Tune into a desired Radio Data System broadcasting
station.
We recommend using “Auto Preset” to tune into the Radio Data System
broadcasting stations (p.59).
2
Press INFO.
Each time you press the key, the item switches.
About 3 seconds later, the information is displayed.
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
FM98.50MHz
02:Empty
Preset
“Empty” (not in use) or frequency currently registered
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
01:FM98.50MHz
Preset
Program Service Program service name
Program Type Type of the current program
Radio Text Information on the current program
Clock Time Current time
DSP Program Sound mode name
Audio Decoder Decoder name
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
ProgramType
Info
Item name
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
CLASSICS
FM98.50MHz
Information
Frequency (always displayed)
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
A
M
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
ENTE
R
MO
DE
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
TUNER
INFO
MEMORY
PRESET
Numeric keys
En 58
“Program Service”, “Program Type”, “Radio Text” and “Clock Time” do not
appear when the radio station does not provide the Radio Data System
service.
Receiving traffic information
automatically
When “TUNER” is selected as the input source, this unit
automatically receives traffic information. To enable this function,
follow the procedure below to set the traffic information station.
1
When “TUNER” is selected as the input source,
press OPTION.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Traffic Program”
(TrafficProgram) and press ENTER.
The traffic information station search will start in 5 seconds.
Press ENTER again to start the search immediately.
To search upward/downward from the current frequency, press the cursor
keys ( / ) while “Ready” is displayed.
To cancel the search, press RETURN.
Texts in parentheses denote indications on the front display.
The following screen appears for about 3 seconds when the
search finishes.
“TP Not Found” appears for about 3 seconds when no traffic information
stations are found.
Operating the radio on the TV
You can view the radio information or select a radio station on the TV.
1
Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input
source.
The playback screen is displayed on the TV.
Playback screen
1 Radio station information
Displays the information of the selected radio station such as the selected
band (FM/AM) and frequency.
(Europe model only)
When tuning into a Radio Data System broadcasting station (p.57), the
Radio Data System information (“Program Service”, “Program Type,”
“Radio Text” and “Clock Time”) is also displayed.
2 Band icon
(Except for Europe model)
Select this icon and press ENTER to switch between FM and AM.
3 TUNED/STEREO indicators
“TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station.
“STEREO” lights up when a stereo signal is received.
4 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
TPFM101.30MHz
TrafficProgram
Finished
Traffic information station (frequency)
1
4
3
2
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
ON SCREEN
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
OPTION
ENTER
RETURN
TUNER
Cursor keys
En 59
Browse screen
1 Preset station list
Displays the list of preset stations. Use the cursor keys to select a preset
station and press ENTER to tune into it.
2 Preset number
3 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
Menu Submenu Function
Manual Tuning
FM
(Europe model only)
Switches to FM/AM.
AM
Tuning (+/-) Selects a frequency.
Auto (+/-) Selects a radio station automatically.
Memory
Registers the selected station as
presets.
Direct Enters a frequency directly.
Browse
Moves to the browse screen (preset
station list).
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows
the background. Press one of the
menu operation keys to redisplay it.
Menu Submenu Function
Utility
Memory
Registers the current station to the
preset number selected in the list.
Auto Preset
Automatically registers FM radio
stations with strong signals (up to 40
stations).
Clear Preset
Clear the preset station selected in the
list.
Clear All Preset Clear all the preset stations.
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of
the list.
1 Page Down
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows
the background. Press one of the
menu operation keys to redisplay it.
3
2
1
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
En 60
You can play back iPod music/videos on this unit using a USB cable supplied with iPod,
an optional Yamaha iPod dock (such as YDS-12) or an optional Yamaha iPod wireless
system (YID-W10).
This manual describes both the “iPod” and “iPhone” as the “iPod”. “iPod” means both “iPod” and “iPhone”
unless the explanation describes exceptions.
Some features may not be compatible depending on the model or software version of an iPod, or the model
of an iPod dock.
Functional differences depending on the way of connection
* Requires an Apple Composite AV Cable (not supplied). Connect the USB and composite video plugs of the
Apple Composite AV cable to the USB jack and VIDEO AUX (VIDEO) jack of this unit and set “Video Out
(USB)” (p.89) in the “Input” menu to “V-AUX”.
Connecting an iPod
Using a USB cable
Connect your iPod to this unit with the USB cable supplied with the iPod.
1
Connect the USB cable to the iPod.
2
Connect the USB cable to the USB jack.
Playing back iPod music/videos
USB cable supplied
with iPod
Yamaha iPod universal
dock
(such as YDS-12)
Yamaha iPod wireless
system
(YID-W10)
Audio output ✓✓✓
Video output *
Operation with
remote control of
the unit
✓✓
Operation with
iPod
✓✓✓
Operation on TV
screen
✓✓
Charging ✓✓✓
Charging during
standby mode
✓✓
Supported iPod
(as of April 2011)
iPod touch
iPod nano (2 gen. to
6 gen.)
iPod classic
iPhone 4
iPhone 3GS
iPhone 3G
iPhone
iPod touch
iPod nano
iPod classic
iPod with video
iPod with color display
iPod with click wheel
iPod mini
iPhone 4
iPhone 3GS
iPhone 3G
iPhone
iPod touch
iPod nano
iPod classic
iPod with video
iPhone 4
iPhone 3GS
iPhone 3G
iPhone
SCENE
MULTI ZONE
VIDEO A
U
TONE/BALANCEOPTIONON SCREEN
DISPLAYRETURN
STRAIGHT
1
ENTER
ZONE 2
2 3
ZO
N
YPAO MIC
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
USB
iPod/iPhone
PROGRAM
RL AUDIOVIDEOS VIDEO
I
NPUT
This unit (front)
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
SLEEP
HD
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
Connected
USB
En 61
Using an iPod dock
Refer to the instruction manual of the iPod dock in addition.
1
Set this unit to standby mode and connect the iPod
dock to the DOCK jack.
Locate the iPod dock at the distance as far as from this unit.
2
Connect your iPod to the iPod dock and turn on this
unit.
While an iPod is connected to the iPod dock, the iPod is charged. You can
select whether to charge the iPod when this unit is in standby mode using
“Standby Charge” (p.88) in the “Input” menu.
Using an iPod wireless system
When using an iPod wireless system, operate your iPod itself to
start playback after making a connection. Refer to the instruction
manual of the iPod wireless system in addition.
1
Disconnect the power cable from the AC wall outlet
and connect the iPod wireless system (receiver) to
the DOCK jack.
Locate the iPod wireless system (receiver) at the distance
as far as from this unit.
2
Connect the power cable to an AC wall outlet.
3
Connect your iPod to the iPod wireless system
(transmitter).
4
On your iPod, select the content and start playback.
This unit automatically turns on and selects “DOCK” as the
input source.
You can select whether to control this unit (power on/off, input selection and
volume adjustment) in conjunction with iPod operations using “iPod
Interlock” (p.88) in the “Input” menu. When the iPod interlock function is
disabled, turn on this unit and select the input source manually.
While the iPod wireless system (transmitter) is placed on the iPod wireless
system (receiver), the iPod is charged. You can select whether to charge the
iPod when this unit is in standby mode using “Standby Charge” (p.88) in the
“Input” menu.
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
HD
ARC
1
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUAUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
GND
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
DOCK
This unit (rear)
iPod dock
Caution
When you use iPod controls to adjust volume, the volume may be
unexpectedly loud. This could result in damage to this unit or speakers. If the
volume suddenly increases during playback, remove the iPod from the iPod
wireless system (transmitter) immediately. To prevent this problem, we
recommend using “Max Volume” (p.102) in the “Setup” menu to set the
maximum volume level for this unit.
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
HD
ARC
1
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUAUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
GND
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
DOCK
A
B
1
2
3
This unit (rear)
iPod wireless system (receiver)
En 62
Playback of iPod contents
When using a USB cable or an iPod dock, you can control the iPod
with the menu displayed on the TV.
When using an iPod wireless system, you cannot control the iPod from the TV
screen. Operate your iPod itself to select the content and start playback.
1
When using a USB cable: press USB to select
“USB” as the input source.
When using an iPod dock: press DOCK to select
“DOCK” as the input source.
The browse screen is displayed on the TV.
* Display example (when using an iPod dock)
2
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press
ENTER.
If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback
screen is displayed.
To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.
To operate the iPod itself to select a content or control playback, switch to
the simple play mode (p.63).
Browse screen
1 Status indicators
Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.64) and playback status
(play/pause, etc).
2 List name
3 Contents list
Displays the list of iPod contents. Use the cursor keys to select an item
and press ENTER to confirm the selection.
4 Item number/total
5 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
Menu Function
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the list.
1 Page Down
10 Pages Up
Moves to 10 pages forward/backward.
10 Pages Down
Return Returns to the higher-level list.
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation keys
to redisplay it.
5
4
3
2
1
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
BD
/
DV
D
ENTER
RETURN
DOCK
USB
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
En 63
Playback screen
1 Status indicators
Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.64) and playback status
(play/pause, etc).
2 Playback information
Displays the artist name, album name, song title and elapsed/remaining
time.
Use the cursor keys to select information to be scrolled.
3 Album image
4 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
You can also use the external device operation keys on the remote control to
control playback.
Operating the iPod itself or remote control
(simple play)
1
Press MODE to switch to the simple play mode.
The TV menu screen turns off and iPod operations are
enabled.
To display the TV menu screen, press MODE again.
2
Operate your iPod itself or the remote control to
start playback.
Menu Submenu Function
Play Control
Resumes playback from pause.
Stops playback.
Stops playback temporarily.
Skips forward/backward.
Searches forward/backward (by holding
down).
Browse Moves to the browse screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu
operation keys to redisplay it.
4
3
2
1
Operational remote control
keys
Function
Cursor keys Select an item.
ENTER Confirms the selection.
RETURN Returns to the previous screen.
External
device
operation keys
Starts playback or stops playback
temporarily.
Stops playback.
Skips forward/backward.
Searches forward/backward (while holding
down).
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
MODE
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
En 64
Shuffle/repeat settings
You can configure the shuffle/repeat settings of your iPod.
When using an iPod wireless system, configure the shuffle/repeat settings directly
on your iPod.
During simple play, configure the shuffle/repeat settings directly on your iPod, or
press MODE to display the TV menu screen and then follow the procedure below.
Texts in parentheses denote indications on the front display.
1
When “USB” or “DOCK” is selected as the input
source, press OPTION.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or
“Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
Texts in parentheses denote indications on the front display.
3
Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select a setting and
press ENTER.
4
To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
Item Setting Function
Shuffle
(Shuffle)
Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function.
Songs
(Songs)
Plays back songs in random order. “
appears in the TV screen.
Albums
(Albums)
Plays back albums in random order. “
appears in the TV screen.
Repeat
(Repeat)
Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function.
One (One)
Plays back the current song repeatedly.
” appears in the TV screen.
All (All)
Plays back all songs repeatedly. “
appears in the TV screen.
1
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
MODE
OPTION
ENTER
RETURN
Cursor keys
En 65
You can play back music stored on a Bluetooth component on this
unit using a Yamaha Bluetooth wireless audio receiver (such as
YBA-10, optional). Refer to the instruction manuals of the Bluetooth
receiver and your Bluetooth component in addition.
This unit supports A2DP (Advanced Audio Distribution Profile) of
the Bluetooth profile.
When connecting your Bluetooth component to the Bluetooth receiver for the first
time, you need to perform “pairing” (mutual recognition for 2 Bluetooth
components). After that, you only need to establish a wireless connection between
those components to play back music via Bluetooth. “Pairing” must be performed
between each combination. So if you have several Bluetooth components, you
need to pair each of your Bluetooth components with the Bluetooth receiver.
Connecting a Bluetooth receiver
1
When this unit is in standby mode, connect the
Bluetooth receiver to the DOCK jack.
Locate the Bluetooth receiver at the distance as far as from
this unit.
2
Turn on this unit.
Pairing Bluetooth components
Be sure to perform pairing when connecting a Bluetooth
component to the Bluetooth receiver for the first time, or when the
pairing setting has been deleted.
The Yamaha Bluetooth receiver (YBA-10) can be paired with up to eight Bluetooth
components. When the ninth component is paired, the pairing setting for the
component which has not been used for the longest period of time will be deleted.
Texts in parentheses denote indications on the front display.
1
Press DOCK to select “DOCK” as the input source.
2
Turn on your Bluetooth component and set it to the
pairing mode.
3
Press OPTION, use the cursor keys to select
“Pairing” (Pairing), and then press ENTER.
Searching starts. If your Bluetooth component recognizes
the Bluetooth receiver, the model name (such as “YBA-10
YAMAHA”) will be displayed in the device list of your
component.
To cancel the search, press RETURN.
You can also start the search by holding down MEMORY instead of step 3.
(To cancel the search, press MEMORY again.)
Playing back music via Bluetooth
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
HD
ARC
1
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUAUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
GND
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
DOCK
This unit (rear)
Bluetooth receiver
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CLR
PR
SLEEP
HD
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
Searching...
DOCK
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
P
H
O
N
O
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
OPTION
ENTER
RETURN
MEMORY
DOCK
Cursor keys
En 66
4
Select the Bluetooth receiver from the device list
and enter the pass key “0000”.
“Completed” appears when the pairing is complete.
Depending on Bluetooth components, “BT connected” appears when the
pairing is complete. In this case, the wireless connection has been already
established. You just need to start playback on your Bluetooth component to
enjoy it on this unit.
5
To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
Establishing a wireless connection and
playing back
When the pairing is complete, follow the procedure below to
establish a wireless connection between your Bluetooth component
and the Bluetooth receiver. When the connection is established,
this unit outputs sounds played back on the Bluetooth component.
Depending on Bluetooth components, a wireless connection is established
automatically or by operating the Bluetooth component. In this case, you can skip
steps 2 and 3 below.
Texts in parentheses denote indications on the front display.
1
Press DOCK to select “DOCK” as the input source.
2
Press OPTION.
3
Use the cursor keys to select “Connect” (Connect)
and then press ENTER.
“BT connected” appears when the wireless connection is
established.
If the Bluetooth receiver is paired with more than one Bluetooth component,
the lastly-connected component is automatically chosen. When you cannot
establish a connection with an intended component, perform pairing again
or perform the connection operation from the intended component.
“Not found” appears if a connection cannot be established. Check the
followings and try again.
- The Bluetooth component and Bluetooth receiver are paired.
- The Bluetooth component is turned on and the Bluetooth mode is enabled.
- The Bluetooth component is within 10 m of the Bluetooth receiver.
4
Start playback on your Bluetooth component.
To terminate the wireless connection, select “Disconnect” (Disconnect) in
step 3.
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CLR
PR
SLEEP
HD
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
Completed
DOCK
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
SLEEP
HD
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
BTconnected
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
P
H
O
N
O
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
OPTION
ENTER
DOCK
Cursor keys
En 67
You can play back music files stored on a USB storage device on
this unit. Refer to the instruction manuals of the USB storage device
in addition.
This unit supports USB mass storage class devices (FAT16 or
FAT32 format, except USB HDDs).
This unit supports playback of WAV (PCM format only), MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC
and FLAC files.
This unit is compatible with sampling frequency of up to 96 kHz for WAV and
FLAC files, and 48 kHz for other files.
Connecting a USB storage device
1
Connect the USB storage device to the USB jack.
If the USB storage device contains many files, it may take time to load the
files. In this case, “Loading...” appears in the front display.
Playback of USB storage device contents
Follow the procedure below to operate the USB storage device
contents and start playback.
1
Press USB to select “USB” as the input source.
The browse screen is displayed on the TV.
If playback is ongoing on your USB storage device, the playback screen is
displayed.
2
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press
ENTER.
If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback
screen is displayed.
To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.
Files not supported by this unit are not listed.
You can register your favorite items as shortcuts (p.80) and access them
directly by selecting the shortcut numbers.
Playing back music stored on a USB storage device
MULTI ZONE
VIDEO A
U
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ZONE 2
ZO
N
YPAO MIC
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
USB
iPod/iPhone
PROGRAM
RL AUDIOVIDEOS VIDEO
USB
This unit (front)
USB storage device
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
SLEEP
HD
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
Connected
USB
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
BD
/
DV
D
ENTER
RETURN
USB
Cursor keys
En 68
Browse screen
1 Status indicators
Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.69) and playback status.
2 List name
3 Contents list
Displays the list of USB storage device contents. Use the cursor keys to
select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection.
4 Item number/total
5 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
Playback screen
1 Status indicators
Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.69) and playback status.
2 Playback information
Displays the artist name, album name, song title and elapsed time.
Use the cursor keys to select information to be scrolled.
3 Album image
4 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
You can also use the external device operation keys ( , , , ) on the
remote control to control playback.
Menu Function
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the list.
1 Page Down
10 Pages Up
Moves to 10 pages forward/backward.
10 Pages Down
Return Returns to the higher-level list.
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation keys
to redisplay it.
5
4
3
2
1
Menu Submenu Function
Play
Control
Stops playback.
Skips forward/backward.
Browse Moves to the browse screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation
keys to redisplay it.
4
3
22
1
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
En 69
Shuffle/repeat settings
You can configure the shuffle/repeat settings for playback of USB
storage device contents.
The shuffle/repeat settings are shared by USB and network sources.
1
When “USB” is selected as the input source, press
OPTION.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or
“Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
Texts in parentheses denote indications on the front display.
3
Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select a setting and
press ENTER.
4
To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
Item Setting Function
Shuffle
(Shuffle)
Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function.
On (On)
Plays back songs in the current album
(folder) in random order. “ ” appears in
the TV screen.
Repeat
(Repeat)
Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function.
Single
(Single)
Plays back the current song repeatedly.
” appears in the TV screen.
All (All)
Plays back all songs in the current album
(folder) repeatedly. “ ” appears in the
TV screen.
1
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
OPTION
ENTER
RETURN
Cursor keys
En 70
You can play back music files stored on your PC or DLNA-
compatible NAS on this unit.
To use this function, this unit and your PC must be connected to the network
properly (p.36). You can check whether the network parameters (IP address, etc.)
are properly assigned to this unit in “Network” (p.111) in the “Information”.
This unit supports playback of WAV (PCM format only), MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC
and FLAC files.
This unit is compatible with sampling frequency of up to 96 kHz for WAV and
FLAC files, and 48 kHz for other files.
To play back FLAC files, you need to install server software that supports sharing
of FLAC files via DLNA on your PC or use a NAS that supports FLAC files.
Requirements
This unit can play back music files stored on the following music
servers.
- PC with Windows Media Player 11 or later installed
- PC with DLNA/UPnP certificate server software installed
- NAS with DLNA/UPnP certification
Media sharing setup
To play back music files stored on your PC or DLNA-compatible
NAS, first you need to configure the media sharing setting on each
music server.
For a PC with Windows Media Player
installed
1
Check that Windows Media Player 11 or later is
installed on your PC.
2
In the media sharing settings, enable the media
sharing and select this unit as a device to which the
media is shared.
For a NAS or a PC with other DLNA sever
software installed
Refer to the instruction manual of the device or software and
configure the media sharing setting.
Playback of PC music contents
Follow the procedure below to operate the PC music contents and
start playback.
1
Press NET repeatedly to select “PC” as the input
source.
The browse screen is displayed on the TV.
If playback of a music file selected from this unit is ongoing on your PC, the
playback screen is displayed. This function works only when “DMC Control”
(p.89) in the “Input” menu is set to “Disable”.
2
Use the cursor keys to select a music server and
press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press
ENTER.
If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback
screen is displayed.
Playing back music stored on PCs
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
USB
BD
/
DV
D
ENTER
NET
Cursor keys
En 71
To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.
Files not supported by this unit are not listed (or cannot be selected even if
listed).
You can register your favorite items as shortcuts (p.80) and access them
directly by selecting the shortcut numbers.
Browse screen
1 Status indicators
Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.72) and playback status
(play/pause).
2 List name
3 Contents list
Displays the list of PC contents. Use the cursor keys to select an item and
press ENTER to confirm the selection.
4 Album image
5 Item number/total
6 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
Playback screen
1 Status indicators
Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.72) and playback status
(play/pause).
2 Playback information
Displays the artist name, album name, song title and elapsed time.
Use the cursor keys to select information to be scrolled.
3 Album image
4 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
You can also use the external device operation keys ( , , , , ) on the
remote control to control playback.
You can also use a DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control
playback. For details, see “DMC Control” (p.89).
Menu Function
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the list.
1 Page Down
10 Pages Up
Moves to 10 pages forward/backward.
10 Pages Down
Return Returns to the higher-level list.
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation keys
to redisplay it.
6
5
4
3
2
1
Menu Submenu Function
Play
Control
Resumes playback from pause.
Stops playback.
Stops playback temporarily.
Skips forward/backward.
Browse Moves to the browse screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation
keys to redisplay it.
4
3
2
2
1
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
En 72
Shuffle/repeat settings
You can configure the shuffle/repeat settings for playback of PC
music contents.
The shuffle/repeat settings are shared by USB and network sources.
1
When “PC” is selected as the input source, press
OPTION.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or
“Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
Texts in parentheses denote indications on the front display.
3
Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select a setting and
press ENTER.
4
To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
Item Setting Function
Shuffle
(Shuffle)
Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function.
On (On)
Plays back songs in the current album
(folder) in random order. “ ” appears in
the TV screen.
Repeat
(Repeat)
Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function.
Single
(Single)
Plays back the current song repeatedly.
” appears in the TV screen.
All (All)
Plays back all songs in the current album
(folder) repeatedly. “ ” appears in the
TV screen.
1
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
OPTION
ENTER
RETURN
Cursor keys
En 73
You can listen to Internet radio stations using the vTuner Internet
radio station database service particularly customized for this unit,
providing a database of numerous radio stations in the world.
To use this function, this unit must be connected to the Internet (p.36). You can
check whether the network parameters (IP address, etc.) are properly assigned to
this unit in “Network” (p.111) in the “Information”.
This service may be discontinued without notice.
Some Internet radio stations may not be played.
1
Press NET repeatedly to select “NET RADIO” as the
input source.
The browse screen is displayed on the TV.
2
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press
ENTER.
If an Internet radio station is selected, playback starts and
the playback screen is displayed.
To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.
You can register your favorite Internet radio stations as shortcuts (p.80) and
access them directly by selecting the shortcut numbers.
Browse screen
1 Playback indicator
2 List name
3 Contents list
Displays the list of Internet radio contents. Use the cursor keys to select
an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection.
4 Station art
5 Item number/total
6 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
Listening to Internet radio
Menu Function
Bookmark On Adds the station selected in the list to “Bookmarks”.
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the list.
1 Page Down
10 Pages Up
Moves to 10 pages forward/backward.
10 Pages Down
Return Returns to the higher-level list.
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation keys
to redisplay it.
6
5
4
3
2
1
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
USB
BD
/
DV
D
ENTER
RETURN
NET
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
En 74
By adding your favorite Internet radio stations to “Bookmarks”, you can access to
them quickly from “Bookmarks”. To remove stations from “Bookmarks”, select the
station in “Bookmarks” and then “Bookmark Off”.
You can also register your favorite Internet radio stations by accessing the
following website with the web browser on your PC. To use this feature, you need
the vTuner ID of this unit and your e-mail address to create your personal account.
You can check the vTunerID (MAC address of this unit) in the “Network” screen
(p.111) in the “Information” menu.
http://yradio.vtuner.com/
Playback screen
1 Playback indicators
2 Playback information
Displays the station name and elapsed time.
3 Station art
4 Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
You can also use the external device operation keys ( , ) on the remote
control to control playback.
Menu Submenu Function
Bookmark
On
Adds the current station to “Bookmarks”.
Play
Control
Stops playback.
Browse Moves to the browse screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation
keys to redisplay it.
4
3
2
1
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
En 75
The multi-zone function allows you to play back separate input
sources in the room where this unit is installed (main zone) and
another room (Zone2).
For example, while you are watching a TV in the living room (main
zone), another person can listen to radio in the bedroom (Zone2).
Since there are many possible ways to use this unit in a multi-zone configuration,
we recommend that you consult with your nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or
service center about the multi-zone connections that best meet your
requirements.
Only analog audio signals (including radio, USB and network sources) can be
output to Zone2. To listen to playback sounds of an external device in Zone2, you
need to connect the device to the AUDIO jacks of this unit with a stereo pin cable.
The party mode (p.79) allows you to enjoy main zone sources in Zone2
simultaneously regardless of input audio signal types.
Preparing for Zone2
Connect devices to be set in Zone2 to this unit. The connection
method varies depending on an amplifier to use (this unit or
external amplifier).
Using the internal amplifier of this unit
Connect the speakers placed in Zone2 to this unit with speaker
cables. For details, see “Connecting Zone2 speakers” (p.22).
Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone)
Living room (main zone)
Bedroom (Zone2)
Caution
Remove the power cable of this unit from an AC wall outlet before connecting
speakers or an external amplifier.
Be careful that the core of the speaker cable does not touch anything or come
into contact with the metal areas of this unit. This may damage this unit or the
speakers. If the speaker cables short circuit, “CHECK SP WIRES” will appear
on the front display when this unit is turned on.
En 76
Using an external amplifier
Connect the external amplifier placed in Zone2 to this unit with a
stereo pin cable.
Connecting a video monitor for Zone2
Connect a video monitor for Zone2 to watch videos at Zone2.
Depending on the video input jacks available on your video
monitor, choose one of the video connection methods.
The video conversion between the analog video jacks does not work for Zone2
video output. To watch videos played back on a video device on the Zone2 video
monitor, you need to connect the video monitor to this unit in the same way as the
video device.
To assign the ZONE OUT jacks to the Zone2 video monitor, set
“Monitor Out Assign” (p.106) in the “Setup” menu to “Zone2”.
YPB
HDMI OUT
2
HDMI
(1 BD/DVD)
MONITOR OUT/ZO
N
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
AUDIO 4
MULTI CH INPUT
ZONE OUT
AUDIO 3
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
ZONE 2FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
SPEAKE
R
SURROUND
B
SURROUND
R L R
FRONT
YPB PR YPB PR
AV 1
AV 3
COMPONENT VIDEO
A
AV 2
B
C
AV 4
D
L
R
L
R
AUDIO
ZONE OUT
ZONE 2
This unit (rear)
ZONE OUT (ZONE 2) jacks
Zone2
Main zone
External amplifier
Audio input (analog stereo)
YPB PR
OPTICAL
HDMI OUT
ARC
1 2
HDMI
(1 BD/DVD)
MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT
IN
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5
R
E
AUDIO 4
MULTI CH INPUT
ZONE OUT
AUDIO 3AUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
ZONE 2FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
SPEAKERS
C
SURROUND BACKSURROUND
R
5
COAXIAL
6
L R L
SINGLE
PRE OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BAC
K
(SINGL
E
YPB PR YPB PR
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
AV 1
AV 3
COMPONENT VIDEO
A
AV 2
B
C
AV 4
D
YPB PR
MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT
YPB PR
COMPONENT VIDEO
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
P
B
Y
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
S VIDEO
S
S
V
V
VIDEO
This unit (rear)
ZONE OUT jacks
(any of COMPONENT VIDEO,
VIDEO, S VIDEO)
Zone2
Main zone
Video input
(any of component video,
composite video, S-video)
En 77
Operating this unit from Zone2
(remote connection)
By connecting an infrared signal receiver/emitter to the REMOTE
IN/OUT jacks of this unit, you can operate this unit and external
devices from Zone2 with the supplied remote control.
To operate external devices with the supplied remote control, register a remote
control code for each device in advance (p.115).
YPB PR
1
2
HDMI
MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT
IN OUT
AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV 7
REMOTE
CH INPUT
ZONE OUT
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
ZONE 2
D
SUR. BACK
SPEAKERS
CENTER FROSURROUND BACKSURROUND
R L R RL
SINGLE
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTER
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
YPB PR
AV 3
O
NENT VIDEO
C
AV 4
D
IN OUT
REMOTE
This unit (rear)
REMOTE IN/OUT jacks
Infrared signal
transmitter
External device
(CD player, etc.)
Remote control
Infrared signal
receiver
Zone2
Main zone
En 78
Remote connections between Yamaha products
If you are using Yamaha products that support remote connections
like this unit, an infrared signal transmitter is unnecessary. You can
transmit remote control signals by connecting the REMOTE IN/OUT
jacks with monaural mini-jack cables and an infrared signal
receiver.
Controlling Zone2
1
Set MAIN/ZONE2 to “ZONE2”.
2
Press RECEIVER .
Each time you press the key, Zone2 output is enabled or
disabled.
When Zone2 output is enabled, “ZONE2” lights up in the
front display.
3
Use the following keys to select an input source.
AV1~4: AV1~4 (AUDIO) jacks
V-AUX: VIDEO AUX (AUDIO) jacks (on the front panel)
AUDIO1~4: AUDIO1~4 (AUDIO) jacks
PHONO: PHONO jacks
DOCK: DOCK jack
TUNER: FM/AM radio
NET: NETWORK jack (press repeatedly to select a desired
network source)
USB: USB jack (on the front panel)
You cannot select USB and network sources exclusively for each zone. For
example, if you select “PC” for Zone2 when “USB” is selected for the main
zone, the input source for the main zone also switches to “PC”.
IN
OUT
REMOTE
IN
OUT
REMOTE
Remote control
Infrared signal
receiver
Yamaha products
(up to 6, including this unit)
REMOTE IN/OUT jacks REMOTE IN/OUT jacks
Zone2
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
AV
7
6
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
ENTE
R
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
MU
LT
I
TUNIN
G
BD
/
DV
D
AV1~4
V-AUX
AUDIO1~4
PHONO
DOCK
TUNER
NET
USB
RECEIVER
MAIN/ZONE2
En 79
4
Start playback on the external device, or select a
radio station.
Refer to the instruction manual of the external device.
For details on the following operations, see the
corresponding pages.
- Listening to FM/AM radio (p.56)
- Playing back iPod music (p.60)
- Playing back music via Bluetooth (p.65)
- Playing back music stored on a USB storage device (p.67)
- Playing back music stored on PCs (p.70)
- Listening to Internet radio (p.73)
The on-screen operations are not available for Zone2. Use the front display
or web control (p.81) to control Zone2.
Other operations for Zone2
The following functions are also available when Zone2 output is
enabled.
Adjusting the volume
Press VOLUME or MUTE.
Selecting the input source and settings at once (SCENE)
Press SCENE.
To register the current settings (input source, volume and tone control) to a scene,
hold down the desired SCENE key until “SET Complete” appears on the front
display.
Setting the sleep timer
Press SLEEP repeatedly to set the time (120 min, 90 min, 60 min, 30
min, off).
Adjusting the high-/low-frequency range of sounds
a Press ZONE CONTROL on the front panel.
b Press TONE/BALANCE repeatedly to select “Treble” or “Bass”.
c Press PROGRAM to make an adjustment.
Setting range
-10.0dB ~ +10.0dB (2.0dB steps)
Default
0.0dB
Adjusting the Zone2 front speaker balance
a Press ZONE CONTROL on the front panel.
b Press TONE/BALANCE repeatedly to select “Balance”.
c Press PROGRAM to make an adjustment.
Enjoying main zone sources in Zone2
(party mode)
The party mode allows you to enjoy main zone sources in Zone2
simultaneously. During the party mode, stereo playback is
automatically selected for all zones. Utilize this function when you
want to play back main sources as background music in a home
party, etc.
1
Pr ess PARTY.
Each time you press the key, the party mode is turned on or
off.
When the party mode is turned on, “PARTY” lights up in the
front display.
If the party mode does not work on Zone2, set “Party Mode Set” (p.106) in
the “Setup” menu to “Enable” (default).
Caution
To avoid unexpected noise, never play back DTS-CDs in Zone2.
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
RETUR
N
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
ENTE
R
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
SLEEP
PARTY
VOLUME
SCENE
MUTE
En 80
Registering favorite items (shortcut)
You can register up to 40 favorite USB and network contents as
shortcuts and access them directly by selecting the shortcut
numbers.
You can also use the “Bookmarks” feature to register Internet radio stations (p.73).
Registering an item
Select a desired item and register it to a shortcut number.
1
Play back a song or a radio station to be registered.
2
Press MEMORY.
To change a shortcut number to which the item will be registered, use
PRESET or numeric keys to select the shortcut number after step 2.
3
To confirm the registration, press MEMORY.
Recalling a registered item
Recall a registered item by selecting the shortcut number.
1
Press NET or USB.
2
Press PRESET repeatedly to select a desired item.
You can also enter a shortcut number (01 to 40) directly by
using the numeric keys.
“No Presets” appears when no items are registered.
“Empty” appears when a preset number not in use is entered.
The registered item cannot be recalled in the following cases.
- A USB storage device which contains the registered item is not connected
to this unit.
- A PC which contains the registered item is turned off or not connected to
the network.
- The registered network content is temporarily unavailable or out of service.
- The registered item (file) has been deleted or moved to another location.
When you register music files stored on a USB storage device or a PC, this
unit memorizes the relative position of the music files in the folder. If you
have added or deleted any music files to or from the folder, this unit may not
recall the music file correctly. In such cases, register the items again.
Useful functions
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
SLEEP
HD
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
01:Empty
MemoryPreset
Shortcut number (flashes)
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
SLEEP
HD
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
02:Empty
MemoryPreset
“Empty” (not in use) or item currently registered
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
SLEEP
HD
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
01:USB
RecallPreset
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
A
M
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
ENTE
R
MO
DE
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
BD
/
DV
D
MEMORY
PRESET
NET
USB
Numeric keys
En 81
Controlling this unit from the web browser
(web control)
You can control this unit with the web control screen displayed in
the web browser.
To use this function, this unit and your PC must be connected to the network
properly (p.36).
Some security software installed on your PC may block the access of this
unit to your PC. In such cases, configure the security software appropriately.
We recommend using Internet Explorer 7.x or 8.x as a web browser.
If you set “Network Standby” (p.82) to “On”, you can display the web control
screen even when this unit is in standby mode.
You can limit access to this unit from the network devices (PCs, etc.) with
the MAC address filter (p.82).
1
Start the web browser.
2
Enter the IP address of this unit in the address bar
of the web browser.
(Example)
You can check the IP address in “Network” (p.111) in the “Information”
menu.
By adding the IP address of this unit to the bookmark of the browser, you will
be able to open it without entering the IP address from the next time.
However, the IP address of this unit may change if you are using a DHCP
server.
Top menu screen
1 CONTROL
Moves to the control screen for the selected zone.
2 STATUS
Turns on/off the power for each zone, or displays the input source and
volume set for each zone.
3 SETTINGS
Moves to the settings screen.
4 PARTY MO D E
Turns on/off the party mode (p.79).
5 SYSTEM POWER
Turns on/off the power for all zones.
6 MAIN VOLUME
Adjusts the volume or mutes the audio output for the main zone. You can
also switch the step for the volume adjustment.
7 RELOAD
Reloads the current status of this unit.
Web browser
Web control
PC
Router This unit
Web control
3
4
1
2
5
6
7
En 82
Control screen
1 PLAY INFO
Selects an input source or controls playback for the selected zone.
2 TOP MENU
Moves to the top menu screen.
3 SCENE
Select a scene for the selected zone.
4 POWER
Turns on/off the power for the selected zone.
5 VOLUME
Adjusts the volume or mutes the audio output for the selected zone. You
can also switch the step for the volume adjustment.
6 RELOAD
Reloads the current status of this unit.
Settings screen
1 Rename
Edits the friendly name (name for this unit in the network) or the name of
each zone (p.107). Click “APPLY” to apply the changes to this unit.
MAC Filter
Sets the MAC address filter (p.105) to limit access to this unit from the
network devices. Click “APPLY” to apply the changes to this unit.
Auto Reload
Enables/disables automatic reloading. When “Auto Reload” is “On”
(enabled), the web control screen reloads the status of this unit every 5
seconds.
Network Standby
Enables/disables the network standby function (p.105).
Tips 1/ 2
Displays the tips for use of the web control.
Create Link
Creates a shortcut link to the desired control screen.
Backup/Recovery
Creates backup of the settings of this unit on the PC, or restores the
settings from the backup.
2 BACK
Moves to the top menu screen.
3 RELOAD
Reloads the current status of this unit.
2
1
4
3
5
6
Note
Do not operate this unit during the recovery process (restoring the settings).
Otherwise, the settings may not be restored correctly. When the recovery
finishes, click “OK” to set this unit to standby mode.
The backup does not contain user information (user account, password, etc.)
or unit-specific information (MAC address, IP address, etc).
2
1
3
En 83
Viewing the current status
Switching information on the front display
1
Press INFO.
Each time you press the key, the display item switches.
About 3 seconds later, the corresponding information
appears.
Available items vary depending on the selected input source. Also, the
display item can be applied separately to each input source group.
Viewing the status information on the TV
1
Press DISPLAY.
The following information is displayed on the TV.
2
To close the information display, press DISPLAY.
Input source group Item
AV1~7
V-AUX
AUDIO1~4
PHONO
DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder
(decoder name)
TUNER
Frequency (frequency), DSP Program (sound mode
name), Audio Decoder (decoder name)
* (Europe model only)
When tuning into a Radio Data System
broadcasting station, Radio Data System data is
also available (p.57).
DOCK
Song (song title), Artist (artist name), Album (album
name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio
Decoder (decoder name)
* When using iPod wireless system, Bluetooth
receiver, or during simple play:
DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder
(decoder name)
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
SLEEP
HD
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
DSPProgram
Info
Item name
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
SLEEP
HD
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
TheRoxyTheat
AV1
Information
PC
USB
Song (song title), Artist (artist name), Album (album
name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio
Decoder (decoder name)
* When iPod is connected via USB, the display item
switches in the same manner as “DOCK”.
NET RADIO
Station (station name), DSP Program (sound mode
name), Audio Decoder (decoder name)
Input
source
Audio
format/
Decoder
Volume
Sound
mode
CINEMA DSP status
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
ENTE
R
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
DISPLAY
INFO
En 84
You can configure the playback-related settings in accordance with a playback source.
Since this menu is operational on the front panel (or on the TV screen), you can easily
configure the settings during playback.
1
Press OPTION.
Front display
TV screen
2
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
3
Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select a setting and press ENTER.
4
To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
Option menu items
Available items vary depending on the selected input source.
Texts in parentheses denote indications on the front display.
Configuring settings in accordance with a playback source (Option menu)
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSBPR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
SLEEP
HD
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
ToneControl
Option
Item Function Page
Tone Control
(Tone Control)
Adjusts the high-frequency range and low-frequency range
of sounds.
85
Adaptive DRC
(Adaptive DRC)
Sets whether dynamic range (from maximum to minimum)
is adjusted automatically in conjunction with adjusting the
volume level.
85
CINEMA DSP 3D Mode
(CINEMA DSP 3D)
Enables/disables CINEMA DSP 3D. 85
Dialogue Lift
(Dialog Lift)
Adjusts the vertical position of center sound when front
presence speakers are used.
85
Extended Surround
(EXTD Surround)
Selects the 5.1 to 7.1-channel signal playback method
when surround back speakers are used.
86
Volume Trim
(Volume Trim)
Corrects volume differences between input sources. 86
Enhancer
(Enhancer)
Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer. 86
Audio Select
(Audio Select)
Selects the audio input jack to use when more than one
audio connection is made for one input source.
86
Traffic Program
(TrafficProgram)
(Europe model only)
Searches for a traffic information station automatically.
58
Shuffle
(Shuffle)
Configures the shuffle setting for the iPod (p.64), USB
storage device (p.69) or PC (p.72).
Repeat
(Repeat)
Configures the repeat setting for the iPod (p.64), USB
storage device (p.69) or PC (p.72).
Connect/Disconnect
(Connect/Disconnect)
Establishes/terminates a wireless connection between your
Bluetooth component and the Bluetooth receiver.
66
Pairing
(Pairing)
Performs pairing of your Bluetooth component and the
Bluetooth receiver.
65
En 85
Tone Control (Tone Control)
Adjusts the high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range (Bass) of speaker
sounds. When connecting headphones, you can adjust high-frequency range and low-
frequency range of sounds output from headphones.
Choices
Treble (Treble), Bass (Bass)
Setting range
-6.0db ~ Bypass (Bypass) ~ +6.0dB *0.5dB steps
Default
Bypass (Bypass)
If you set the balance extremely off, sounds may not match those from other channels well.
Adjusting with the front panel controls
a Press TONE/BALANCE to select “Treble” or “Bass”.
b Press PROGRAM to make an adjustment.
Adaptive DRC (Adaptive DRC)
Sets whether dynamic range (from maximum to minimum) is adjusted automatically in
conjunction with adjusting the volume level. When it is set to “On”, it is useful for
listening to playback at low volume at night.
Settings
If “On” is selected, the dynamic range becomes narrow at a low volume, and becomes
wide at a high volume.
CINEMA DSP 3D Mode (CINEMA DSP 3D)
Enables/disables CINEMA DSP 3D. If this function is set to “On”, CINEMA DSP 3D
functions according to the selected sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 7ch
Stereo).
Settings
Dialogue Lift (Dialog Lift)
Adjusts the vertical position of center sound such as dialogues when front presence
speakers are used. If dialogues are heard from a position lower than the TV screen,
adjust this setting to raise the position.
Setting range
0~5 (higher raises the position)
Default
0
On (On) Adjusts the dynamic range automatically.
Off (Off) (default) Does not adjust the dynamic range automatically.
Volume: low Volume: high
Input level Input level
On
Off
On
Off
Output level
O
utput
l
eve
l
On (On) (default) Enables CINEMA DSP 3D.
Off (Off) Disables CINEMA DSP 3D.
Ideal position
En 86
Extended Surround (EXTD Surround)
Selects how to play back 5.1- to 7.1-channel sources when surround back speakers
are used.
Settings
Volume Trim (Volume Trim)
Corrects volume differences between input sources. If you are bothered by volume
differences when switching between input sources, use this function to correct it.
This setting is applied separately to each input source.
Setting range
-6.0dB ~ +6.0dB (0.5dB steps)
Default
0.0dB
Enhancer (Enhancer)
Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer (p.55).
This setting is applied separately to each input source.
Settings
Default
TUNER, DOCK, (network sources), USB: On (On)
Others: Off (Off)
Audio Select (Audio Select)
Selects the audio input jack to use when more than one audio connection is made for
one input source.
This setting is applied separately to each input source.
Settings
Auto (Auto) (default)
Automatically selects the most suitable decoder if a flag for
reproducing surround back channel is present, and reproduces the
signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel.
When the DTS or DTS-HD signal is input, the unit reproduces the
signal in 7.1-channel regardless of a flag for surround back channel.
PLIIx Movie
( PLIIxMo)
Always reproduces signals in 7.1-channel using the Dolby Pro Logic
IIx Movie decoder. This setting is available only when two surround
back speakers are connected.
PLIIx Music
( PLIIxMu)
Always reproduces signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel using the Dolby Pro
Logic IIx Music decoder. This setting is available only when one or two
surround back speakers are connected.
EX/ES (EX/ES)
Automatically selects the most suitable decoder, and reproduces
signals in 6.1-channel.
Off (Off) Always reproduces signals in original channels.
Off (Off) Disables Compressed Music Enhancer.
On (On) Enables Compressed Music Enhancer.
Auto (Auto) (default)
Automatically selects the audio input jack in the following priority order.
1. HDMI input
2. Digital input (COAXIAL or OPTICAL)
3. Analog input (AUDIO)
HDMI (HDMI)
Always selects HDMI input. No sounds are produced when no signals
are input through the HDMI jack.
Coax/Opt (Coax/Opt)
Always selects digital input (COAXIAL or OPTICAL). No sounds are
produced when no signals are input through the COAXIAL or OPTICAL
jack.
Analog (Analog)
Always selects analog input (AUDIO). No sounds are produced when
no signals are input through the AUDIO jacks.
En 87
CONFIGURATIONS
You can change the input source settings using the TV screen.
1
Press ON SCREEN.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select an input source to be configured
and press the cursor key ( ).
The input source of this unit also changes.
You can still switch the input source by using cursor keys ( / ) after step 3.
4
Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select an item and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
5
Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Input menu items
Available items vary depending on the selected input source.
Configuring input sources (Input menu)
Item Function Page
Rename/Icon Select Changes the input source name and icon. 88
Decoder Mode Sets the format of digital audio playback to DTS. 88
Standby Charge
Selects whether to charge the iPod when this unit is in
standby mode.
88
iPod Interlock
Selects whether to control this unit in conjunction with
iPod operations.
88
Video Out
Selects a video to be output with the audio input
source.
89
DMC Control
Selects whether to allow a DLNA-compatible Digital
Media Controller (DMC) to control playback.
89
En 88
Rename/Icon Select
Changes the input source name and icon displayed on the front display or TV screen.
Input sources
AV1~7, V-AUX, AUDIO1~4, PHONO, USB, DOCK, MULTI CH
Setup procedure
1
Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select an icon and press the cursor key ( ).
2
Press ENTER, use the cursor keys to rename, and then press ENTER again.
3
Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”.
4
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Decoder Mode
Sets the format of digital audio playback to DTS.
For example, if this unit does not detect DTS audio and outputs noise, set “Decoder
Mode” to “DTS”.
Input sources
AV1~7, V-AUX, AUDIO1~4 (available only when any audio digital input jack is assigned)
Settings
Standby Charge
Selects whether to charge the iPod connected to the iPod dock or iPod wireless system
when this unit is in standby mode.
Input sources
DOCK (iPod)
Settings
iPod Interlock
Selects whether to control this unit in conjunction with operations of the iPod connected
to the iPod wireless system.
Input sources
DOCK (iPod)
This function is available only when an iPod wireless system is connected to this unit.
Power & Input
Selects whether to control the power and input source selection of this unit in
conjunction with iPod operations.
Settings
When “Power & Input” is set to “On”, the iPod connected to the iPod wireless system is charged regardless
of the “Standby Charge” setting (p.88).
Volume
Selects whether to control the volume of this unit in conjunction with iPod operations.
Settings
Auto (default) Automatically selects an audio format to match the input audio signal.
DTS Selects DTS only. (Other audio signals are not reproduced.)
On (default) Charges the iPod even when this unit is in standby mode.
Off Does not charge the iPod when this unit is in standby mode.
On (default)
Enables power and input interlocking controls. When you start
playback of the iPod, this unit turns on and “DOCK” is selected as the
input source. When you stop playback, this unit enters standby mode
after a short time.
Off Disables power and input interlocking controls.
On (default)
Enables volume interlocking controls. When you adjust the iPod
volume, the volume of the unit is also adjusted.
Off Disables volume interlocking control.
En 89
Video Out
Selects a video to be output with the audio input source.
Input sources
TUNER, (network sources), USB, MULTI CH
Settings
DMC Control
Selects whether to allow DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control
playback.
Input source
PC
Settings
A Digital Media Controller (DMC) is a device that can control other network devices through the network.
When this function is enabled, you can control playback of this unit from DMCs (Windows Media Player 12,
etc.) on the same network.
You can change the settings of the SCENE function (p.49) using the TV screen.
1
Press ON SCREEN.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Scene” and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select a scene to be configured and
press the cursor key ( ).
You can still switch the scene by using cursor keys ( / ) after step 3.
4
Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select an item and press ENTER.
Off (default) Does not output videos.
AV1~7, V-AUX Outputs videos input through the corresponding video input jacks.
Disable Does not allow DMCs to control playback.
Enable (default) Allows DMCs to control playback.
Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu)
En 90
5
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to change the setting.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Scene menu items
Save
Registers the settings currently applied to this unit (input source, sound program, etc.)
to the selected scene.
If you have changed the input assignment for a scene, you also need to change the external device
assigned to the corresponding SCENE key (p.50).
Load
Loads the settings registered to the selected scene.
Select “DETAIL” to configure the SCENE link playback setting, select items to be
included as the scene assignments, or view the settings currently assigned to the
selected scene.
Device Control
Enables to start playback of external devices connected to this unit via HDMI or a
Yamaha product connected to the REMOTE OUT jack, in conjunction with a scene
selection (SCENE link playback)
Settings
Default
SCENE1 (BD/DVD), SCENE2 (TV): HDMI Control
SCENE3 (CD): IR: Yamaha CD
SCENE4 (RADIO), SCENE5~12: Off
To control playback of an HDMI Control-compatible device by SCENE link playback, you need to set “HDMI
Control” in the “Setup” menu to “On” and perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.131).
Item Function Page
Save
Registers the settings currently applied to this unit to the
selected scene.
90
Load
Loads the settings registered to the selected scene. You
can also configure the SCENE link playback setting, select
items to be included as the scene assignments, or view the
settings currently assigned to the selected scene.
90
Rename/Icon Select Changes the scene name and icon. 91
Reset Restores the default settings for the selected scene. 91
Off Disables the SCENE link playback function.
HDMI Control
Enables SCENE link playback using HDMI Control signals. Select this if
HDMI Control-compatible device (BD/DVD players, etc.) is connected
to this unit via HDMI. It also turns on the HDMI Control-compatible TV
concurrently.
IR: Yamaha BD/DVD 1
Enables SCENE link playback using remote control signals. Select this
if a Yamaha BD/DVD player is connected to the REMOTE OUT jack.
IR: Yamaha BD/DVD 2
Enables SCENE link playback using remote control signals. Select this
if a Yamaha BD/DVD player is connected to the REMOTE OUT jack and
“IR: Yamaha BD/DVD 1” does not work properly.
IR: Yamaha CD
Enables SCENE link playback using remote control signals. Select this
if a Yamaha CD player is connected to the REMOTE OUT jack.
En 91
Detail
Selects items to be included as the scene assignments. You can also view the settings
currently assigned to the selected scene.
To include items as the scene assignments, use the cursor keys to select an item and
press ENTER to check the box (or uncheck the box to exclude).
For example, if you often adjust the volume while watching TV but listen to radio with
low volume at night, exclude “Volume” from the assignments for SCENE2 (TV) and
include “Volume” in the assignments for SCENE4 (RADIO).
Choices
Default
Input, HDMI Output, Mode, Sound: selected
Surround, Video, Volume, Lipsync, Speaker Setup: not selected
Rename/Icon Select
Changes the scene name and icon displayed on the front display or TV screen.
Setup procedure
1
Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select an icon and press the cursor key ( ).
2
Press ENTER, use the cursor keys to rename, and then press ENTER again.
3
Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”.
4
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Reset
Restores the default settings (p.49) for the selected scene.
Input Input (p.48), Audio Select (p.86)
HDMI Output HDMI Output (p.48)
Mode Sound Program (p.51), Pure Direct Mode (p.102)
Sound Tone Control (p.85), Adaptive DRC (p.85), Enhancer (p.55)
Surround
CINEMA DSP 3D Mode (p.85), Dialogue Lift (p.85),
Extended Surround (p.86)
Video Video Processing (p.103)
Volume Master Volume (p.48)
Lipsync Lipsync (p.101), Delay (p.101)
Speaker Setup Setting Pattern (p.98), PEQ Select (p.100)
Check or uncheck
En 92
You can change the settings of the sound programs and surround decoders using the
TV screen.
1
Press ON SCREEN.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Sound Program” and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select a sound program to be
configured and press the cursor key ( ).
You can still switch the sound program by using cursor keys ( / ) after step 3.
4
Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select an item and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
To restore the default settings for the selected sound program, select “Reset”.
5
Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Configuring sound programs/surround
decoders (Sound Program menu)
En 93
Sound Program menu items
Available items vary depending on the selected sound program or surround decoder.
Settings for sound programs
The following items are available when you select “2ch Stereo” or “7ch Stereo”.
Available items in “7ch Stereo” vary depending on the speaker system being used.
Item Function Settings
Decode Type
Selects a surround decoder to be used
in combination with the selected sound
program.
PLIIx Movie ( PLII
Movie), Neo:6 Cinema
DSP Level Adjusts the sound field effect level.
-6dB ~ +3dB (default: 0dB)
Higher to enhance the
sound field effect and lower
to reduce.
Initial Delay
Adjusts the delay between the direct
sound and presence sound field
generation.
1ms ~ 99ms
Higher to enhance the delay
effect and lower to reduce.
Surround Initial Delay
Adjusts the delay between the direct
sound and surround sound field
generation.
1ms ~ 49ms
Higher to enhance the delay
effect and lower to reduce.
Surround Back Initial
Delay
Adjusts the delay between the direct
sound and surround back sound field
generation.
Room Size
Adjusts the broadening effect of the
presence sound field.
0.1 ~ 2.0
Higher to enhance the
broadening effect and lower
to reduce.
Surround Room Size
Adjusts the broadening effect of the
surround sound field.
Surround Back Room
Size
Adjusts the broadening effect of the
surround back sound field.
Liveness
Adjusts the loss of the presence sound
field.
0 ~ 10
Higher to enhance the
reflectivity and lower to
reduce.
Surround Liveness
Adjusts the loss of the surround sound
field.
Surround Back
Liveness
Adjusts the loss of the surround back
sound field.
Reverb Time
Adjust the decay time of the reverberant
sound.
1.0s ~ 5.0s
Higher to enrich the
reverberant sound and
lower to have clear sound.
Reverb Delay
Adjusts the delay between the direct
sound and reverberant sound
generation.
0 ms ~ 250ms
Higher to enhance the delay
effect and lower to reduce.
Reverb Level
Adjusts the volume of the reverberant
sound.
0% ~ 100%
Higher to strengthen the
reverberant sound and
lower to weaken.
Sound
program
Item Function Settings
2ch Stereo Direct
Selects whether to
automatically bypass the DSP
and tone control circuits when
an analog audio source is
played back.
Auto (default), Off
Select “Auto” to
bypass the circuits
(when both “Treble”
and “Bass” are set to
“Bypass”).
7ch Stereo
Center Level
Adjusts the volume of the
center channel.
0% ~ 100%
(default: 100%)
Surround L Level
Adjusts the volume of the
surround left channel.
Surround R Level
Adjusts the volume of the
surround right channel.
Surround Back Level
Adjusts the volume of the
surround back channel.
0% ~ 100%
(default: 50%)
Surround Back L
Level
Adjusts the volume of the
surround back left channel.
0% ~ 100%
(default: 35%)
Surround Back R
Level
Adjusts the volume of the
surround back right channel.
Front Presence L Level
Adjusts the volume of the front
presence left channel.
0% ~ 100%
(default: 33%)
Front Presence R Level
Adjusts the volume of the front
presence right channel.
Item Function Settings
En 94
Settings for decoders
The following items are available when you set “Decode Type” of “Surround Decoder”
to “PLIIx Music” or “Neo:6 Music”.
Decode Type Item Function Settings
PLIIx Music
Panorama
Adjusts the broadening
effect of the front sound
field.
Off (default), On
Select “On” to wrap front right/left
channel sounds around the field
and generate a spacious sound
field in combination with the
surround sound field.
Center Width
Adjusts the broadening
effect of the center
sound field.
0 ~ 7 (default: 3)
Higher to enhance the broadening
effect and lower to reduce (closer
to center).
Dimension
Adjusts the difference in
level between the front
and surround sound
fields.
-3 ~ +3 (default: 0)
Higher to strengthen the front
sound field and lower to
strengthen the surround sound
field.
Neo:6 Music Center Image
Adjusts the center
orientation level
(broadening effect) of
the front sound field.
0.0 ~ 1.0 (default: 0.3)
Higher to strengthen the center
orientation level (less broadening
effect) and lower to weaken (more
broadening effect).
En 95
You can configure the various functions of this unit using the TV screen.
1
Press ON SCREEN.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select a menu.
4
Use the cursor keys
(/)
to select an item and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
5
Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Configuring various functions (Setup menu)
En 96
Setup menu items
Menu Item Function Page
Speaker
Auto Setup Optimizes the speaker settings automatically (YPAO). 41
Manual Setup
Setting Pattern Registers two speaker setting patterns and switches between them. 98
Setting Data Copy Copies the “Setting Pattern” parameters in the specified direction. 98
Power Amp Assign Selects a speaker system. 98
Configuration
Front Selects the size of the front speakers. 98
Center Selects whether or not a center speaker is connected and its size. 99
Surround Selects whether or not surround speakers are connected and its size. 99
Surround Back Selects whether or not surround back speakers are connected and its size. 99
Front Presence Selects whether or not front presence speakers are connected. 99
Subwoofer Selects whether or not a subwoofer is connected and its phase. 99
Extra Bass Sets the speakers to produce the front channel low-frequency components. 99
Bass Cross Over Sets the lower limit of low-frequency component produced from speakers of which the size is set to “Small”. 100
Distance Sets the distance between each speaker and listening position. 100
Level Adjusts the volume of each speaker. 100
Parametric EQ
PEQ Select Selects a type of equalizer to be used. 100
PEQ Data Copy Copies the parametric equalizer values acquired with “Auto Setup” to the “Manual” fields for fine adjustment. 100
Test Tone Enables/disabled the test tone output. 101
Sound
Lipsync Adjusts the delay between video and audio output. 101
Dynamic Range Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for bitstream audio (Dolby Digital and DTS signals) playback. 102
Max Volume Sets the maximum volume so that sound is not too loud. 102
Initial Volume Sets the initial volume for when this receiver is turned on. 102
Pure Direct Mode Selects whether to output video signals during the Pure Direct mode. 102
Adaptive DSP Level Selects whether to automatically adjust the CINEMA DSP effect level in conjunction with volume adjustments. 102
Video
Analog to Analog Conversion Enables/disables the video conversion between the analog video jacks. 102
Processing Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio). 103
HDMI
HDMI Control Enables/disables HDMI Control. You can also configure the relevant settings (ARC, TV audio input, etc). 103
Audio Output Selects a device to output audio. 104
Standby Through Select whether to output videos/audio (input through HDMI jacks) to the TV when this unit is in standby mode. 104
En 97
Network
IP Address Configures the network parameters (IP address, etc). 105
Network Standby Selects whether or not to turn on this unit by the command from other network devices. 105
MAC Address Filter Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to this unit from other network devices. 105
Multi Zone
Zone2 Set
Vol ume Enables/disables volume adjustments for Zone2 output. 106
Max Volume Sets the Zone2 maximum volume so that sound is not too loud. 106
Initial Volume Sets the Zone2 initial volume for when this unit is turned on. 106
Mono Switches between stereo and monaural for Zone2 output. 106
Monitor Out Assign Select the zone for which the MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT jacks are used. 106
Party Mode Set Enables/disables switching to the party mode. 106
Zone Scene Rename Changes the scene names (for Zone2) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 106
Zone Rename Changes the zone names displayed on the front display or TV screen. 107
Function
Auto Power Down Sets the amount of time for auto-standby. 107
Input Assignment Assigns the COMPONENT VIDEO, COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks to another input source. 108
Display Set
Front Panel Display
Dimmer Adjusts the brightness of the front display. 108
Scroll Sets the scrolling manner of the front display. 108
Short Message Selects whether to display short messages on the TV screen when this unit is operated. 108
Wall Paper Selects a wall paper displayed on the TV. 108
Trigger Output1
Trigger Output2
Trigger Mode Specifies the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function. 109
Target Zone Specifies the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions synchronized. 109
Target Source Specifies the output level of the electronic signal transmitted with each input switching. 109
Manual Switches the output level for electronic signal transmission manually. 109
Memory Guard Prevents accidental changes to the settings. 109
Language Select an on-screen menu language. 110
Menu Item Function Page
En 98
Speaker (Manual Setup)
Configures the speaker settings manually.
Setting Pattern
Registers two speaker setting patterns and switches between them.
When you configure the following speaker settings, the settings will be memorized in
the selected pattern.
- Measurement results (Auto Setup)
- Power Amp Assign
- Configuration
- Distance
- Level
- Parametric EQ
Settings
Pattern1 (default), Pattern2
The setting pattern currently selected is shown at the top of the “Auto Setup” and “Manual Setup” screens.
Setting Data Copy
Copies the “Setting Pattern” parameters in the specified direction.
Choices
Power Amp Assign
Selects a speaker system.
This unit has 7 built-in amplifiers. You can connect 2 to 9 speakers and up to 2
subwoofers (with built-in amplifier) to create the favorite acoustic space in your room.
You can also apply bi-amp connections, channel expansion (using an external power
amplifier) or multi-zone configurations to enhance your system.
Settings
Configuration
Configures the output characteristics of the speakers.
When you configure the speaker size, select “Large” if the woofer diameter of your speaker is 16 cm or
larger or “Small” if it is smaller than 16 cm.
Front
Selects the size of the front speakers.
Settings
“Front” is automatically set to “Large” when “Subwoofer” is set to “None”.
Pattern1 > 2 Copies the “Pattern1” parameters to “Pattern2”.
Pattern2 > 1 Copies the “Pattern2” parameters to “Pattern1”.
Basic (default)
Select this when you use the basic speaker configuration (7-channel
plus front presence speakers) (p.15).
7ch +1ZONE
Select this when you use 7-channel speakers in the main zone and
Zone2 speakers (p.21).
5ch BI-AMP
Select this when you use 5-channel speakers (including bi-amp front
speakers) (p.20).
5ch BI-AMP +SB
Select this when you use 5-channel speakers (including bi-amp front
speakers) plus surround back channel expansion using an external
amplifier (p.21).
Large
Select this for large speakers.
The front speakers will produce all of the front channel frequency
components.
Small (default)
Select this for small speakers.
The subwoofer will produce front channel low-frequency components
(configurable in “Bass Cross Over”).
En 99
Center
Selects whether or not a center speaker is connected and its size.
Settings
Surround
Selects whether or not surround speakers are connected and its size.
Settings
Surround Back
Selects whether or not surround back speakers are connected and its size.
Settings
“Surround Back” is automatically set to “None” when “Surround” is set to “None”.
Front Presence
Selects whether or not front presence speakers are connected.
Settings
Subwoofer
Selects whether or not subwoofer is connected and its phase.
Settings
When the bass sound is lacking or unclear, switch the subwoofer phase.
Extra Bass
Sets the speakers to produce the front channel low-frequency components.
Settings
This setting is not available when “Subwoofer” is set to “None” or “Front” is set to “Small”.
Large
Select this for large speaker.
The center speaker will produce all of the center channel frequency
components.
Small (default)
Select this for small speaker.
The subwoofer will produce center channel low-frequency components
(configurable in “Bass Cross Over”).
None
Select this when no center speaker is connected.
The front speakers will produce center channel audio.
Large
Select this for large speakers.
The surround speakers will produce all of the surround channel
frequency components.
Small (default)
Select this for small speakers.
The subwoofer will produce surround channel low-frequency
components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”).
None
Select this when no surround speakers are connected.
The front speakers will produce surround channel audio. Virtual
CINEMA DSP works when you select a sound program.
Large x1
Select this when 1 large speaker is connected.
The surround back speaker will produce all of the surround back channel
frequency components.
Large x2
Select this when 2 large speakers are connected.
The surround back speakers will produce all of the surround back channel
frequency components.
Small x1
Select this when 1 small speaker is connected.
The subwoofer will produce surround back channel low-frequency
components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”).
Small x2
(default)
Select this when 2 small speakers are connected.
The subwoofer will produce surround back channel low-frequency
components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”).
None
Select this when no surround back speakers are connected.
The surround speakers and subwoofer (or front speakers) will produce
surround back channel audio.
Use (default) Select this when front presence speakers are connected.
None Select this when no front presence speakers are connected.
Use
Normal
(default)
Select this when a subwoofer is connected (not to reverse the phase).
The subwoofer will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio
and low-frequency components from other channels.
Reverse
Select this when a subwoofer is connected (reverse the phase). The
subwoofer will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and
low-frequency components from other channels.
None
Select this when no subwoofer is connected. The front speakers will
produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and low-frequency
components from other channels.
Off (default)
Depending on the size of the front speakers, either the subwoofer or
front speakers produce the front channel low-frequency components.
On
Both the front speakers and subwoofer produce the front channel low-
frequency components.
En 100
Bass Cross Over
Sets the lower limit of low-frequency component produced from speakers of which the
size is set to “Small”. A frequency sound lower than the specified value will be
produced from the subwoofer or front speakers.
Settings
40Hz, 60Hz, 80Hz (default), 90Hz, 100Hz, 110Hz, 120Hz, 160Hz, 200Hz
If the volume and cross-over frequency are adjustable on your subwoofer, set the volume to half and cross-
over frequency to maximum.
Distance
Sets the distance between each speaker and listening position so that sounds from the
speakers reach the listening position at the same time. First, select the unit of distance
from “Meter” or “Feet”.
Choices
Front L, Front R, Center, Surround L, Surround R, Surround Back L, Surround Back R, Front
Presence L, Front Presence R, Subwoofer
Setting range
0.30m ~ 24.00m (1.0ft ~ 80.0ft) *0.05m (0.2ft) steps
Default
3.00m (10.0ft)
Level
Adjusts the volume of each speaker.
Choices
Front L, Front R, Center, Surround L, Surround R, Surround Back L, Surround Back R, Front
Presence L, Front Presence R, Subwoofer
Setting range
-10.0dB ~ +10.0dB (0.5dB steps)
Default
0.0dB
Parametric EQ
Adjusts sound quality of tone with an equalizer.
PEQ Select
Selects a type of equalizer to be used.
Settings
“YPAO:Flat”, “YPAO:Front” and “YPAO:Natural” are available only when the measurement results of “Auto
Setup” have already been saved (p.41).
PEQ Data Copy
Copies the parametric equalizer values acquired with “Auto Setup” (p.41) to the
“Manual” fields for fine adjustment.
Choices
Manual equalizer adjustment
1
Set “PEQ Select” to “Manual” and press ENTER.
2
Use the cursor keys to select a speaker and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER.
Band / Gain:
You can select a center frequency from the preset 7 bands and adjust the gain.
Freq. / Gain: You can adjust the center frequency of the selected band and adjust the gain.
Q / Gain: You can adjust the Q factor (bandwidth) of the selected band and adjust the gain.
Clear: Restores the default settings for the selected speaker.
Manual
Select this when you want to adjust the equalizer manually.
For details, see “Manual equalizer adjustment”.
YPAO:Flat Adjusts individual speakers to achieve the same characteristics.
YPAO:Front
Adjusts individual speakers to achieve the characteristics same as the
front speakers.
YPAO:Natural Adjusts all speakers to achieve a natural sound.
Through Does not use the equalizer.
Flat > Manual Copies the “Flat” values acquired with “Auto Setup”.
Front > Manual Copies the “Front” values acquired with “Auto Setup”.
Natural > Manual Copies the “Natural” values acquired with “Auto Setup”.
En 101
4
Use the cursor keys to adjust parameters and press ENTER.
Setting range
Gain: -20.0dB ~ +6.0dB (0.5dB steps)
Center frequency: 31.3Hz ~ 16.0kHz
Q factor: 0.500 ~ 10.08
5
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Test Tone
Enables/disabled the test tone output. Test tone output helps you to adjust the speaker
balance or equalizer while confirming its effect.
Settings
Sound
Configures the audio output settings.
Lipsync
Adjusts the delay between video and audio output.
Auto
Adjusts the delay between video and audio output automatically when a TV that
supports an automatic lipsync function is connected to this unit via HDMI. If necessary,
you can fine-adjust the audio output timing. “Offset” shows the difference between
automatic adjustment and fine adjustment.
Setting range
0ms ~ 250ms (1ms steps)
Default
0ms
Manual
Adjusts the delay between video and audio output manually.
Setting range
0ms ~ 250ms (1ms steps)
Default
0ms
Off (default) Does not output test tones.
On
Outputs test tones automatically when you adjust the speaker balance,
equalizer, etc.
En 102
Dynamic Range
Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for bitstream audio (Dolby Digital and
DTS signals) playback.
Settings
Max Volume
Sets the maximum volume so that sound is not too loud.
Setting range
-30.0dB ~ +15.0dB (5.0dB steps), +16.5dB
Default
+16.5dB
Initial Volume
Sets the initial volume for when this receiver is turned on.
Settings
Pure Direct Mode
Selects whether to output video signals during the Pure Direct mode (p.55).
Settings
Adaptive DSP Level
Selects whether to automatically adjust the CINEMA DSP effect level in conjunction with
volume adjustments.
Settings
Video
Configures the video output settings.
Analog to Analog Conversion
Enables/disables the video conversion (p.130) between the analog video jacks
(COMPONENT VIDEO, S VIDEO and VIDEO).
Settings
This function does not work when “Monitor Out Assign” (p.106) is set to “Zone2”.
This unit does not convert 480-line and 576-line video signals interchangeably.
480p/576p-, 1080i- and 720p-resolution video signals cannot be output from the S VIDEO and VIDEO
jacks (p.130).
Maximum (default) Produces audio without adjusting the dynamic range.
Standard Optimizes the dynamic range for regular home use.
Minimum/Auto
Sets the dynamic range to make clear sound even at night or at low
volumes.
When playing back Dolby TrueHD signals, the dynamic range is
automatically adjusted based on the input signal information.
Off (default) Sets at the level when this unit last entered standby mode.
On
Sets at Mute, or -80.0dB ~ +16.5dB (0.5dB steps). (This setting works
only when “Max Volume” is set higher.)
Auto (default)
Automatically outputs video signals when any videos are input from the
selected input source or an input source that can be operated with the
on-screen display is selected. When no video signals are input, the wall
paper is displayed.
Video Off Does not output video signals including the wall paper.
Off Does not adjust the effect level automatically.
On (default) Adjusts the effect level automatically.
Off Disables the video conversion between the analog video jacks.
On (default)
Enables the video conversion between the analog video jacks.
Converted video signals are output from the MONITOR OUT jacks only.
En 103
Processing
Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio).
Settings
720p-, 1080i- and 1080p-resolution video signals cannot be converted (p.130).
Resolution
Selects a resolution to output HDMI video signals when “Processing” is set to “On”.
Settings
If you need to select a resolution that is not supported by your TV, set “MONITOR CHECK” (p.113) in the
“ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “SKIP” and try again. (Note that output videos may not be displayed on your
TV normally.)
Aspect
Selects an aspect ratio to output HDMI video signals when “Processing” is set to “On”.
Settings
This setting functions only when 480i/576i or 480p/576p signals are converted into 720p, 1080i or 1080p
signals.
HDMI
Configures the settings related to HDMI.
HDMI Control
Enables/disables HDMI Control (p.131).
Settings
To use HDMI control, you need to perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.131) after connecting HDMI
Control-compatible devices.
TV Audio Input
Selects an audio input jack of this unit to be used for TV audio input when “HDMI
Control” is set to “On”. The input source of this unit automatically switches to TV audio
(input jack selected in here) when the TV input is switched to its built-in tuner.
Settings
AUDIO1~4
Default
AUDIO1
When using ARC to input TV audio to this unit, you cannot use the input jacks selected in here for
connecting an external device because the input will be used for TV audio input.
Off (default) Disables the video signal processing.
On
Enables the video signal processing.
Select a resolution and an aspect ratio in “Resolution” and “Aspect”.
Through Does not convert the resolution.
Auto (default)
Selects a resolution automatically in accordance with TV
resolution.
480p/576p, 720p, 1080i,
1080p
Output video signals with a selected resolution.
(Only the resolutions supported by your TV are selectable.)
Through (default) Does not convert the aspect ratio.
16:9 Normal
Outputs 4:3 video signals to a 16:9 TV with black bands on either
side of the screen.
Off (default) Disables HDMI Control.
On
Enables HDMI Control.
Configure the settings in “TV Audio Input”, “ARC” and
“Standby Sync”.
En 104
ARC
Enables/disables ARC (p.25) when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”.
Settings
You do not need to change this setting normally. In case noises are produced from the speakers connected
to this unit because TV audio signals input to this unit via ARC are not supported by this unit, set “ARC” to
“Off” and use the TV speaker.
Standby Sync
Select whether to set this unit to standby in conjunction with TV power-off when “HDMI
Control” is set to “On”.
Settings
Audio Output
Selects a device to output audio.
The “Amp” and “HDMI OUT1” settings are available only when “HDMI Control” is set to “Off”.
Amp
Enables/disables the audio output from the speakers connected to this unit.
Settings
HDMI OUT1, HDMI OUT2
Enables/disables the audio output from a TV connected to the HDMI OUT 1 jack or
HDMI OUT 2 jack.
Settings
Standby Through
Select whether to output videos/audio (input through HDMI jacks) to the TV when this
unit is in standby mode.
Settings
This setting is available only when “HDMI Control” is set to “Off”.
Off Disables ARC.
On (default) Enables ARC.
Off
Does not set this unit to standby mode in conjunction with TV
power-off.
On
Sets this unit to standby mode in conjunction with TV power-
off.
Auto (default)
Sets this unit to standby mode in conjunction with TV power-off
only when this unit is receiving TV audio or HDMI signals.
Off Disables the audio output from the speakers.
On (default) Enables the audio output from the speakers.
Off (default) Disables the audio output from the TV.
On Enables the audio output from the TV.
Off (default) Does not output videos/audio to the TV.
On
Outputs videos/audio to the TV.
(This unit consumes approximately 3 W of power.)
En 105
Network
Configures the network settings.
IP Address
Configures the network parameters (IP address, etc).
DHCP
Select whether to use a DHCP server.
Settings
Manual Setup
Configures the network parameters of this unit manually when “DHCP” is set to “Off”.
Submenu
Network Standby
Selects whether to turn on this unit by the command from other network devices
(network standby).
Settings
MAC Address Filter
Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to this unit from other network devices.
Mode
Enables/disables the MAC address filter.
Settings
Address Setup
Specifies the MAC addresses (up to 10) of the network devices that will be permitted
access to this unit when “Mode” is set to “On”.
Off
Does not use a DHCP server. Configure the network parameters
manually.
On (default)
Uses a DHCP server to automatically obtain the network parameters (IP
address, etc.) of this unit.
IP Address Specifies an IP address.
Subnet Mask Specifies a subnet mask.
Default Gateway Specifies the IP address of the default gateway.
DNS Server (P) Specifies the IP address of the primary DNS server.
DNS Server (S) Specifies the IP address of the secondary DNS server.
Off (default) Disables the network standby function.
On
Enables the network standby function.
(This unit consumes approximately 5 W of power.)
Off (default) Disables the MAC address filter.
On
Enables the MAC address filter. In “Address Setup”, specify the MAC
addresses of the network devices that will be permitted access to this
unit.
En 106
Multi Zone
Configures the multi zone settings.
Zone2 Set
Configures the audio output settings for Zone2.
Volume
Enables/disables volume adjustments for Zone2 output.
Settings
This setting is available only when Zone2 speakers are connected to this unit via an external amplifier
(p.76).
Max Volume
Sets the Zone2 maximum volume so that sound is not too loud.
Setting range
-30.0dB ~ +15.0dB (5.0dB steps), +16.5dB
Default
+16.5dB
Initial Volume
Sets the Zone2 initial volume for when this unit is turned on.
Settings
Mono
Switches between stereo and monaural for Zone2 output.
Settings
Monitor Out Assign
Select the zone for which the MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO, S
VIDEO and VIDEO) jacks are used.
Settings
Main (default), Zone2
The video conversion between the analog video jacks does not work for Zone2 video output. To watch
videos played back on a video device on the Zone2 video monitor, you need to connect the video monitor to
this unit in the same way as the video device.
Party Mode Set
Enables/disables switching to the party mode (p.79).
Choice
Target: Zone 2
Settings
Zone Scene Rename
Changes the scene names (for Zone2) displayed on the front display or TV screen.
Setup procedure
1
While “Zone2” is selected, press ENTER.
2
Use the cursor keys to select a scene to be renamed and press ENTER.
Fixed Disables volume adjustments for Zone2 output.
Variable (default) Enables volume adjustments for Zone2 output.
Off (default) Sets at the level when this unit last entered standby mode.
On
Sets at Mute, or -80.0dB ~ +16.5dB (0.5dB steps).
(This setting works only when “Max Volume” is set higher.)
Off (default) Produces stereo sounds in Zone2.
On Produces monaural sounds in Zone2.
Disable Disables switching to the party mode.
Enable (default)
Enables switching to the party mode. You can turn on/off the party
mode by pressing PARTY on the remote control.
En 107
3
Press ENTER, use the cursor keys to rename, and then press ENTER again.
4
Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”.
5
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Zone Rename
Changes the zone names displayed on the front display or TV screen.
Setup procedure
1
Use the cursor keys to select a zone to be renamed and press ENTER.
2
Press ENTER, use the cursor keys to rename, and then press ENTER again.
3
Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”.
4
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Function
Configures the functions that make this unit easier to use.
Auto Power Down
Sets the amount of time for auto-standby. If you do not operate this unit for the specified
time, this unit will automatically go into standby mode.
Settings
Default
Europe model: 8 Hours
Other models: Off
Off Does not set this unit to standby mode automatically.
4 Hours, 8 Hours,
12 Hours
Sets this unit to standby mode when you have not operated this unit for the
specified time.
En 108
Input Assignment
Assigns the COMPONENT VIDEO, COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks to another input
source.
Setup procedure
Example: assigning the OPTICAL (e) jack to the input source “AV2”
1
Use the cursor keys to select the cell at the intersection of “AV2” and “Optical”, and
press ENTER.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “e” and press ENTER.
3
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
You cannot assign both COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks to the same input source.
Display Set
Configures the settings related to the front display and TV screen display.
Front Panel Display
Configures the front display settings.
Dimmer
Adjusts the brightness of the front display.
Setting range
-4 ~ 0 (higher to brighten)
Default
0
Scroll
Sets the scrolling manner of the front display.
The display scrolls automatically if the text exceeds 14 characters.
Settings
Short Message
Selects whether to display short messages on the TV screen when this unit is operated
(input selection, volume adjustment, etc).
Settings
Wall Paper
Selects a wall paper displayed on the TV.
Settings
Continue (default) Sets the display to scroll continuously.
Once
Sets the display to scroll all characters once and then halt scrolling for
display of the first 14 characters.
On (default) Displays short messages on the TV screen.
Off Does not display short messages on the TV screen.
Picture1, Picture2, Picture3
Displays the selected image on the TV screen when there
is no video signal.
Gray
Displays a gray background on the TV screen when there
is no video signal.
En 109
Trigger Output1, Trigger Output2
Sets the TRIGGER OUT 1~2 jacks to function synchronized with power status of each
zone or input switching.
Trigger Mode
Specifies the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function.
Settings
Target Zone
Specifies the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions synchronized.
Settings
Target Source
Specifies the output level of the electronic signal transmitted with each input switching
when “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”.
Choices
AV1~7, V-AUX, AUDIO1~4, PHONO, TUNER, (network sources), USB, DOCK, MULTI CH
Settings
Manual
Switches the output level for electronic signal transmission manually when “Trigger
Mode” is set to “Manual”. This setting can also be used to confirm proper function of
the external component connected via the TRIGGER OUT jack.
Choices
Memory Guard
Prevents accidental changes to the settings.
Settings
Power (default)
The TRIGGER OUT jack functions synchronized with the power status of the zone
specified with “Target Zone.”
Source
The TRIGGER OUT jack functions synchronized with the input switching in
the zone specified with “Target Zone.”
Electronic signal is transmitted according to the setting made in “Target
Source.”
Manual
Select this to manually switch the output level for electronic signal transmission with
“Manual.”
Main
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission is
synchronized with power status of the main zone.
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission is
synchronized with input switching in the main zone.
Zone2
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission is
synchronized with power status of Zone2.
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission is
synchronized with input switching in Zone2.
All (default)
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission is
synchronized with power status of the main zone or Zone2.
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission is
synchronized with input switching in the main zone or Zone2.
Low
Stops the electronic signal transmission when you switch to the input source
specified in this option.
High (default)
Transmits the electronic signal when you switch to the input source
specified in this option.
Low Stops the electronic signal transmission.
High (default) Transmits the electronic signal.
Off (default) Does not protect the settings.
On Protects the settings until “Off” is selected.
En 110
Language
Select an on-screen menu language.
Settings
The information on the front display is provided in English only.
You can view information about this unit using the TV screen.
1
Press ON SCREEN.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Information” and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select an information type.
4
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
English (default) English
Japanese
French
German
Spanish
Russian
Français
Deutsch
Español
Viewing information about this unit
(Information menu)
En 111
Types of information
Audio Signal
Displays information about the current audio signal.
Even when this unit is set to output bitstream signals directly, the signal may be converted depending on
the specifications and settings of the playback device.
Video Signal
Displays information about the current video signal.
HDMI Monitor
Displays information about the TVs connected to the HDMI OUT jacks.
Use the cursor keys ( / ) to switch between “OUT1” and “OUT2”.
Network
Displays the network information on this unit.
System
Displays the system information on this unit.
If this unit detects a newer firmware over the network, “!” (exclamation mark) appears at the upper right of
the “Information” and “System” icons, and the corresponding message will be displayed in this screen. You
can update the firmware of this unit by pressing ENTER in this screen and following the procedure in
“Updating the firmware of this unit” (p.119).
Zone
Displays information about Zone2.
Input
Format Audio format of the input signal
Channel
The number of source channels in the input signal (front/
surround/LFE)
For example, “5.1 (3/2/0.1)” means 5.1ch in total (3 front
channels, 2 surround channels, and LFE).
Sampling The number of samples per second of the input digital signal
Bitrate The amount of data per second of the input bitstream signal
Dialogue The dialogue normalization level of the input bitstream signal
Output The speaker terminals from which signals are output
HDMI Signal Presence or absence of HDMI signal input/output
HDMI Resolution Resolutions of input signal (analog or HDMI) and output signal (HDMI)
Analog Resolution
Resolutions of input signal (analog) and signal output at the MONITOR
OUT jacks (analog)
HDMI Error
Errors related to HDMI
HDCP Error: The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital
Content Protection).
Device Over: The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack is
over the limit.
Interface TV interface
Video Resolution Resolutions supported by the TV
IP Address IP address
Subnet Mask Subnet mask
Default Gateway The IP address of the default gateway
DNS Server (P) The IP address of the primary DNS server
DNS Server (S) The IP address of the secondary DNS server
MAC Address MAC address
Status Network connection status
Remote ID The remote control ID setting of the main unit (p.113)
TV Format The video signal type setting of this unit (p.113)
Speaker Impedance The speaker impedance setting of this unit (p.112)
System ID System ID number
Firmware Version The version of firmware installed on this unit
Input The input source selected for Zone2
Volume The volume setting for Zone2
En 112
You can configure the system settings of this unit using the front display.
1
Set this unit to standby mode.
2
While holding down STRAIGHT on the font panel, press MAIN ZONE .
3
Press PROGRAM to select an item.
4
Press STRAIGHT to select a setting.
5
Press MAIN ZONE to set this unit to standby mode and turn it on
again.
The new settings become effective.
ADVANCED SETUP menu items
Changing the speaker impedance setting (SPEAKER IMP.)
Change the speaker impedance settings of unit depending on the impedance of the
speakers connected.
Settings
Configuring the system settings
(ADVANCED SETUP menu)
MAIN ZONE
PROGRAM
STRAIGHT
Item Function Page
SPEAKER IMP. Changes the speaker impedance setting. 112
REMOTE SENSOR
Turns on/off of the remote control sensor on the main
unit.
113
REMOTE CON AMP Selects the remote control ID of the main unit. 113
TV FORMAT Switches the video signal type. 113
MONITOR CHECK Removes the limitation on HDMI video output. 113
RECOV./BACKUP
Creates backup of the settings of this unit, or recovers
the settings from the backup.
114
INITIALIZE Restores the default settings. 114
FIRM UPDATE Updates the firmware. 114
VERSION
Checks the version of firmware currently installed on
this unit.
114
6 Ω MIN
Select this when you connect 6-ohm speakers to this unit. You can also
use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers.
8 Ω MIN (default) Select this when you connect 8-ohm or higher speakers to this unit.
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSB PR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
8MIN
SPEAKERIMP.
SPIMP.-
En 113
Turning on/off the remote control sensor
(REMOTE SENSOR)
Turn on/off the remote control sensor on the main unit. While the remote control sensor
is turned off, you cannot control this unit from the remote control.
Settings
Selecting the remote control ID (REMOTE CON AMP)
Select the remote control ID of the main unit so that it matches to the ID of the remote
control (default: ID1). When using multiple Yamaha AV receivers, you can set each
remote control with a unique remote control ID for its corresponding receiver.
Settings
ID1 (default), ID2
Changing the remote control ID of the remote control
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be
automatically canceled.
1
Press CODE SET on the remote control using a pointed object such as the tip of a
ballpoint pen.
2
Press SOURCE/RECEIVER.
3
Use the numeric keys to enter “5019” (ID1) or “5020” (ID2).
Once the remote control ID is registered successfully, SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice.
If it blinks 6 times, registration failed. Repeat from step 1.
The registered remote control codes (p.115) are not cleared even if you change the remote control ID.
Switching the video signal type (TV FORMAT)
Switch the video signal type of this unit so that it matches to the format of your TV.
Settings
NTSC, PAL
Default
Canada model: NTSC
Other models: PAL
Removing the limitation on HDMI video output
(MONITOR CHECK)
This unit automatically detects resolutions supported by a TV connected to the HDMI
OUT jacks.
If you want to select a resolution in “Resolution” (p.103) regardless of the detection
results or if this unit does not detect it correctly, disable the monitor check function.
Settings
In case this unit becomes inoperable because videos from this unit cannot be displayed on the TV after
“MONITOR CHECK” is set to “SKIP”, reset the setting to “YES”.
ON (default) Turns on the remote control sensor.
OFF Turns off the remote control sensor.
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSB PR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
ON
REMOTESENSOR
SPIMP.-
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSB PR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
ID1
REMOTECONAMP
SPIMP.-
YES (default)
Enables the monitor check function. (Outputs video signals with a
resolution supported by the TV only.)
SKIP
Disables the monitor check function. (Outputs video signals with a
specified resolution regardless of compatibility with the TV.)
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
3
ZONE
2
STEREO
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
PAL
TVFORMAT
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSB PR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
YES
MONITORCHECK
SPIMP.-
En 114
Backing up/recovering the settings (RECOV./BACKUP)
Creates backup of the settings of this unit, or recovers the settings from the backup.
Backup/recovery procedure
1
Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select “BACKUP” or “”RECOVERY” and press INFO
to start the process.
Choices
Restoring the default settings (INITIALIZE)
Restores the default settings for the selected item.
Choices
Updating the firmware (FIRM UPDATE)
New firmware will be released irregularly for the purpose of additional features or
product improvements. It can be downloaded from our website. If this unit is connected
to the Internet, you can download the firmware via the network. For details, refer to the
information supplied with updates.
Firmware update procedure
Do not perform this procedure unless firmware update is necessary. Also, make sure
you read the information supplied with updates before updating the firmware.
1
Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select “USB” or “NETWORK” and press INFO to start
firmware update.
Choices
If this unit detects a newer firmware over the network, the corresponding message will be displayed after
ON SCREEN is pressed. In this case, you can also update the firmware of this unit by following the
procedure in “Updating the firmware of this unit” (p.119).
Checking the firmware version (VERSION)
Check the version of firmware currently installed on this unit.
You can also check the firmware version in “System” (p.111) in the “Information” menu.
BACKUP Creates backup of the settings of this unit in the internal memory.
RECOVERY
Recovers the settings of this unit from the backup (available only when
backup has been created).
Note
Do not turn off this unit during the recovery process. Otherwise, the settings may not be restored
correctly.
The backup does not contain user information (user account, password, etc.) or unit-specific
information (MAC address, IP address, etc).
VIDEO Restores the default settings for video configurations.
ALL Restores the default settings for this unit.
CANCEL Does not perform an initialization.
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSB PR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
BACKUP
RECOV./BACKUP
SPIMP.-
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSB PR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
CANCEL
INITIALIZE
SPIMP.-
USB Update the firmware using a USB memory device.
NETWORK Update the firmware via the network.
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSB PR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
USB
FIRMUPDATE
SPIMP.-
OUT
1
IN
OUT
2
VOLUME
MUTE
DRCADAPTIVE
3
ZONE
2
SBLPL SBRSB PR
SW1
SL
SW2SW
SR
PL
CL R
PR
STEREO
ENHANCER
SLEEP
HD
TUNED
PRE
AMP
PAR TY
ZONE
3
ZONE
4
HD
TAG
DOCK
x.xx
VERSION
SPIMP.-
En 115
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
ENTE
R
MO
DE
HDMI O
U
T
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
TV
SOURCE/RECEIVER
CODE SET
By setting the code for external devices (BD/DVD players, etc.),
you can operate it with the remote control of this unit.
You cannot control an external device that does not have a remote control sensor.
Make sure the remote control ID of the external device is set to “ID1”. If any other
ID is selected, the remote control operations may not work properly.
If the remote control is without batteries for more than 2 minutes, the registered
codes may be cleared. In this case, insert new batteries and setting the codes
again.
When HDMI control of both this unit and playback device such as a BD/DVD
player are enabled, you may be able to control the device with the remote control
without registering the remote control code.
Setting the remote control code for a TV
By setting the remote control code for your TV, you can operate it
with the remote control of this unit.
You can also register a remote control code of your TV to the input selection keys
(p.116). In this case, you can use the cursor keys or numeric keys to operate the
TV depending on its model. However, you need to press the corresponding input
selection key to play back TV audio on this unit.
(China and Europe models only)
You can also assign a function to each key using the learning function (p.117).
1
Use “Remote Control Code Search” in the CD-ROM
to find a remote control code for your TV.
If multiple remote control codes exist, first set the first code in the list, if it
does not work then try the other codes.
2
Press CODE SET using a pointed object such as the
tip of a ballpoint pen.
SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice.
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. In this case, repeat
from step 2.
3
Press TV
4
Use the numeric keys to enter the 4-digit remote
control code.
Once the remote control code is set successfully,
SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice.
If it blinks 6 times, registration failed. Repeat from step 2.
TV operations
Once you have set the remote control code for your TV, you can
control it using the TV operation keys regardless of an input source
selected on this unit.
Controlling external devices with the remote control
TV operation keys
INPUT Switches the video inputs of the TV.
MUTE Mutes the audio output of the TV.
TV VOL Adjust the volume of the TV.
TV CH Switch the channels of the TV.
TV Turns on/off the TV.
Numeric keys
TV operation keys
En 116
Setting the remote control codes for
playback devices
By setting the remote control codes for your playback devices, you
can operate those devices with the remote control of this unit. Since
the codes are assigned to each input source key, you can select
the input source and device to control with the remote control
concurrently.
At the factory, Yamaha CD player code (5095) is set for AUDIO2. For the other
input selection keys, no codes are set.
(China and Europe models only)
You can also assign a function to each key using the learning function (p.117).
1
Use “Remote Control Code Search” in the CD-ROM
to find a remote control code for your playback
device.
If multiple remote control codes exist, first set the first code in the list, if it
does not work then try the other codes.
2
Press CODE SET using a pointed object such as the
tip of a ballpoint pen.
SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice.
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. In this case, repeat
from step 2.
3
Press a corresponding input selection key.
For example, press AV1 to set the remote control code for
the playback device connected to the AV1 jack.
4
Use the numeric keys to enter the 4-digit remote
control code.
Once the remote control code is registered successfully,
SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice.
If it blinks 6 times, registration failed. Repeat from step 2.
For details on how to register the input selection key applied the remote
control code on a corresponding SCENE key, refer to “Configuring scene
assignments” (p.50).
Playback device operations
Once you have registered the remote control code for your
playback device, you can control it using the following keys after
selecting the input source or scene.
By pressing SOURCE/RECEIVER, you can switch the devices (this unit or
external device) to operate with the menu operation keys, DISPLAY and numeric
keys. You can operate this unit when SOURCE/RECEIVER lights up in orange,
and an external device when SOURCE/RECEIVER lights up in green.
For example, if you register the remote control code of your external device on
TUNER, you can operate FM/AM radio built in this unit when SOURCE/
RECEIVER lights up in orange, and the external device when SOURCE/
RECEIVER lights up in green.
These keys work only when the corresponding function is available on your
playback device and is possible to be operated with an infrared remote control.
SOURCE Turns on/off the playback device.
Menu operation
keys
Cursor keys Select an item.
ENTER Confirms a selected item.
RETURN Returns to the previous screen.
DISPLAY Switches information on the display.
External device
operation keys
TOP MENU Displays the top menu.
POP-UP MENU Displays the pop-up menu.
Stops playback.
Stops playback temporarily.
Starts playback of the selected song/
video.
Search forward/backward (by holding
down).
Skip forward/backward.
Numeric keys Enter numerical values.
TV operation keys Control the TV (p.115).
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETURN
VO
LUME
SU
R
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
PU
RE DIRE
C
T
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
R
Y
AM
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
U
S
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
UT
E
MO
DE
HDMI
OU
T
MAI
N
Z
O
NE
2
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
T
U
NIN
G
BD
/
DV
D
DISPLAY
SOURCE/RECEIVER
SOURCE
CODE SET
Numeric keys
TV operation keys
External device
operation keys
Menu operation keys
Input selection key
En 117
Programming from other remote controls
(learning)
(China and Europe models only)
The remote control of this unit can receive remote control signals
from other remote controls and learn the remote control operation. If
you cannot find a remote control code for your playback device or if
any key on the remote control does not work after you set the
remote control code, use the learning function to assign a function
to each key.
1
Press CODE SET using a pointed object such as the
tip of a ballpoint pen.
SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice.
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. In this case, repeat
from step 1.
2
Press one of the following keys depending on the
type of your device.
For playback device: press the input selection key
(corresponding to the input jacks where the device is
connected).
For TV: press TV .
3
Use the numeric keys to enter “9990”.
4
Aim the infrared transmitters of the remote controls
at each other.
5
Perform the following steps within 10 seconds.
a On this unit, press one of the following keys to which you want to
assign a function.
For playback device: SOURCE , menu operations keys,
external device operation keys
For TV: TV operation keys
b On the external device, press the key from which the operation
is learned.
Once the operation is learned successfully, SOURCE/
RECEIVER blinks twice.
If it blinks 6 times, learning failed. Repeat step 5.
6
Repeat step 5 until all desired operations are
learned.
7
Press CODE SET using a pointed object such as the
tip of a ballpoint pen.
SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks once.
SCENE
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDI O
123
67
4
V-A UX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PAR TY
MOVIE MUSIC
1 2 3 4
TV
CD
RADIO
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
DOCK
PHONO
123 4
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
Remote control of external device
5 to 10 cm apart
Note
If you press SOURCE/RECEIVER in step 2, you can assign functions of an
external receiver to the menu operation keys, external device operation keys
or numeric keys. However, it makes these keys to control this unit impossible.
If you need to restore the remote control code for this unit, perform the
following steps.
a Press CODE SET using a pointed object such as the tip of a ballpoint pen.
b Press SOURCE/RECEIVER.
c Use the numeric keys to enter “9992”.
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETURN
VO
LUME
SU
R
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
PU
RE DIRE
C
T
AV
AU
DI
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V-A
U
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
R
Y
AM
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
U
S
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
UT
E
MO
DE
HDMI
OU
T
DISPLA
Y
A
A
MAI
N
Z
O
NE
2
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1
4
3
MU
LT
I
TUNE
R
T
U
NIN
G
NET
USB
BD
/
DV
D
TV
SOURCE/RECEIVER
SOURCE
CODE SET
Numeric keys
TV operation keys
External device
operation keys
Menu operation keys
En 118
Resetting remote control codes
Resetting all remote control codes
You can clear all remote control codes (including functions learned
from other remote controls [China and Europe models only]) and
restore the default settings.
The settings for controlling playback devices after selecting a scene (p.50) will be
also cleared.
1
Press CODE SET using a pointed object such as the
tip of a ballpoint pen.
SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice.
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. In this case, repeat
from step 1.
2
Press SOURCE/RECEIVER.
3
Use the numeric keys to enter “9981”.
Once the remote control codes are reset successfully,
SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice.
If it blinks 6 times, resetting failed. Repeat from step 1.
Clearing functions learned from other
remote controls (China and Europe models
only)
Clearing the assignment of each key
1
Press CODE SET using a pointed object such as the
tip of a ballpoint pen.
SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice.
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. In this case, repeat
from step 1.
2
Press one of the following keys to select the device
for which key assignments will be cleared.
For playback device: press the input selection key.
For TV: press TV .
3
Use the numeric keys to enter “9991”.
4
Press the key that you want to reset.
Once the key assignment is cleared successfully,
SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice.
If it blinks 6 times, clearing failed. Repeat from step 2.
5
Repeat step 4 until all desired key assignments are
cleared.
6
Press CODE SET using a pointed object such as the
tip of a ballpoint pen.
SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks once.
Clearing the key assignments for each input source
1
Press CODE SET using a pointed object such as the
tip of a ballpoint pen.
SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice.
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. In this case, repeat
from step 1.
2
Press one of the following keys to select the device
for which key assignments will be cleared.
For playback device: press the input selection key.
For TV: press TV .
3
Use the numeric keys to enter “9992”.
Once the key assignment is cleared successfully,
SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice.
If it blinks 6 times, clearing failed. Repeat from step 1.
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
ENTE
R
MO
DE
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
TUNIN
G
BD
/
DV
D
TV
SOURCE/RECEIVER
CODE SET
Numeric keys
Input selection key
En 119
If this unit is connected to the Internet, the corresponding message
will be displayed on the TV when a newer firmware is available. In
this case, follow the procedure below to update the firmware of this
unit.
You can also update the firmware using the USB memory device from the
“ADVANCED SETUP” menu (p.114).
If the following message is displayed after ON SCREEN is pressed,
firmware update is available.
1
Read the on-screen description.
2
To start the firmware update, use the cursor keys to
select “START” and press ENTER.
The on-screen display turns off.
3
If “UPDATE SUCCESS PLEASE POWER OFF!”
appears on the front display, press MAIN ZONE
on the front panel.
The firmware update is complete.
If you want to update the firmware later, select “CLOSE” in step 2. In this
case, “!” (exclamation mark) appears at the upper right of the “Information”
and “System” icons, and the corresponding message will be displayed in the
“System” screen (p.111). You can update the firmware of this unit by
pressing ENTER in the “System” screen.
Updating the firmware of this unit
Note
Do not operate this unit or disconnect the power cable or network cable during
firmware update. Firmware update takes about 15 minutes.
Information
icon
Message
System icon
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCERSLEEP PURE DIRECT
AV
AUDIO
123
67
4
V-AUX
5
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PA RT Y
MOVIE MUSIC
1 234
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
MODE
ENT
HDMI OUT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
PHONO
OPTIONON SCREEN
1234
MULTI
TUNER
TUNING
NET USB
BD/DVD
SC
EN
E
RETUR
N
VO
LUME
S
UR
.
DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
S
LEEP
P
URE DIRE
C
T
A
V
A
U
D
I
O
2
1
3
7
6
4
V
-
AU
X
5
FM
I
NF
O
MEM
O
RY
A
M
PRE
S
ET
PA
RT
Y
M
O
VI
E
M
US
I
C
1
2
3
4
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUT
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
MO
DE
EN
T
HDMI O
U
T
TV
TV
V
O
LT
V
C
H
T
O
P
MENU
P
O
P-
UP
M
EN
U
DISPLA
Y
A
A
SO
UR
CE
M
AI
N
Z
O
NE 2
R
E
C
EIVER
CO
DE
SE
T
INP
U
T
M
U
T
E
DOC
K
P
H
O
N
O
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
2
1 43
MU
LT
I
T
U
NE
R
TUNIN
G
N
E
T
USB
BD
/
DV
D
ENTER
Cursor keys
En 120
APPENDIX
The new speaker system does not provide an ideal sound
balance...
If you have changed speakers or speaker system, use “Auto Setup” to optimize the
speaker settings again (p.41). If you want to adjust the speaker settings manually, use
“Manual Setup” in the “Setup” menu (p.98).
Since we have small children, we want to set limitations on the
volume control...
If a small child, etc. accidentally operates the controls on the main unit or remote
control, the volume may suddenly increase. And this may cause injury or damage this
unit or speakers. We recommend using “Max Volume” in the “Setup” menu to set the
maximum volume level for this unit in advance (p.102). You can also set the maximum
volume for Zone2 (p.106).
I am occasionally startled by a sudden large sound when
turning on this unit...
By default, the volume level when this unit last entered standby mode is automatically
applied. If you want to fix the volume, use “Initial Volume” to set the volume to be
applied when this receiver is turned on (p.102). You can also set the initial volume for
Zone2 (p.106).
I made HDMI connections but HDMI Control does not work at
all...
To use HDMI Control, you need to perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.131). After
connecting HDMI Control-compatible devices (TV, BD/DVD players, etc.) to this unit,
enable HDMI Control on each device and perform the HDMI Control link setup. This
setup is required every time when you add a new HDMI Control-compatible device to
your system. For information on how HDMI Control works between your TV and
playback devices, refer to the instruction manuals of each device.
I want to turn off the onscreen messages displayed during
operations...
By default, short messages are displayed on the TV screen when this unit is operated
(input selection, volume adjustment, etc). In case that the short messages bother you
when you are watching movies or sports, configure “Short Message” (p.108) in the
“Setup” menu to turn off the short messages.
I want to prevent accidental changes to the settings...
You can protect the settings configured on this unit (speaker settings, etc.) by utilizing
“Memory Guard” in the “Setup” menu (p.109).
The web control screen (p.81) becomes inaccessible...
If you are using a DHCP server, the IP address of this unit may change each time this
unit is turned on. Check the IP address of this unit in “Network” (p.111) in the
“Information” menu. Also, if you have enabled “MAC Address Filter” (p.105), you need
to specify the MAC address of your PC in “Address Setup” (p.105) to allow the PC to
access this unit. For information on how to check the MAC address of your PC, refer to
the instruction manuals of it.
The supplied remote control concurrently controls this unit and
another Yamaha product that is not intended...
When using multiple Yamaha products, the supplied remote control may work on
another Yamaha product or another remote control may work on this unit. In this case,
set each remote control with a unique remote control ID for its corresponding receiver
(p.113).
Frequently asked questions
En 121
Refer to the table below when this unit does not function properly.
If the problem you are experiencing is not listed below, or if the instructions below do not help, turn off this unit, disconnect the power cable, and contact the nearest authorized
Yamaha dealer or service center.
First, check the followings:
a The power cables of this unit, TV and playback devices (BD/DVD player, etc.) are connected to AC outlets securely.
b This unit, subwoofer, TV and playback devices (BD/DVD player, etc.) are turned on.
c The connectors of each cable are inserted to jacks on each devices securely.
Power and system
Troubleshooting
Problem Cause Remedy
The power does not turn on.
The protection circuitry has been activated 3 times consecutively.
As a safety precaution, capability to turn on the power is disabled. Contact your
nearest Yamaha dealer or service center to request repair.
The power does not turn off.
The internal microcomputer is hung-up due to an external electric
shock (such as lightning and excessive static electricity) or by a
drop in power supply voltage.
Hold down MAIN ZONE on the front panel for more than 10 seconds to initialize
and reboot this unit.
The power turns off (standby mode)
immediately.
This unit was turned on while a speaker cable was shorted.
Twist the bare wires of each speaker cable firmly and reconnect to this unit and
speakers (p.18).
The unit enters
standby mode automatically.
The sleep timer worked. Turn on the unit and start playback again.
Since this unit was not operated for the specified time, auto-
standby worked.
To disable auto-standby, set “Auto Power Down” in the “Setup” menu to “Off”
(p.107).
The speaker impedance setting is incorrect. Set the speaker impedance to match your speakers (p.112).
The protection circuitry has been activated because of a short
circuit.
Twist the bare wires of each speaker cable firmly and reconnect to this unit and
speakers (p.18).
This unit is uncontrollable.
The internal microcomputer is hung-up due to an external electric
shock (such as lightning and excessive static electricity) or by a
drop in power supply voltage.
Hold down MAIN ZONE on the front panel for more than 10 seconds to initialize
and reboot this unit.
En 122
Audio
Problem Cause Remedy
No sound.
Another input source is selected. Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys
Signals that this unit cannot reproduce are being input.
Some digital audio formats cannot be played back on this unit. To check the
audio format of the input signal, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu
(p.111).
The cable connecting this unit and playback device is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable.
The volume cannot be increased.
The maximum volume is set. Use “Max Volume” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the maximum volume (p.102).
Any device connected to the output jacks of this unit is not turned
on. (This may happen due to the nature of AV receivers.)
Turn on all devices connected to the output jacks of this unit
No sound is heard from a specific
speaker.
The playback source does not contain corresponding channel
signals.
To check it, select “7ch Stereo” (p.51).
The sound program/decoder currently selected does not use the
corresponding speaker.
To check it, select “7ch Stereo” (p.51).
Audio output of the corresponding speaker is disabled.
Perform “Auto Setup” (p.41) or use “Configuration” in the “Setup” menu to change
the speaker setting (p.98).
The volume of the corresponding speaker is too low.
Perform “Auto Setup” (p.41) or use “Level” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the
speaker volume (p.100).
The speaker cable connecting this unit and corresponding
speaker is defective.
If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another speaker cable.
The corresponding speaker is malfunctioning.
To check it, replacing with another speaker. If the problem persists, this unit may
be malfunctioning.
No sound is heard from the surround
back speaker.
The extended surround is disabled.
Use “Extended Surround” in the “Option” menu to select a decoder to be used
(p.86).
No sound is heard from the subwoofer.
The playback source does not contain LFE or low-frequency
signals.
To check it, set “Extra Bass” in the “Setup” menu to “On”, to output the front
channel low-frequency components from the subwoofer (p.99).
Subwoofer output is disabled.
Perform “Auto Setup” (p.41) or set “Subwoofer” in the “Setup” menu to “Use
(p.99).
The subwoofer is turned off by the auto-standby function on it. Disable the auto-standby function of the subwoofer or adjust its sensitivity level.
No sound from the playback device
(connected to this unit with HDMI).
The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content
Protection).
To check it, use “Video Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.111).
This unit is set not to output audio input through HDMI jacks from
the SPEAKERS terminals.
In “Audio Output” in the “Setup” menu, set “Amp” to “On” (p.104).
The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack is over
the limit.
Disconnect some of the HDMI devices.
No sound from the TV (when HDMI
Control is used).
(If the TV is connected to this unit with an audio cable)
The TV audio input setting does not match the actual connection.
Use “TV Audio Input” in the “Setup” menu to select the correct audio input jack
(p.103).
(If you are trying to use ARC)
ARC is disabled on this unit or TV.
Set “ARC” in the “Setup” menu to “On” (p.104). Also, enable ARC on the TV.
En 123
Video
Only the front speakers work on multi-
channel audio.
The playback device is set to output 2-channel audio (PCM, etc.)
only.
Change the digital audio output setting on the playback device.
Noise/hum is heard.
This unit is too close to other digital or radio frequency device. Move this unit further away from such device.
The cable connecting this unit and playback device is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable.
The sound is distorted.
Any device connected to the output jacks of this unit is not turned
on. (This may happen due to the nature of AV receivers.)
Turn on all devices connected to the output jacks of this unit
Problem Cause Remedy
No video.
Another input source is selected on this unit. Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys
Another input source is selected on the TV. Switch the TV input to display the video from this unit.
The video signal output from this unit is not supported by the TV. Set “MONITOR CHECK” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “YES” (p.113).
The cable connecting this unit and TV (or playback device) is
defective.
If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable.
No video from the playback device
(connected to this unit with HDMI).
The input video signal (resolution) is not supported by this unit.
To check the information about the current video signal (resolution), use “Video
Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.111). For information about video signals
supported by this unit, see “HDMI signal compatibility” (p.132).
The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content
Protection).
To check it, use “Video Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.111).
The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack is over
the limit.
Disconnect some of the HDMI devices.
Problem Cause Remedy
En 124
FM/AM radio
USB and network
Problem Cause Remedy
FM radio reception is weak or noisy.
There is multi-path interference. Adjust the FM antenna height or orientation, or place it in a different location.
Your area is too far from the FM station transmitter.
Press MODE to select “Mono” (monaural reception) (p.56).
Use an outdoor FM antenna commercially available. We recommend using a
sensitive multi-element antenna.
AM radio reception is weak or noisy.
The noises may be caused by fluorescent lamps, motors,
thermostats, or other electrical equipment.
It is difficult to completely eliminate noise. It may be reduced by using an outdoor
AM antenna commercially available.
Radio stations cannot be selected
automatically.
Your area is too far from the FM station transmitter.
Select the station manually (p.56).
Use an outdoor antenna commercially available. We recommend using a
sensitive multi-element antenna.
The AM radio signal is weak.
Adjust the AM antenna orientation.
Select the station manually (p.56).
Use an outdoor AM antenna commercially available. Connect it to the ANTENNA
(AM) jack together with the supplied AM antenna.
AM radio stations cannot be registered
as presets.
“Auto Preset” has been used.
“Auto Preset” is for registering FM radio stations only. Register AM radio stations
manually (p.56).
Problem Cause Remedy
This unit does not detect the USB
device.
The USB cable connecting this unit and USB device is not
compliant with USB 2.0.
Use a USB cable compliant with USB 2.0.
Folders and files in the USB device
cannot be viewed.
The folder structure not supported by this unit is applied.
This unit supports folder hierarchies of up to 8 levels and up to 500 items (total of
files and subfolders) per folder. If necessary, modify the folder structure on your
USB device.
The network feature does not function.
The network parameters (IP address) is not obtained properly.
Enable the DHCP server function on your router and set “DHCP” in the “Setup”
menu to “On” on this unit (p.105). If you want to configure the network parameters
manually, make sure using an IP address which is not used by other network
devices in your network (p.105).
This unit does not detect the PC.
The media sharing setting is not correct.
Configure the sharing setting and select this unit as a device to which music
contents are shared (p.70).
Some security software installed on your PC is blocking the access
of this unit to your PC.
Check the settings of security software installed on your PC.
This unit and PC are not in the same network.
Check the network connections and the settings of your router to connect them to
the same network.
En 125
Remote control
The files in the PC cannot be viewed or
played back.
The files are not supported by this unit or the media server.
Use the file format supported by both this unit and the media server. For
information about the file formats supported by this unit, see “Playing back music
stored on PCs” (p.70).
The Internet radio cannot be played.
The selected Internet radio station is currently not available.
It may not be available to listen because there might be a network problem, or the
station might be broadcasting in limited hour. Try the station later or select another
station.
The selected Internet radio station broadcasts audio silence
currently.
Some Internet radio stations broadcast audio silence during particular periods of
time in a day. Try the station later or select another station.
Access to the network is restricted by the firewall settings of your
network devices (router, etc).
Check the firewall settings of your network devices. The Internet radio can be
played only when it passes through the port designated by each radio station.
The port number is variable depending on radio station.
Problem Cause Remedy
This unit cannot be controlled using the
remote control.
Out of the operating range. Use the remote control in the operating range (p.5).
The batteries are weak. Replace with new batteries.
Direct sunlight or lighting is striking the remote control sensor of
this unit.
Adjust the lighting angle, or reposition this unit.
The remote control is set to control external devices.
Press SOURCE/RECEIVER to set the remote control to control this unit (the key
lights up in orange).
The remote control IDs of the main unit and remote control are not
identical.
Change the remote control ID of the main unit or remote control (p.113).
External devices cannot be controlled
using the remote control.
The remote control is set to control this unit.
Press SOURCE/RECEIVER to set the remote control to control external devices
(the key lights up in green).
The corresponding remote control code is not set properly.
Set the remote control code again (p.115). Even if the remote control code is
registered properly set, some products may not respond to the remote control.
The remote control does not learn new
functions.
(China and Europe models only)
The batteries of the remote control of this unit and/or the external
device are weak.
Replace with new batteries.
The distance between the two remote controls is not appropriate. Place the remote controls at a proper distance (p.117).
The signal coding or modulation of the other remote control is not
compatible with this remote control.
Learning is impossible in this case.
Memory capacity is full.
Clear unnecessary assignments to free some memory space for the new
functions (p.118).
Problem Cause Remedy
En 126
Error indications on the front display
Message
(alphabetical order)
Cause Remedy
Access denied
Access to the PC is denied. Configure the sharing setting and select this unit as a device to which music contents are shared (p.70).
Access error
This unit cannot access the USB device. Turn off this unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device.
This unit cannot access the iPod connected to the USB jack. Turn off the iPod and turn on it again.
There is a problem with the signal path from the network to this unit.
Make sure your router and modem are turned on.
Check the connection between this unit and your router (or hub) (p.36).
No device
This unit cannot detect the USB device. Turn off this unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device.
This unit cannot detect the iPod connected to the USB jack. Turn off the iPod and turn on it again.
Not found
The Bluetooth component is not found.
(When pairing)
Turn on the Bluetooth component and set it in pairing mode.
(When establishing a wireless connection)
- Turn on the Bluetooth component.
- Place the Bluetooth component within 10 m of the Bluetooth receiver.
- Perform pairing again.
Unknown iPod
The connected iPod is not supported by the unit. Use an iPod supported by this unit (p.60).
Unable to play
The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the iPod for some
reasons.
Check the song data. If it cannot be played on the iPod itself, the song data or storage area may be
defective.
The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the PC for some
reasons.
Check if the format of files you are trying to play is supported by this unit. For information about the
formats supported by this unit, see “Playing back music stored on PCs” (p.70). If this unit cannot play
back any files, the network may be overloaded with heavy traffic, and playback is interrupted.
USB Overloaded
Over current passes through the USB device. Turn off this unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device.
En 127
Audio information
Audio and video synchronization (Lipsync)
Lip sync, an abbreviation for lip synchronization, is a technical term that involves both a problem, and the capability of
maintaining audio and video signals synchronized during post-production and transmission.
Whereas the audio and video latency requires complex end-user adjustment, HDMI version 1.3 incorporates an
automatic audio and video syncing capability that allows devices to perform this synchronization automatically and
accurately without user interaction.
Bi-amplification connection (Bi-amp)
A bi-amplification connection uses two amplifiers for a speaker. One amplifier is connected to the woofer section of a
loudspeaker while the other is connected to the combined mid and tweeter section. With this arrangement each
amplifier operates over a restricted frequency range. This restricted range presents each amplifier with a much simpler
job and each amplifier is less likely to influence the sound in some way.
CINEMA DSP
Since the Dolby Surround and DTS systems were originally designed for use in movie theaters, their effect is best felt in
a theater having many speakers designed for acoustic effects. Since home conditions, such as room size, wall material,
number of speakers, and so on, can differ so widely, it is inevitable that there are differences in the sound that is heard.
Based on a wealth of actually measured data, Yamaha CINEMA DSP uses Yamaha’s original DSP technology to
combine Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby Digital, and DTS systems to provide the audiovisual experience of a movie theater in
the listening room of your own home.
CINEMA DSP 3D
The actually measured sound field data contain the information of the height of the sound images. CINEMA DSP 3D
feature achieves the reproduction of the accurate height of the sound images so that it creates the accurate and
intensive stereoscopic sound fields in a listening room.
Compressed Music Enhancer
The Compressed Music Enhancer feature of this unit enhances your listening experience by regenerating the missing
harmonics in compression artifacts. As a result, it compensates for flattened complexity due to the loss of high-
frequency fidelity as well as lack of bass due to the loss of low-frequency bass, providing improved performance for the
overall sound system.
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital is a digital surround sound system that gives you completely independent multi-channel audio. With 3 front
channels (front L/R and center), and 2 surround stereo channels, Dolby Digital provides 5 full-range audio channels.
With an additional channel especially for bass effects, referred to as LFE (Low-Frequency Effect), the system has a total
of 5.1-channels (LFE is counted as 0.1 channel). By using 2-channel stereo for the surround speakers, more accurate
moving sound effects and surround sound environments are possible than with Dolby Surround. The wide dynamic
range from maximum to minimum volumes that are reproduced by the 5 full-range channels, and the precise sound
orientation generated using digital sound processing provides listeners with unprecedented excitement and realism.
With this unit, any sound environment from monaural up to a 5.1-channel configuration can be freely selected for your
enjoyment.
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital Plus is an advanced audio technology developed for highdefinition programming and BD (Blu-ray disc).
Selected as an optional audio standard for BD, this technology delivers multichannel sound with discrete channel
output. Supporting bitrates up to 6.0 Mbps, Dolby Digital Plus can carry up to 7.1 discreet audio channels
simultaneously. Supported by HDMI version 1.3 and designed for the optical disc players and AV receivers/amplifiers of
the future, Dolby Digital Plus also remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that incorporate
Dolby Digital.
Dolby Pro Logic II
Dolby Pro Logic II is an improved technique used to decode vast numbers of existing Dolby Surround sources. This new
technology enables a discrete 5-channel playback with 2 front left and right channels, 1 center channel, and 2 surround
left and right channels, instead of only 1 surround channel for conventional Pro Logic technology. There are three modes
available: “Music mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources, and “Game mode” for game sources.
Dolby Pro Logic IIx
Dolby Pro Logic IIx is a new technology enabling discrete multichannel playback from 2-channel or multi-channel
sources. There are three modes available: “Music mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources (for 2-
channel sources only) and “Game mode” for game sources.
Dolby Surround
Dolby Surround uses a 4-channel analog recording system to reproduce realistic and dynamic sound effects: 2 front left
and right channels (stereo), a center channel for dialog (monaural), and a surround channel for special sound effects
(monaural). The surround channel reproduces sound within a narrow frequency range. Dolby Surround is widely used
with nearly all video tapes and laser discs, as well as in many TV and cable broadcasts. The Dolby Pro Logic decoder
built into this unit employs a digital signal processing system that automatically stabilizes the volume on each channel to
enhance moving sound effects and directionality.
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD is an advanced lossless audio technology developed for high-definition disc-based media including Blu-
ray Disc. Selected as an optional audio standard for BD (Blu-ray disc), this technology delivers sound that is bit-for-bit
identical to the studio master, offering a high-definition home theater experience. Supporting bitrates up to 18.0 Mbps,
Dolby TrueHD can carry up to 8 discrete channels of 24-bit/96 kHz audio simultaneously. Dolby TrueHD also remains
fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems and retains the metadata capability of Dolby Digital,
allowing dialog normalization and dynamic range control.
DTS 96/24
DTS 96/24 offers an unprecedented level of audio quality for multichannel sound on DVD video, and is fully backward-
compatible with all DTS decoders. “96” refers to a 96 kHz sampling rate compared to the typical 48 kHz sampling rate.
“24” refers to 24-bit word length. DTS 96/24 offers sound quality transparent to the original 96/24 master, and 96/24 5.1-
channel sound with full-quality full-motion video for music programs and motion picture soundtracks on DVD video.
Glossary
En 128
DTS Digital Surround
DTS Digital Surround was developed to replace the analog soundtracks of movies with a 5.1-channel digital sound
track, and is now rapidly gaining popularity in movie theaters around the world. DTS, Inc. has developed a home theater
system so that you can enjoy the depth of sound and natural spatial representation of DTS Digital Surround in your
home. This system produces practically distortion-free 5.1-channel sound (technically, left, right and center channels, 2
surround channels, plus an LFE 0.1 channel as a subwoofer, for a total of 5.1-channels). This unit incorporates a DTS-ES
decoder that enables 6.1-channel reproduction by adding the surround back channel to the existing 5.1-channel format.
DTS Express
This is an audio format for next-generation optical discs such as BD (Blu-ray disc). It uses optimized low bit rate signals
for network streaming. In the case of a BD, this format is used with secondary audio, enabling you to enjoy the
commentary of the movie producer via the Internet while playing the main program.
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is a high resolution audio technology developed for high-definition disc-based media
including BD (Blu-ray disc). Selected as an optional audio standard for BD, this technology delivers sound that is
virtually indistinguishable from the original, offering a high-definition home theater experience.
Supporting bitrates up to 6.0 Mbps for BD, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio can carry up to 7.1 discrete channels of 24-
bit/96 kHz audio simultaneously.
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio also remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that
incorporate DTS Digital Surround.
DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS-HD Master Audio is an advanced lossless audio technology developed for high-definition disc-based media
including BD (Blu-ray disc). Selected as an optional audio standard for BD, this technology delivers sound that is bit-for-
bit identical to the studio master, offering a high-definition home theater experience.
Supporting bitrates up to 24.5 Mbps for BD, DTS-HD Master Audio can carry up to 7.1 discrete channels of 24-bit/96
kHz audio simultaneously. Supported by HDMI version 1.3 and designed for the optical disc players and AV receivers/
amplifiers of the future, DTS-HD Master Audio also remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio
systems that incorporate DTS Digital Surround.
DSD
Direct Stream Digital (DSD) technology stores audio signals on digital storage media, such as Super Audio CDs. Using
DSD, signals are stored as single bit values at a high-frequency sampling rate of 2.8224 MHz, while noise shaping and
oversampling are used to reduce distortion, a common occurrence with very high quantization of audio signals. Due to
the high sampling rate, better audio quality can be achieved than that offered by the PCM format used for normal audio
CDs. The frequency is equal to or higher than 100 kHz, with a dynamic range of 120 dB. This unit can transmit or receive
DSD signals via the HDMI jack.
FLAC
This is a file format for lossless audio data compression. FLAC is inferior to lossy compression formats in compression
rate but provides higher audio quality.
LFE 0.1 channel
This channel reproduces low-frequency bass signals, and has a frequency range from 20 Hz to 120 Hz. This channel is
counted as 0.1, because it only enforces a low-frequency range compared to the full-range reproduced by the other 5-
channels in Dolby Digital or DTS 5.1-channel systems.
MP3
One of the audio compression methods used by MPEG. It employs the irreversible compression method, which
achieves a high compression rate by thinning out the data of hardly audible part to the human ears. It is said to be
capable of compressing the data quantity by about 1/11 (128 kbps) while maintaining a similar audio quality to music
CD.
MPEG-4 AAC
An MPEG-4 audio standard. As it allows compression of data at a bit rate lower than that of MPEG-2 AAC, it is used
among others for mobile telephones, portable audio players and other low-capacity devices requiring high sound
quality. In addition to the above types of devices, MPEG-4 AAC is also used to distribute contents on the Internet, and
as such is supported by computers, media servers and many other devices.
Neo:6
Neo:6 decodes the conventional 2-channel sources for 6-channel playback by the specific decoder. It enables
playback with the full-range channels with higher separation just like digital discrete signal playback. There are two
modes available: “Music mode” for music sources and “Cinema mode” for movie sources.
PCM (Linear PCM)
Linear PCM is a signal format under which an analog audio signal is digitized, recorded and transmitted without using
any compression. This is used as a method of recording CDs and DVD audio. The PCM system uses a technique for
sampling the size of the analog signal per very small unit of time. Standing for “Pulse Code Modulation,” the analog
signal is encoded as pulses and then modulated for recording.
Sampling frequency and number of quantized bits
When digitizing an analog audio signal, the number of times the signal is sampled per second is called the sampling
frequency, while the degree of accuracy when converting the sound level into a numeric value is called the number of
quantized bits. The range of rates that can be played back is determined based on the sampling rate, whereas the
dynamic range representing the sound level difference is determined by the number of quantized bits. In principle, the
higher the sampling frequency, the wider the range of frequencies that can be played back, and the higher the number
of quantized bits, the more accurately the sound level can be reproduced.
SILENT CINEMA
Yamaha has developed a natural, realistic sound effect DSP algorithm for headphones. Parameters for headphones
have been set for each sound program, so that accurate representations of all the sound programs can be enjoyed on
headphones.
Virtual CINEMA DSP
Yamaha has developed a Virtual CINEMA DSP algorithm that allows you to enjoy DSP surround effects even without any
surround speakers, by using virtual surround speakers. It is even possible to enjoy Virtual CINEMA DSP using a minimal
two-speaker system that does not include a center speaker.
WAV
Windows standard audio file format, which defines the method of recording the digital data obtained by converting
audio signals. It does not specify the compression (coding) method so a desired compression method can be used with
it. By default, it is compatible with the PCM method (no compression) and some compression methods including the
ADPCM method.
WMA
An audio compression method developed by Microsoft Corporation. It employs the irreversible compression method,
which achieves a high compression rate by thinning out the data of hardly audible part to the human ears. It is said to be
capable of compressing the data quantity by about 1/22 (64 kbps) while maintaining a similar audio quality to music CD.
En 129
Video information
Component video signal
With the component video signal system, the video signal is separated into the Y signal for luminance and the Pb and Pr
signals for chrominance. Color can be reproduced more faithfully with this system because each of these signals is
independent. The component signal is also called the “color difference signal” because the luminance signal is
subtracted from the color signal. A monitor with component input jacks is required in order to output component signals.
Composite video signal
With the composite video signal system, the video signal comprises the three basic elements of a video picture: color,
brightness and synchronization data. A composite video jack on a video component transmits these three elements
combined.
Deep Color
Deep Color refers to the use of various color depths in displays, up from the 24-bit depths in previous versions of the
HDMI specification. This extra bit depth allows HDTVs and other displays increase from millions of colors to billions of
colors and eliminate on-screen color banding for smooth tonal transitions and subtle gradations between colors. The
increased contrast ratio can represent many times more shades of gray between black and white. Additionally, Deep
Color increases the number of available colors within the boundaries defined by the RGB or YCbCr color space.
HDMI
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) is the first industry supported, uncompressed, all-digital audio/video
interface. Providing an interface between any sources (such as set-top boxes or AV receivers) and audio/video monitors
(such as digital televisions), HDMI supports standard, enhanced or high-definition video as well as multichannel digital
audio using a single cable. HDMI transmits all ATSC HDTV standards and supports 8-channel digital audio, with
bandwidth to spare to accommodate future enhancements and requirements.
When used in combination with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection), HDMI provides a secure audio/
video interface that meets the security requirements of content providers and system operators. For further information
on HDMI, visit the HDMI website at “http://www.hdmi.org/.”
S-video signal
With the S-video signal system, the video signal normally transmitted using a pin cable is separated and transmitted as
the Y signal for the luminance and the C signal for the chrominance through the S-video cable. Using the S VIDEO jack
eliminates video signal transmission loss and allows recording and playback of even more beautiful images.
“x.v.Color”
A color space standard supported by HDMI version 1.3. It is a more extensive color space than sRGB, and allows the
expression of colors that were not hitherto possible. While remaining compatible with the color gamut of sRGB
standards, “x.v.Color” expands the color space, and can thus produce more vivid, natural images. It is particularly
effective for still pictures and computer graphics.
En 130
Video signal flow
Video signals input from a video device to this unit are
output to a TV as shown below.
(solid line) is always available. (dotted line) is
available only when “Analog to Analog Conversion”
(p.102) in the “Setup” menu is set to “On” (default).
HDMI
PR
PB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
PR
PB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
PR
PB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
PR
PB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
S VIDEO
VIDEO VIDEO VIDEOVIDEO
S VIDEO S VIDEO S VIDEO
Video device This unit TV
HDMI outHDMI in
COMPONENT
VIDEO in
COMPONENT
VIDEO out
VIDEO outVIDEO in
S VIDEO
in
S VIDEO
out
Video conversion table
You can select a resolution and an aspect ratio applied to HDMI-output video processing.
This unit does not convert 480-line and 576-line video signals interchangeably.
HDMI out COMPONENT VIDEO out
S VIDEO
out
VIDEO
out
Resolution
480i/
576i
480p/
576p
720p 1080i 1080p
480i/
576i
480p/
576p
720p 1080i
480i/
576i
480i/
576i
HDMI in
480i/576i
480p/576p
720p
1080i
1080p
COMPONENT
VIDEO in
480i/576i
480p/576p
720p
1080i
S VIDEO in 480i/576i
VIDEO in 480i/576i
En 131
HDMI Control
HDMI Control allows you to operate external devices via HDMI. If you connect a TV that
supports HDMI Control to this unit with an HDMI cable, you can control this unit (power,
volume, etc.) in conjunction with TV remote control operations. You can also control
playback devices (HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD players, etc.) connected to this
unit with an HDMI cable.
For details on connections, see “Connecting a TV” (p.25) and “Connecting video
devices (BD/DVD players, etc.)” (p.31).
Operations available from the TV’s remote control
- Standby synchronization
- Volume control including mute
- Switching to input audio from the TV when the TV input is switched to its built-in tuner
- Switching to input video/audio from the selected playback device and output the
video to the TV
- Switching between audio output devices (this unit or TV speaker)
(Example)
Operations available from this unit’s remote control
- Starting playback on the playback device and turning on the TV in conjunction with a
scene selection (p.49)
- Switching the TV input to display the on-screen menu (when ON SCREEN is pressed)
- Controlling the playback device (playback and menu operations) without registering
remote control codes (p.115)
(Example)
To use HDMI Control, you need to perform the following HDMI Control link setup after
connecting the TV and playback devices.
This setup is required every time when you add a new HDMI Control-compatible device to your system.
To use HDMI Control, connect the TV to the HDMI OUT 1 jack.
1
Turn on this unit, TV and playback devices.
2
Enable HDMI Control on this unit, TV and playback devices (HDMI
Control-compatible BD/DVD players, etc).
To enable HDMI Control on this unit, set “HDMI Control” (p.103) in the “Setup”
menu to “On” and configure the related items (“TV Audio Input”, “ARC” and
“Standby Sync”).
3
Turn off the main power of the TV and then turn off this unit and
playback devices.
4
Turn on this unit and playback devices and then turn on the main
power of the TV.
5
Switch the TV input to display the video from this unit.
6
Check the followings.
On this unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected. If
not, select the input source manually.
On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed.
7
Check that this unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning
off the TV or adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control.
If HDMI Control does not work properly, try unplugging the TV in step 2 and re-plugging the TV in step 3. It
may solve the problem. Also, HDMI Control may not work if the number of connected devices is over the
limit. In this case, disable HDMI Control on the devices not in use.
If the unit is not synchronized to the TV's power operations, check the priority of the audio output setting on
the TV.
We recommend using TV and playback devices from the same manufacturer so that HDMI Control works
more effectively.
Information on HDMI
HDMI Control
Turn off the TV
This unit turns off
(standby)
HDMI Control
Playback device
also turns off
HDMI Control
Press SCENE
(BD/DVD)
Turns on and displays video
from the playback device
HDMI Control
Playback starts
En 132
HDMI signal compatibility
Audio signals
Video signals
This unit is compatible with the video signals of the following resolutions:
- 480i/60 Hz - 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz
- 576i/50 Hz - 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz
- 480p/60 Hz - 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 24 Hz
- 576p/50 Hz
When CPPM copy-protected DVD-Audio is played back, video/audio signals may not be output, depending
on the type of the DVD player.
This unit is not compatible with HDCP-incompatible HDMI or DVI devices. For details, refer to the
instruction manual of each device.
To decode audio bitstream signals on this unit, set the input source device appropriately so that the device
outputs the bitstream audio signals directly (does not decode the bitstream signals on the playback device).
For details, refer to the instruction manual of the playback device.
This unit is not compatible with the audio commentary features (for example, the special audio contents
downloaded via Internet) of BD or HD DVD. This unit does not playback the audio commentaries of the BD
or HD DVD content.
Audio signal type Audio signal format Compatible media (example)
2ch Linear PCM 2ch, 32 to 192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit CD, DVD-Video, DVD-Audio
Multi-channel Linear PCM 8ch, 32 to 192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit
DVD-Audio, BD (Blu-ray disc),
HD DVD
DSD 2/5.1ch, 2.8224 MHz, 1 bit SACD
Bitstream Dolby Digital, DTS DVD-Video
Bitstream
(High definition audio)
Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital
Plus, DTS-HD Master Audio,
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio,
DTS Express
BD (Blu-ray disc), HD DVD
En 133
The area around the video/audio output jacks is marked in white on the actual product.
Reference diagram (rear panel)
+12V 0.1A MAX.
AC IN
TRIGGER
OUT
DOCK
FM
75Ω
ANTENNA
YP
B PR
OPTICAL
AV OUT
R
L
HDMI OUT
ARC
1
1
2
2
HDMI
(1 BD/DVD)
MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT
IN OUT
AV 1AV 2AV 3AV 4AV 5AV 6AV 7
1
2
REMOTE
AV 3 AV 4AV 2AV 1
AUDIO 4
MULTI CH INPUT
ZONE OUT
AUDIO 3AUDIO 2
(3 CD)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
CENTER
SUBWOOFER
ZONE 2FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONTSURROUND BACKSURROUND
BI–AMP
ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/
R
5
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
COAXIAL
6
L R R RL L L
SINGLE
RS-232C
AM
(4 RADIO)
PHONO
NETWORK
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTER
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
GND
EXTRA SP
YPB PR YPB PR
MONITOR OUT/
ZONE OUT
AV 1
AV 3
COMPONENT VIDEO
A
AV 2
B
C
AV 4
D
En 134
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby, Pro Logic and the double-D symbol are trademarks of
Dolby Laboratories.
Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent #’s:
5,451,942; 5,956,674; 5,974,380; 5,978,762; 6,226,616; 6,487,535; 7,212,872; 7,333,929; 7,392,195; 7,272,567 & other
U.S. and worldwide patents issued & pending. DTS and the Symbol are registered trademarks, & DTS-HD, DTS-HD
Master Audio, and the DTS logos are trademarks of DTS, Inc.
Product includes software. © DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
iPod™, iPhone™
“Made for iPod” and “Made for iPhone” mean that an electronic accessory has been designed to connect specifically to
iPod or iPhone, respectively, and has been certified by the developer to meet Apple performance standards.
Apple is not responsible for the operation of this device or its compliance with safety and regulatory standards. Please
note that the use of this accessory with iPod or iPhone may affect wireless performance.
iPhone, iPod, iPod classic, iPod nano, and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other
countries.
MPEG Layer-3 audio coding technology licensed from Fraunhofer IIS and Thomson.
This receiver supports network connections.
Bluetooth™
Bluetooth is a registered trademark of the Bluetooth SIG and is used by Yamaha in accordance with a license
agreement.
“HDMI,” the “HDMI” logo and “High-Definition Multimedia Interface” are trademarks, or registered trademarks of HDMI
Licensing LLC.
x.v.Color™
“x.v.Color” is a trademark of Sony Corporation.
“SILENT CINEMA” is a trademark of Yamaha Corporation.
DLNA Certified is a trademark of the Digital Living Network Alliance in the United States and other countries.
Windows is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and other countries.
Windows XP, Windows Vista, Windows 7, Windows Media Audio, Windows Media Connect and Windows Media Player
are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft corporation in the United States and/or other countries.
Trademarks
En 135
Input jacks
• Analog Audio
Audio x 10 (AV1~4, AUDIO1~4, PHONO, V-AUX)
MULTI CH INPUT (8ch) x 1
(FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R,
SURROUND BACK L/R, SUBWOOFER)
• Digital Audio (Support fs: 32 kHz to 96 kHz)
Optical x 4 (AV3~4, AUDIO1, V-AUX)
Coaxial x 3 (AV1~2, AUDIO2)
•Video
Composite x 5 (AV1~4, V-AUX)
S-video x 5 (AV1~4, V-AUX)
Component x 4 (AV1~4)
• HDMI Input
HDMI (Front Panel) x 1 (V-AUX)
HDMI (Rear Panel) x 7 (AV1~7)
•Other
DOCK x 1 (Audio, Composite Video, S-video)
USB x 1 (USB2.0)
NETWORK x 1 (100Base-TX/10Base-T)
Output jacks
• Analog Audio
Speaker out x 9 (7 ch) (FRONT L/R, CENTER,
SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R, EXTRA SP L/R*
1
)
*1 Note: assignment is possible.
[ZONE2, F.PRESENCE, BI-AMP (FRONT L/R)]
Pre Out x 7 (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R,
SURROUND BACK L/R)
Subwoofer Out x 2 (SUBWOOFER 1~2, mono)
Audio x 1 (AV OUT)
ZONE OUT x 1
• Digital Audio
Optical x 1 (AV OUT)
•Video
MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT
- Composite x 1
- S-video x 1
- Component x 1
AV OUT
- Composite x 1
- S-video x 1
• HDMI Output
HDMI OUT x 2 (HDMI OUT1~2)
Remote jacks
• REMOTE IN x 1
• REMOTE OUT x 1
• TRIGGER OUT x 2
• RS-232C x 1
HDMI
• HDMI Specification: Deep Color, “x.v.Color,” Auto Lip Sync,
HDMI Control (CEC), ARC (Audio Return Channel), 3D
• Video Format (Repeater Mode)
- VGA
- 480i/60 Hz
- 576i/50 Hz
- 480p/60 Hz
- 576p/50 Hz
- 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz
- 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz
- 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 24 Hz
• Audio Format
- Dolby Digital
- DTS
- DSD 6ch
- Dolby Digital Plus
- Dolby TrueHD
- DTS-HD
- PCM 2ch-8ch (Max 192 kHz/24 bit)
• Content Protection: HDCP compatible
TUNER
Analog Tuner
[Europe model]
FM/AM with RDS x 1 (TUNER)
[Other models]
FM/AM x 1 (TUNER)
USB
• Capable of iPod, Mass Storage Class USB Memory, MTP
(Media Transfer Protocol)
Current Supply Capacity: 1 A
Network
PC Client Function
Compatible with Windows 7, DLNA ver. 1.5
Internet Radio
Compatible Decoding Formats
• Decoding Format
- Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus
- DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD High Resolution,
DTS Express
- Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital EX
- DTS, DTS 96/24, DTS-ES Matrix 6.1, DTS-ES Discrete 6.1
• Post Decoding Format
- Dolby Pro Logic
- Dolby Pro Logic II Music, Dolby Pro Logic II Movie,
Dolby Pro Logic II Game
- Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music, Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie,
Dolby Pro Logic IIx Game
- DTS Neo:6 Music, DTS Neo:6 Cinema
Specifications
En 136
Audio Section
• Rated Output Power
(20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.06% THD, 8Ω)
Front L/R .............................................................110 W+110 W
Center............................................................................. 110 W
Surround L/R.......................................................110 W+110 W
Surround Back L/R .............................................110 W+110 W
(1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8Ω)
Front L/R .......................................... 135 W/ch (120 W+120 W)
Center...........................................................135 W/ch (120 W)
Surround L/R.................................... 135 W/ch (120 W+120 W)
Surround Back L/R .......................... 135 W/ch (120 W+120 W)
(1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 4Ω) [Europe model]
Front L/R .................................................................... 170 W/ch
Maximum Effective Output Power (JEITA, 1 kHz, 10% THD, 8
Ω
)
[China model]
Front L/R .................................................................... 165 W/ch
Center ........................................................................ 165 W/ch
Surround L/R.............................................................. 165 W/ch
Surround Back L/R .................................................... 165 W/ch
• Dynamic Power (IHF)
Front L/R (8/6/4/2 Ω) .................................. 135/165/210/280 W
• Damping Factor
Front L/R, 1 kHz, 8 Ω ............................................. 150 or more
• Input Sensitivity / Input Impedance
PHONO (1 kHz, 100 W/8 Ω) ................................3.5 mV/47 kΩ
AUDIO2 etc. (1 kHz, 100 W/8 Ω)........................200 mV/47 kΩ
• Maximum Input Signal
PHONO (1 kHz, 0.5% THD)............................... 60 mV or more
AUDIO2 etc. (1 kHz, 0.5% THD) ......................... 2.4 V or more
• Output Level / Output Impedance
AV OUT ..............................................................200 mV/1.2 kΩ
HEADPHONE OUT .............................................150 mV/100 Ω
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER (50 Hz) ...........................................1.0 V/1.2 kΩ
Except SUBWOOFER (1 kHz) ...............................1.0 V/1.2 kΩ
ZONE OUT.............................................................1.0 V/1.2 kΩ
• Frequency Response
AUDIO2 etc. to Front (Pure Direct, 10 kHz to 100 kHz)
....................................................................................+0/-3 dB
• RIAA Equalization Deviation
PHONO (20 Hz to 20 kHz) .........................................0±0.5 dB
• Total Harmonic Distortion
PHONO to AV OUT.............................................. 0.02% or less
MULTI CH INPUT to SP OUT (Pure Direct, 70W, 8Ω)
............................................................................ 0.04% or less
• Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network)
PHONO to AV OUT (Input shorted 5 mV)
[Canada and China models].............................. 86 dB or more
[Other models] ...................................................81 dB or more
AUDIO2 etc. to SP OUT (Pure Direct, Input shorted 250 mV)
.........................................................................100 dB or more
• Residual Noise (IHF-A Network)
Front L/R (SP OUT)............................................. 150 µV or less
• Channel Separation
PHONO (Input Shorted, 1 kHz/10 kHz)... 60 dB/55 dB or more
AUDIO2 etc.
(Input 5.1 kΩ Shorted, 1 kHz/10 kHz) ..... 60 dB/45 dB or more
• Volume Control
Main Zone ................. MUTE, -80 dB to +16.5dB (0.5 dB step)
Zone2 ........................ MUTE, -80 dB to +16.5dB (0.5 dB step)
• Tone Control Characteristics (Front L/R)
Main Zone
Bass Boost/Cut......................... ±6.0 dB/50 Hz (0.5 dB step)
Bass Turnover............................................................. 350 Hz
Treble Boost/Cut ......................±6.0 dB/20 kHz (0.5 dB step)
Treble Turnover...........................................................3.5 kHz
Zone2
Bass Boost/Cut............................. ±10 dB/50 Hz (2 dB step)
Bass Turnover............................................................. 350 Hz
Treble Boost/Cut ........................... ±10 dB/50 Hz (2 dB step)
Treble Turnover...........................................................3.5 kHz
• Filter Characteristics
(fc=40/60/80/90/100/110/120/160/200 Hz)
H.P.F. (Front, Center, Surround, Surround Back: Small)
................................................................................. 12 dB/oct.
L.P.F. (Subwoofer)..................................................... 24 dB/oct.
Video Section
• Video Signal Type
[Canada model]...............................................................NTSC
[Other models]....................................................................PAL
• Video Signal Type (Video Conversion)..................... NTSC/PAL
• Video Signal Level
Composite..............................................................1 Vp-p/75 Ω
S-Video
Y ..........................................................................1 Vp-p/75 Ω
C (NTSC) [Canada model]...........................0.286 Vp-p/75 Ω
C (PAL) [Other models]....................................0.3 Vp-p/75 Ω
Component
Y ..........................................................................1 Vp-p/75 Ω
Pb/Pr ................................................................0.7 Vp-p/75 Ω
• Video Maximum Input Level (Video Conversion Off)
....................................................................... 1.5 Vp-p or more
Signal to Noise Ratio (Video Conversion Off) .... 60 dB or more
• Monitor Out Frequency Response (Video Conversion Off)
Component (MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT)
........................................................... 5 Hz to 100 MHz, ±3 dB
FM Section
• Tuning Range
[Canada model].................................. 87.5 MHz to 107.9 MHz
[Other models]................................ 87.50 MHz to 108.00 MHz
• 50 dB Quiet Sensitivity (IHF, 1 kHz, 100% MOD.)
Mono ................................................................. 3 µV (20.8 dBf)
Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF)
Mono/Stereo.......................................................... 72 dB/70 dB
Harmonic Distortion (IHF, 1 kHz)
Mono/Stereo.............................................................0.3%/0.5%
Antenna Input................................................ 75 Ω unbalanced
En 137
AM section
• Tuning Range
[Canada model]....................................... 530 kHz to 1710 kHz
[Other models]......................................... 531 kHz to 1611 kHz
General
• Power Supply
[Canada model]............................................. AC 120 V, 60 Hz
[China model]................................................. AC 220 V, 50 Hz
[Australia model] ............................................ AC 240 V, 50 Hz
[Europe model]............................................... AC 230 V, 50 Hz
• Power Consumption
[Canada model].................................................. 400 W/510 VA
[Other models]................................................................ 490 W
• Standby Power Consumption
HDMI Control Off / Standby Through Off..............0.3 W or less
HDMI Control On/Standby Through On (Typical)............ 2.0 W
Network Standby On (Typical)......................................... 2.5 W
• Dimensions (W x H x D)............................435 x 182 x 430 mm
(17-1/8” x 7-1/8” x 16-7/8”)
• Weight........................................................... 15.1 kg (33.3 lbs)
* Specifications are subject to change without notice.
© 2011 Yamaha Corporation
YD504A0/OMEN

Documenttranscriptie

AV Receiver Owner’s Manual Be sure to read “Safety Brochure” (supplied booklet) before using this unit. English for Canada, Europe and Oceania En 1 CONTENTS Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 FEATURES 7 Connecting the power cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 8 Selecting an on-screen menu language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 9 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) . . . . . . . . . 41 What you can do with this unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Measuring at one listening position (single measure) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Part names and functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Front display (indicators) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 Rear panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11 Checking the measurement results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Reloading the previous YPAO results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Error messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Warning messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12 SETUP General setup procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 PLAYBACK Basic playback procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Selecting an HDMI output jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 1 Connecting speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Selecting the input source and favorite settings at once (SCENE) . . 49 Basic speaker configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15 Configuring scene assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Advanced speaker configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 Input/output jacks and cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 2 Connecting a TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 3 Connecting playback devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Selecting the sound mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Enjoying sound field effects (CINEMA DSP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Enjoying unprocessed playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (Pure Direct) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Enjoying compressed music with enhanced sound (Compressed Music Enhancer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Connecting video devices (BD/DVD players, etc.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31 Enjoying surround sound with headphones (SILENT CINEMA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Connecting audio devices (CD players, etc.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 Listening to FM/AM radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Connecting to the jacks on the front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34 4 Connecting the FM/AM antennas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 5 Connecting to the network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Selecting a frequency for reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Registering favorite radio stations (preset) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Radio Data System tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Operating the radio on the TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 6 Connecting other devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Connecting video/audio recording devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37 Connecting a device with analog multi-channel output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37 Connecting a device compatible with SCENE link playback (remote connection) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38 Connecting a device compatible with the trigger function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38 Playing back iPod music/videos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Connecting an iPod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Playback of iPod contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Playing back music via Bluetooth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 En 2 Connecting a Bluetooth receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65 HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Pairing Bluetooth components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65 Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 Establishing a wireless connection and playing back . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66 Multi Zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Playing back music stored on a USB storage device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Connecting a USB storage device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67 Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Playback of USB storage device contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67 Viewing information about this unit (Information menu) . . . . . . . . 110 Playing back music stored on PCs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 Types of information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Media sharing setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70 Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) . . . . . 112 Playback of PC music contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70 ADVANCED SETUP menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Listening to Internet radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Changing the speaker impedance setting (SPEAKER IMP.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Turning on/off the remote control sensor (REMOTE SENSOR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Selecting the remote control ID (REMOTE CON AMP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Preparing for Zone2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 Switching the video signal type (TV FORMAT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Controlling Zone2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78 Removing the limitation on HDMI video output (MONITOR CHECK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Useful functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Backing up/recovering the settings (RECOV./BACKUP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Registering favorite items (shortcut) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80 Controlling this unit from the web browser (web control) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81 Viewing the current status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83 Configuring settings in accordance with a playback source (Option menu) . . . 84 Option menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84 Restoring the default settings (INITIALIZE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Updating the firmware (FIRM UPDATE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Checking the firmware version (VERSION) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Controlling external devices with the remote control . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Setting the remote control code for a TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Setting the remote control codes for playback devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 CONFIGURATIONS Configuring input sources (Input menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87 Programming from other remote controls (learning) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 Resetting remote control codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Updating the firmware of this unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Input menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87 Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 Scene menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) . . . . 92 Sound Program menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93 Configuring various functions (Setup menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Setup menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96 Speaker (Manual Setup) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98 Sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 En 3 APPENDIX Frequently asked questions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Power and system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 FM/AM radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 USB and network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 Error indications on the front display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Audio information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Video information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 Video signal flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 Information on HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 HDMI Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 HDMI signal compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 Reference diagram (rear panel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 Trademarks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 En 4 Accessories Operating range of the remote control Check that the following accessories are supplied with this product. ■ Remote control • Aim the remote control directly at the remote control sensor on this unit during operation. ■ Batteries (AAA, R03, UM-4) (x 2) Within 6 m 30° 30° Insert into the remote control in the correct polarity (+/-) ■ YPAO microphone ■ Power cable *The figure of the supplied power cable differs depending on regions. ■ AM antenna ■ FM antenna *The figure of the supplied FM antenna differs depending on regions. ■ Easy Setup Guide ■ CD-ROM (Owner’s Manual) • Some features are not available in certain regions. • Design and specifications are subject to change in part as a result of improvements, etc. In case of differences between the manual and product, the product has priority. • This manual mainly explains operations using the supplied remote control. • This manual describes both the “iPod” and “iPhone” as the “iPod”. “iPod” means both “iPod” and “iPhone” unless the explanation describes exceptions. ■ Safety Brochure • “ ” indicates the cautions concerning operations or setup of the unit. • “ ” indicates the explanations for better use. En 5 FEATURES What you can do with this unit Ready for any kind of contents Network iPod p.60 p.70 to p.73 USB p.65 p.67 Bluetooth *Requires optional Bluetooth receiver for playback via Bluetooth iPod Network contents Audio USB device Speakers Audio Supports 2 to 7 channel (plus front presence) speaker system and up to 2 subwoofer connections. Allows you to enjoy favorite acoustic spaces in various styles. Plus, bi-amp connections, channel p.19 expansion (with external power-amp) and multi-zone configurations to enhance your system Automatically optimizing the speaker p.41 settings to suit your room (YPAO) Sound field reproductions like actual p.52 movie theaters and concert halls from stereo or multi-channel audio sources (CINEMA DSP) Enjoying compressed music with p.55 enhanced sound (Compressed Music Enhancer) HDMI Control via Bluetooth Audio HDMI Control Video Audio/Video BD/DVD player TV AV receiver (this unit) Operating external devices with the supplied remote control p.115 Remote control of this unit Selecting the input source and favorite settings at once (SCENE) p.49 Operating the TV, AV receiver and BD/DVD player in combination (HDMI Control) TV remote control p.131 En 6 Full of useful functions! ● Connecting various devices (p.31) A number of HDMI jacks and various input/output jacks on this unit allow you to connect video devices such as BD/DVD players, audio devices such as CD players, game consoles and camcorders, and so on. ● Creating stereoscopic sound fields (p.54) At time like this Connection of front presence speakers enables to create a natural stereoscopic sound field in your room (CINEMA DSP 3D). Even when no front presence speakers are connected, this unit automatically creates Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) to produce 3D surround sound. I want to connect a playback device using HDMI for video and non-HDMI for audio... Use “Audio Select” in the “Option” menu to specify the type of an audio input jack to be used for the corresponding input source (p.86). Video and audio are not synchronized... Use “Lipsync” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the delay between video and audio output (p.101). Turntable I want to hear audio from the TV speakers... Use “Audio Output” in the “Setup” menu to select whether to output audio signals through this unit and the TV (p.104). CD player BD/DVD player I want to this unit to be turned off automatically when not in use... Use “Auto Power Down” in the “Setup” menu to set the amount of time for auto-standby (p.107). Game console TV ● Listening to FM/AM radio (p.56) Camcorder ● Playing back TV audio in surround sound with a single HDMI cable connection (Audio Return Channel: ARC) (p.25) When using a TV that supports ARC, you only need a single HDMI cable to connect the TV and this unit to output video to the TV, input audio from the TV, and transmit HDMI Control signals. HDMI Control TV audio Video from external device This unit is equipped with the built-in FM/AM tuner. You can register favorite radio stations as presets. ● Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (p.55) When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, this unit plays back the selected source with the least circuitry. It allows you to enjoy Hi-Fi sound quality. ● Easy operation with a TV screen You can navigate the various contents (iPod, USB, network, etc.), view the information, or configure the settings using the on-screen menu. I want to change the on-screen menu language... Use “Language” in the “Setup” menu to select a language from English, Japanese, French, German, Spanish and Russian (p.110). I want to update the firmware... Use “UPDATE” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to update the firmware of this unit (p.114). If this unit is connected to the Internet, the corresponding message will be displayed on the TV when a newer firmware is available (p.119). There are many other settings to customize this unit. For details, see the following pages. ●Input settings (p.87) ●Scene settings (p.90) ●Sound program and surround decoder settings (p.93) ●Various function settings (p.96) ●Information view (audio signal, video signal, etc.) (p.111) ●System settings (p.112) En 7 Part names and functions Front panel 1 2 3 4 5 NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V1071 MAIN ZONE PURE DIRECT INPUT VOLUME ON SCREEN OPTION TONE/BALANCE SCENE STRAIGHT 1 2 3 INFO MEMORY PRESET FM AM TUNING/CH 4 MULTI ZONE PROGRAM ENTER ZONE 2 RETURN ZONE CONTROL DISPLAY VIDEO AUX PHONES USB iPod/iPhone 6 1 MAIN ZONE Turns on/off (standby) this unit. 2 Standby indicator Lights up when this unit is in standby mode under any of the following conditions. - HDMI Control is enabled (p.131) - The standby through function is enabled (p.104) - The network standby function is enabled (p.105) - The iPod is being charged (p.88) - An iPod wireless system is connected (p.61) YPAO MIC SILENT CINEMA S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R OPTICAL 7 HDMI IN 8 7 Front panel door For protecting controls and jacks (p.9). 8 VOLUME Adjusts the volume. Opening the front panel door • To use controls or jacks behind the front panel door, gently press the bottom of the door to open it. Keep the door closed when not using controls or jacks behind the front panel door. 3 Front display Displays information (p.10). 4 Remote control sensor Receives remote control signals (p.5). 5 PURE DIRECT Enables/disables Pure Direct (p.55). 6 INPUT Selects an input source. En 8 ■ Inside of the front panel cover 9 0 AB C ON SCREEN OPTION DE TONE/BALANCE F G H SCENE STRAIGHT 1 2 3 K INFO MEMORY PRESET FM AM TUNING/CH L 4 MULTI ZONE PROGRAM I J ENTER ZONE 2 RETURN ZONE CONTROL DISPLAY VIDEO AUX PHONES USB 9 ON SCREEN Displays the on-screen menu on the TV. 0 Menu operation keys Cursor keys Select a menu or parameter. ENTER Confirms a selected item. RETURN Returns to the previous screen. A OPTION Displays the option menu (p.84). B DISPLAY Display the status information on the TV (p.83). C TONE/BALANCE Adjusts the high-frequency range and low-frequency range of sounds output from speakers and headphones (p.85). Adjusts the right/left channel volume balance for Zone2 (p.79). D STRAIGHT Enables/disables the straight decode mode (p.54). E PROGRAM Selects a sound program or a surround decoder (p.51). iPod/iPhone YPAO MIC SILENT CINEMA M N O S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R OPTICAL HDMI IN P F SCENE Selects the registered input source, sound program, HDMI output and various settings at once. Additionally, you can turn on this unit when it is in standby mode (p.49). G MULTI ZONE Enables/disables the audio output to Zone2 (p.78). ZONE CONTROL Switches the zones (main or Zone2) to operate with the front panel controllers (p.78). ZONE 2 H INFO Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.83). I MEMORY L TUNING/CH Selects the radio frequency (p.56). M USB jack For connecting a USB storage device (p.67) or an iPod via USB (p.60). N YPAO MIC jack For connecting the supplied YPAO microphone (p.41). O PHONES jack For connecting headphones. P VIDEO AUX jacks For connecting camcorders, game consoles, etc (p.34). Registers FM/AM radio stations as preset stations (p.56). Registers USB/network contents as shortcuts (p.80). J FM/AM Switches between FM and AM (p.56). K PRESET Selects a preset FM/AM radio station (p.57). Selects a USB/network content from shortcuts (p.80). En 9 Front display (indicators) 1 2 34 6 5 STEREO TUNED ZONE IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP 7 A PL L C R PR SL SW SR SBL SB SBR B 1 HDMI Lights up during normal HDMI communication. IN Lights up when HDMI signals are being input. OUT1/OUT2 Indicate the HDMI OUT jacks currently outputting an HDMI signal. 2 STEREO Lights up when this unit is receiving a stereo FM radio signal. TUNED Lights up when this unit is receiving an FM/AM radio station signal. 3 ZONE 2 Lights up when the audio output to Zone2 is enabled. 4 SLEEP Lights up when the sleep timer is on. 5 PARTY Lights up when this unit is in the party mode. 9 MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PARTY 3 0 8 B 6 Information display Displays the current status (input name, sound mode name, etc). You can switch the information by pressing INFO (p.83). 7 MUTE Flashes when audio is muted. 8 Volume indicator Indicates the current volume. 9 ADAPTIVE DRC Lights up when Adaptive DRC (p.85) is working. 0 ENHANCER Lights up when Compressed Music Enhancer (p.55) is working. A CINEMA DSP C C Speaker indicators Indicate speaker terminals from which signals are output. Front speaker (L) Front speaker (R) Center speaker Surround speaker (L) Surround speaker (R) Surround back speaker (L) Surround back speaker (R) Surround back speaker Front presence speaker (L) Lights up when CINEMA DSP (p.52) is working. Front presence speaker (R) CINEMA DSP 3 Subwoofer Lights up when CINEMA DSP 3D (p.54) is working. B Cursor indicators Indicate the remote control cursor keys currently operational. En 10 Rear panel 1 2 7 3 4 56 NETWORK DOCK 8 2 AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT A B AV 2 AV 3 RS-232C AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV 7 Y PB COMPONENT VIDEO PR Y AV 3 PB C TRIGGER OUT PR AV 1 A PHONO Y GND 1 REMOTE MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT PR PB IN OUT AV 2 2 B D AV 4 AUDIO 1 (2 TV) L AUDIO 2 (3 CD) C (1 BD/DVD) ARC AV 1 0 HDMI HDMI OUT 1 (1 BD/DVD) 9 AUDIO 3 AUDIO 4 MULTI CH INPUT +12V 0.1A MAX. ZONE OUT CENTER PRE OUT (SINGLE) SURROUND SUR. BACK 1 R 2 1 COAXIAL 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL 5 OPTICAL 6 COAXIAL FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER ZONE 2 FRONT SUBWOOFER CENTER SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R SURROUND BACK CENTER L R FRONT L ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/ R BI–AMP EXTRA SP L AC IN ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω SINGLE D E 1 PHONO jacks For connecting a turntable (p.33). 2 DOCK jack For connecting an optional Yamaha products such as iPod dock (p.61), iPod wireless system (p.61), and Bluetooth receiver (p.65). 3 AV1~4 jacks For connecting video/audio playback devices to input video/ audio signals (p.31). 4 NETWORK jack For connecting to the network (p.36). 5 AV OUT jacks For outputting video/audio to a recording device (VCR, tape deck, etc.) (p.37). 6 MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT (composite video/S-video) jacks For connecting a TV compatible with composite video or Svideo to output video signals (p.29). For connecting a Zone2 video monitor (p.76). 7 HDMI OUT 1~2 jacks For connecting HDMI-compatible TVs to output video/audio signals (p.25). When using ARC, TV audio signal is input through the HDMI OUT 1 jack. F G H I 8 COMPONENT VIDEO (AV1~4) jacks For connecting video playback devices compatible with component video to input video signals (p.32). 9 HDMI (AV1~7) jacks For connecting HDMI-compatible playback devices to input video/audio signals (p.31). 0 MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT (component video) jacks For connecting a TV compatible with component video to output video signals (p.29). For connecting a Zone2 video monitor (p.76). A REMOTE IN/OUT jacks For connecting a Yamaha product compatible with SCENE link playback (p.38), or connecting an infrared signal receiver/emitter to operate devices including this unit from another room (p.77). B TRIGGER OUT 1~2 jacks J E AUDIO1~4 jacks For connecting audio playback devices to input audio signals (p.33). F MULTI CH INPUT jacks For connecting a device that supports multi-channel output to input audio signals (p.37). G ZONE OUT jacks For connecting an external amplifier used in Zone2 to output audio (p.76). H PRE OUT jacks For connecting subwoofers with built-in amplifier (p.18) or an external power amplifier (p.23). I SPEAKERS terminals For connecting speakers (p.14). J AC IN For connecting the supplied power cable (p.39). For connecting devices that support the trigger function (p.38). C RS-232C terminal This is a control expansion terminal for custom installation. Consult your dealer for details. D ANTENNA jacks For connecting FM and AM antennas (p.35). En 11 Remote control 1 Remote control signal transmitter Transmits infrared signals. 1 2 3 2 MAIN/ZONE2 MAIN ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER E 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB 5 FM 6 INFO MEMORY 7 MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO 8 9 0 A C Switches the devices (this unit or external device) to operate with the remote control (p.116). You can operate this unit when this key lights up in orange, and an external device when this key lights up in green. RECEIVER Turns on/off (standby) this unit. 4 Input selection keys AM PRESET TUNING SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT F SCENE ON SCREEN G OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN H DISPLAY POP-UP MENU TOP MENU B SOURCE/RECEIVER AUDIO TUNER MUTE MODE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 I J K Select an input source to play back. AV1~7 AV1~7 jacks V-AUX VIDEO AUX jacks (on the front panel) AUDIO1~4 AUDIO1~4 jacks MULTI MULTI CH INPUT jacks PHONO PHONO jacks DOCK DOCK jack TUNER FM/AM radio NET NETWORK jack (press repeatedly to select a desired network source) USB USB jack (on the front panel) 5 Radio keys Operate the FM/AM radio when “TUNER” is selected as the input source. FM Switches to FM radio. AM Switches to AM radio. MEMORY Registers FM/AM radio stations as presets. PRESET Selects a preset station. TUNING Selects the radio frequency. 6 INFO 10 Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.83). ENT 7 SLEEP TV D 3 SOURCE Turns on/off an external device. AV 4 Switches the zones (main or Zone2) to operate with the remote control (p.78). INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH HDMI OUT L Switches this unit to standby mode automatically after a specified period of time has elapsed (sleep timer). Press repeatedly to set the time (120 min, 90 min, 60 min, 30 min, off). 9 SCENE Selects the assigned input source, sound program, HDMI output and various settings at once. Additionally, you can turn on this unit when it is in standby mode (p.49). 0 ON SCREEN Displays the on-screen menu on the TV. A Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN Select a menu or a parameter. Confirms a selected item. Returns to the previous screen. B MODE Switches between stereo and monaural for FM radio reception. Switches the iPod operation modes (p.63). C Numeric keys Enter numerical values such as radio frequencies. D TV operation keys Operate TV input, TV volume, etc (p.115). E CODE SET Registers remote control codes of external devices on the remote control (p.115). F Sound mode keys Select a sound mode (p.51). G OPTION Displays the option menu (p.84). H VOLUME Adjusts the volume. I DISPLAY Displays the status information on the TV (p.83). J MUTE Mutes the audio output. K External device operation keys Operate playback and menu display etc. for external devices (p.116). L HDMI OUT Selects HDMI OUT jacks to be used for video/audio output (p.48). 8 PARTY Turns on/off the party mode (p.79). • To operate external devices with the remote control, register a remote control code for each device in advance (p.115). En 12 SETUP General setup procedure 1 Connecting speakers (p.14) Basic speaker configuration (p.15) Select the speaker layout and connect the speakers to this unit. Advanced speaker configuration (p.19) Apply bi-amp connections, channel expansion (using an external power amplifier) or multi-zone configurations to enhance the system. 2 Connecting a TV (p.25) Connect a TV to this unit. 3 Connecting playback devices (p.31) Connect video devices (BD/DVD players, etc.) and audio devices (CD players, etc.) to this unit. 4 Connecting the FM/AM antennas (p.35) Connect the supplied FM/AM antennas to this unit. 5 Connecting to the network (p.36) Connect this unit to the network. 6 Connecting other devices (p.37) Connect external devices such as recording devices. 7 Connecting the power cable (p.39) After all the connections are complete, plug in the power cable. 8 Selecting an on-screen menu language (p.40) Select a desired on-screen menu language (default: English). 9 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) (p.41) Optimize the speaker settings such as volume balance and acoustic parameters to suit your room (YPAO). Now all the preparations are complete. Enjoy playing movies, music, radio, etc. with this unit! En 13 1 Speaker connections 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 Connecting speakers This unit has 7 built-in amplifiers. You can connect 2 to 9 speakers and up to 2 subwoofers (with built-in amplifier) to create the favorite acoustic space in your room. You can also apply bi-amp connections, channel expansion (using an external power amplifier) or multi-zone configurations to enhance your system (p.19). Caution • This unit is configured for 8-ohm speakers at the factory. When connecting 6-ohm speakers, set the speaker impedance of this unit to “6 Ω MIN”. In this case, you can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers. For details, see “Setting the speaker impedance” (p.16). Ideal speaker layout Functions of each speaker Speaker type Abbr. Function Front (L) Produce front right/left channel sounds (stereo sounds). Front (R) Center Produces center channel sounds (dialogs, vocals, etc). Surround (L) Produce surround right/left channel sounds. Surround speakers also produce surround back channel sounds when no surround back speakers are connected. Surround (R) Surround back (L) Surround back (R) Front presence (L) Front presence (R) Subwoofer 0.5 to 1 m 0.5 to 1 m 1.8 m 1.8 m Produce surround back right/left channel sounds. When no surround back speakers are connected, Surround back channel sounds are produced from the surround speakers. Produce CINEMA DSP effect sounds. In combination with CINEMA DSP 3D (p.54), the front presence speakers create a natural stereoscopic sound field in your room. Produces LFE (low-frequency effect) channel sounds and reinforces bass parts of other channels. This channel is counted as “0.1”. You can connect 2 subwoofers (with built-in amplifier) to this unit and place them on the right/left (or front/ rear) sides of the room. 10°~30° • We recommend using front presence speakers to have a full effect of the stereoscopic sound fields. However, this unit creates Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center and surround speakers to produce stereoscopic sound fields even when no front presence speakers are connected (p.54). 10°~30° 30 cm or more • Use “Ideal speaker layout” (diagram on the right) as reference. You do not need to exactly adjust the speaker layout to this diagram since the YPAO function of this unit will automatically optimize the speaker settings (distance, etc.) to suit the speaker layout. • When using only one surround back speaker, place it straight behind the listening position (middle of “SBL” and “SBR” in the diagram). En 14 1 Speaker connections 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Basic speaker configuration ■ Placing speakers in your room Depending on the number of speakers, place the speakers and subwoofer (with built-in amplifier) in your room. This section describes the representative speaker layout examples. ❑ 7.1+2 channel system (using both surround back and front presence speakers) ❑ 7.1 channel system (using front presence speakers) This speaker system brings out the full performance of this unit and allows you to enjoy a natural stereoscopic sound field with any contents. This speaker system uses the front presence speakers to produce a highly-natural stereoscopic sound field, and is suited for enjoying 5.1-channel contents. ❑ 7.1 channel system (using surround back speakers) • The surround back speakers and front presence speakers do not produce sounds simultaneously. This unit automatically switches the speakers to be used depending on a selected CINEMA DSP (p.52). This speaker system creates Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center and surround speakers to produce a stereoscopic sound field, and also allows you to enjoy extended surround sounds using the surround back speakers. En 15 1 Speaker connections 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ❑ 5.1 channel system ■ Setting the speaker impedance This unit is configured for 8-ohm speakers at the factory. When connecting 6-ohm speakers, set the speaker impedance to “6 Ω MIN”. In this case, you can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers. connecting speakers, connect the supplied power cable to 1 Before this unit and then to an AC wall outlet. 2 While holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press MAIN ZONE MAIN ZONE . STRAIGHT This speaker system creates Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center and surround speakers to produce a stereoscopic sound field, and is suited for enjoying 5.1-channel contents. ❑ 2.1 channel system 3 Check that “SPEAKER IMP.” is displayed on the front display. SPIMP.- DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 SPEAKERIMP. 8MIN MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR 4 Press STRAIGHT to select “6 Ω MIN”. MAIN ZONE to set this unit to standby mode and remove the 5 Press power cable from the AC wall outlet. Now you are ready to connect the speakers. Even when no surround speakers are connected, this unit creates the virtual surround speakers using the front speakers to allow you to enjoy multi-channel surround sound (Virtual CINEMA DSP). • Add the center speaker to configure a 3.1-channel system. En 16 1 Speaker connections 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ■ Connecting speakers Connection diagram Refer to the following diagram and connect the speakers to this unit. Connect the speakers placed in your room to this unit. MULTI CH INPUT ZONE OUT CENTER PRE OUT (SINGLE) SURROUND SUR. BACK 1 Caution 2 • Remove the power cable of this unit from an AC wall outlet and turn off the subwoofer before connecting the speakers. This unit (rear) URROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER ZONE 2 FRONT SUBWOOFER CENTER SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R SURROUND BACK L CENTER R FRONT L ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/ R BI–AMP EXTRA SP L • Be careful that the core of the speaker cable does not touch anything or come into contact with the metal areas of this unit. This may damage this unit or the speakers. If the speaker cables short circuit, “CHECK SP WIRES” will appear on the front display when this unit is turned on. SINGLE Speakers to be connected Room Main zone Speaker type Speaker system (the number of channels) Abbr. 7+2 7 5 2 Front (L) ● ● ● ● Front (R) ● ● ● ● Center ● ● ● Surround (L) ● ● ● Surround (R) ● ● ● Surround back (L) ● {*1 Surround back (R) ● {*1 Front presence (L) ● {*2 Front presence (R) ● {*2 Power Amp Assign (p.98) Basic (default) If you have 7 speakers, use two of them as surround back speakers (*1) or front presence speakers (*2). • You can also connect up to 2 subwoofers (with built-in amplifier) to this unit. • To use an external power amplifier (Hi-Fi amplifier, etc.) to enhance speaker output, see “Connecting an external power amplifier” (p.23). Cables necessary for connection (commercially available) • When using only one surround back speaker, connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side). Speaker cables (x the number of speakers) + – + – Audio pin cable (2 for connecting 2 subwoofers) En 17 1 Speaker connections 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ❑ Connecting speaker cables Speaker cables have two wires. One is for connecting the negative (-) terminal of the unit and the speaker, and the other is for the positive (+) terminal. If the wires are colored to prevent confusion, connect the black wire to the negative and the other wire to the positive. a Remove approximately 10 mm of insulation from the ends of the speaker cable, and twist the bare wires of the cable together firmly. b Loosen the speaker terminal. c Insert the bare wires of the cable into the gap on the side (upper right or bottom left) of the terminal. d Tighten the terminal. + (red) + c FR ON T b - a d – (black) Using a banana plug (Canada, China and Australia models only) a Tighten the speaker terminal. b Insert a banana plug into the end of the terminal. a Banana plug + FR ON T b ❑ Connecting the subwoofer Use an audio pin cable to connect the subwoofer. Audio pin cable PRE OUT (SING LE) 1 2 SURR UND SUR. BACK SUBW OOFE R CENT ER CENT ER FRO NT En 18 1 Speaker connections 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Advanced speaker configuration In addition to the basic speaker configuration (p.15), this unit also allows you to apply the following speaker configurations to enhance your system. Using the four internal amplifiers for front speakers to have more high-quality sounds Combining with an external power amplifier (Hi-Fi amplifier, etc.) to build an extended system Using the excess internal amplifiers for stereo speakers in another room Bi-amp connection Power-amp channel expansion Multi-zone configuration (Example) (Example) (Example) External power amplifier Bi-amp connection Zone2 Main zone En 19 1 Speaker connections 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ■ Available speaker configurations ❑ 5ch BI-AMP Bi-amp Main zone Output channel (max) Bi-amp 5 { 7 7 { External power amplifier (required) Multi-zone Surround back +1 (Zone2) Power Amp Assign (p.98) Page 5ch BI-AMP 20 5ch BI-AMP +SB 21 7ch +1ZONE 21 • When applying one of these configurations, you need to configure the “Power Amp Assign” setting (p.98) in the “Setup” menu. Speaker Connect to FRONT and EXTRA SP (bi-amp connection) CENTER SURROUND (not used) (not used) SUBWOOFER 1~2 En 20 1 Speaker connections 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ❑ 5ch BI-AMP +SB ❑ 7ch +1ZONE Bi-amp Zone2 Main zone via external amp Speaker Connect to Speaker Connect to FRONT and EXTRA SP (bi-amp connection) FRONT CENTER CENTER SURROUND SURROUND SUR.BACK (PRE OUT) via external power amplifier SURROUND BACK (not used) (not used) SUBWOOFER 1~2 SUBWOOFER 1~2 Zone2 speakers EXTRA SP • When Zone2 output is enabled (p.78), the surround back speakers in the main zone do not output sound. En 21 1 Speaker connections 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ■ Connecting front speakers that support bi-amp connections ■ Connecting Zone2 speakers When using front speakers that support bi-amp connections, connect them to the FRONT jacks and EXTRA SP jacks. To enable the bi-amp function, configure the “Power Amp Assign” setting (p.98) in the “Setup” menu after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet. When using Zone2 speakers, connect them to the EXTRA SP jacks. To utilize the EXTRA SP jacks for Zone2 speakers, configure the “Power Amp Assign” setting (p.98) in the “Setup” menu after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet. This unit (rear) SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R SURROUND BACK L CENTER R FRONT L ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/ R BI–AMP EXTRA SP L This unit (rear) SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R SURROUND BACK L CENTER R FRONT L ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/ R BI–AMP EXTRA SP L SINGLE SINGLE Zone2 Main zone • You can also connect Zone2 speakers using an external amplifier (p.76). Caution • Before making bi-amp connections, remove any brackets or cables that connect a woofer with a tweeter. Refer to the instruction manual of the speakers for details. When not making bi-amp connections, make sure that the brackets or cables are connected before connecting the speaker cables. En 22 1 Speaker connections 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ■ Connecting an external power amplifier When using an external power amplifier to enhance speaker output, connect the input jacks of the power amplifier to the PRE OUT jacks of this unit. The same channel signals are output from the PRE OUT jacks as from their corresponding SPEAKERS terminals. (Example) Connecting front speakers via an external power amplifier PRE OUT (FRONT) jacks MI RS-232C AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV 7 Caution Main input jack TRIGGER OUT • To prevent the generation of loud noises or abnormal sounds, make sure the followings before making connections. MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT PB PR IN MAIN IN OUT PR 2 +12V 0.1A MAX. PRE OUT (SINGLE) 1 - Remove the power cable of this unit and turn off the external power amplifier before connecting them. - When using the PRE OUT jacks, do not connect speakers to the corresponding SPEAKERS terminals. 1 REMOTE L L 2 FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER R CENTER SPEAKERS SURROUND BACK L CENTER R FRONT L ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/ R BI–AMP EXTRA SP FRONT - When using an external amplifier that does not have the volume control bypass, do not connect other devices (except this unit) to the amplifier. SUR L R AC IN Amplifier with volume control bypass (A-S2000, etc.) SINGLE This unit (rear) This unit (rear) HDMI AV 2 AV 3 ONENT VIDEO Y AV 3 PB C RS-232C AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV 7 TRIGGER OUT PR Y MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT PB PR 1 REMOTE IN OUT 2 D AV 4 TI CH INPUT +12V 0.1A MAX. ZONE OUT CENTER PRE OUT (SINGLE) SURROUND SUR. BACK 1 2 ND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER ZONE 2 FRONT SUBWOOFER CENTER SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R SURROUND BACK L CENTER R FRONT L ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/ R BI–AMP EXTRA SP L AC IN SINGLE 1 23 4 1 FRONT jacks Output front channel sounds. 2 SURROUND jacks Output surround channel sounds. 3 SUR. BACK jacks About external power amplifiers We recommend using power amplifiers that meet the following conditions. - With unbalanced inputs - With volume control bypass (or without volume control circuit) - Output power: 100 W (8Ω) or more Output surround back channel sounds. When using only one external amplifier for the surround back channel, connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side). 4 CENTER jack • When using an external amplifier that does no have the volume control bypass, turn up the volume of the external amplifier enough and fix it. Outputs center channel sounds. En 23 Input/output jacks and cables ■ Video/audio jacks ■ Video jacks ■ Audio jacks ❑ HDMI jacks ❑ COMPONENT VIDEO jacks ❑ OPTICAL jacks Transmit digital video and digital sound through a single jack. Use an HDMI cable. Transmit video signals separated into three components: luminance (Y), chrominance blue (PB), and chrominance red (PR). Use a component video cable with three plugs. Transmit digital audio signals. Use a digital optical cable. Remove the tip protector (if available) before using the cable. AV 1 HDMI cable Digital Optical cable EN PON COM Component video cable AV 1 A • Use a 19-pin HDMI cable with the HDMI logo. We recommend using a cable less than 5.0 m long to prevent signal quality degradation. • To connect a device that has a DVI jack, an HDMI/DVI-D cable is required. • The HDMI jacks of this unit support the HDMI Control, Audio Return Channel (ARC), and 3D video transmission (through output) features. ❑ COAXIAL jacks ❑ S VIDEO jack Transmits S-video signals that include luminance (Y) and chrominance (C) components. Use an S-video cable. Transmit digital audio signals. Use a digital coaxial cable. Digital coaxial cable S-video cable ❑ AUDIO jacks Transmit analog stereo audio signals. Use a stereo pin cable. ❑ VIDEO jacks Stereo pin cable Transmit analog video signals. Use a video pin cable. AV 1 Video pin cable En 24 1 2 TV connection 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 2 Connecting a TV Connect a TV to this unit so that videos input to this unit can be output to the TV. You can also enjoy playback of TV audio on this unit. The connection method varies depending on functions and video input jacks available on your TV. Refer to the instruction manual of the TV and choose a connection method. Does your TV support Audio Return Channel (ARC)? ■ Connection method 1 (HDMI Control/ARC-compatible TV) Connect the TV to this unit with an HDMI cable. Yes ■ Connection method 1 (p.25) • The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “HDMI” parameters (p.103) in the “Setup” menu. • HDMI Control is available only on the HDMI OUT 1 jack. No Does your TV support HDMI Control? HDMI OUT 1 jack Yes HDMI OUT ■ Connection method 2 (p.27) 1 2 ARC HDMI This unit (rear) No NETWORK DOCK HDMI OUT 1 2 AV 1 (1 ARC Does your TV have an HDMI input jack? AV 1 Yes (1 BD/DVD) AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT Y HDMI input (ARC-compatible) PB AV 1 ■ Connection method 3 (p.28) No GND AV 2 B AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 5 OPTICAL 6 COAXIAL (2 TV) L (3 CD) AUDIO 3 HDMI AUDIO 4 R 1 COAXIAL ■ Connection method 4 (p.29) HDMI A PHONO 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL FRONT ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω TV About HDMI Control HDMI Control allows you to operate external devices via HDMI. If you connect a TV that supports HDMI Control to this unit with an HDMI cable, you can control this unit (power, volume, etc.) in conjunction with TV remote control operations. You can also control playback devices (HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD player, etc.) connected to this unit with an HDMI cable. For details, see “HDMI Control” (p.131). • If you make an HDMI connection between your TV and this unit, any videos input to this unit can be output to the TV no matter how you connect video devices to this unit. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.130). • You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.30). About Audio Return Channel (ARC) ARC allows audio signals to travel both ways under HDMI Control. So if you connect a TV that supports HDMI Control and ARC to this unit with a single HDMI cable, you can output video/audio to the TV or input TV audio to this unit. En 25 1 2 TV connection 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ❑ Necessary settings To use HDMI Control and ARC, you need to configure the following settings. For details on settings and operations of your TV, refer to the instruction manual of the TV. connecting external devices (TV, playback devices, etc.) and 1 After power cable of this unit, turn on this unit, TV and playback devices. 2 Configure the settings of this unit. a Check that ARC is enabled on the TV. b Switch the TV input to display the video from this unit. c Press ON SCREEN. BD/DVD TV ON SCREEN CD VOLUME RETURN TOP DISPLAY A a Enable HDMI Control on the TV and playback devices (HDMI Control-compatible BD/ DVD player, etc). b Turn off the main power of the TV and then turn off this unit and playback devices. c Turn on this unit and playback devices and then turn on the main power of the TV. d Switch the TV input to display the video from this unit. e Check the followings. On this unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected. If not, select the input source manually. On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed. RADIO OPTION ENTER 3 Configure the settings for HDMI Control. ON SCREEN Cursor keys ENTER POP UP d Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. f Check that this unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning off the TV or adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control. Now the necessary settings are complete. If you select a TV program with the TV remote control, the input source of this unit will be automatically switched to “AUDIO1” and the TV audio will be played back on this unit. If TV audio cannot be heard, check that “ARC” (p.104) in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”. • If HDMI Control does not work properly, try turning off and on (or unplugging and re-plugging) the devices. It may solve the problem. • If any audio interruption happens while using ARC, set “ARC” (p.104) in the “Setup” menu to “Off” and use an audio cable (digital optical or stereo pin cable) to input TV audio to this unit (p.27). e Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select “HDMI”. • “AUDIO1” is set as TV audio input at the factory. If you have connected any external device to the AUDIO1 jacks, use “TV Audio Input” (p.103) in the “Setup” menu to change the TV audio input assignment. To use the SCENE function (p.49), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV). f Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select “HDMI Control” and press ENTER. g Use the cursor keys to select “On”. h Press ON SCREEN. En 26 1 2 TV connection 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ■ Connection method 2 (HDMI Control-compatible TV) Connect the TV to this unit with an HDMI cable and an audio cable (digital optical or stereo pin cable). • The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “HDMI” parameters (p.103) in the “Setup” menu. ❑ Necessary settings To use HDMI Control, you need to configure the following settings. For details on settings and operations of your TV, refer to the instruction manual of the TV. connecting external devices (TV, playback devices, etc.) and 1 After power cable of this unit, turn on this unit, TV and playback devices. • HDMI Control is available only on the HDMI OUT 1 jack. 2 Configure the settings of this unit. HDMI OUT 1 jack a Switch the TV input to display the video from this unit. HDMI OUT 1 b Press ON SCREEN. 2 ARC HDMI BD/DVD TV CD RADIO This unit (rear) HDMI input NETWORK DOCK HDMI OUT 1 AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 VOLUME (1 HDMI MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT OPTION ENTER AV 1 2 ARC (1 BD/DVD) ON SCREEN Y RETURN DISPLAY A ON SCREEN Cursor keys ENTER PB AV 1 A PHONO HDMI GND TOP POP UP AV 2 B AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 5 OPTICAL 6 COAXIAL (2 TV) L (3 CD) AUDIO 3 AUDIO AUDIO 1 (2 TV) R 1 COAXIAL 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL c Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. AUDIO 4 L FRONT L L R R R ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω TV 5 OPTICAL OPTICAL O O Audio output AUDIO1 (OPTICAL or AUDIO) (digital optical or analog stereo) jacks d Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select “HDMI”. • If you make an HDMI connection between your TV and this unit, any videos input to this unit can be output to the TV no matter how you connect video devices to this unit. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.130). • You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.30). e Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select “HDMI Control” and press ENTER. f Use the cursor keys to select “On”. g Press ON SCREEN. En 27 1 2 TV connection 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 3 Configure the settings for HDMI Control. a Enable HDMI Control on the TV and playback devices (HDMI Control-compatible BD/ DVD player, etc). ■ Connection method 3 (TV with HDMI input jacks) Connect the TV to this unit with an HDMI cable and an audio cable (digital optical or stereo pin cable). b Turn off the main power of the TV and then turn off this unit and playback devices. HDMI OUT 1 jack c Turn on this unit and playback devices and then turn on the main power of the TV. HDMI OUT 1 2 d Switch the TV input to display the video from this unit. e Check the followings. ARC HDMI This unit (rear) HDMI input On this unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected. If not, select the input source manually. NETWORK DOCK HDMI OUT 1 AV 1 2 (1 ARC AV 1 (1 BD/DVD) AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 HDMI MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT Y PB AV 1 On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed. A PHONO HDMI GND AV 2 B f Check that this unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning off the TV or adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control. Now the necessary settings are complete. If you select a TV program with the TV remote control, the input source of this unit will be automatically switched to “AUDIO1” and the TV audio will be played back on this unit. AUDIO 1 (2 TV) L AUDIO 2 (3 CD) AUDIO 3 AUDIO 4 AUDIO AUDIO 1 (2 TV) R 1 COAXIAL 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL 5 OPTICAL 6 COAXIAL L FRONT L L R R R ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω TV 5 OPTICAL OPTICAL O • If HDMI Control does not work properly, try turning off and on (or unplugging and re-plugging) the devices. It may solve the problem. • “AUDIO1” is set as TV audio input at the factory. If you have connected any external device to the AUDIO1 jacks, use “TV Audio Input” (p.103) in the “Setup” menu to change the TV audio input assignment. To use the SCENE function (p.49), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV). O Audio output AUDIO1 (OPTICAL or AUDIO) (digital optical or analog stereo) jacks If switch the input source of this unit to “AUDIO1” by pressing AUDIO1 or SCENE(TV), the TV audio will be played back on this unit. • If you make an HDMI connection between your TV and this unit, any videos input to this unit can be output to the TV no matter how you connect video devices to this unit. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.130). • You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.30). • If you have connected any external device to the AUDIO1 jacks, connect the TV to one of the AUDIO2~4 jacks. To use the SCENE function (p.49), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV). En 28 1 2 TV connection 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ■ Connection method 4 (TV without HDMI input jacks) S VIDEO connection (with an S-video cable) Depending on the video input jacks available on your TV, choose one of the following connections. If you select “AUDIO1” as the input source by pressing AUDIO1 or SCENE(TV), the TV audio will be played back on this unit. MONITOR OUT (S VIDEO) jack MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT This unit (rear) • If you connect your TV to this unit with a cable other than HDMI, videos input to this unit via HDMI cannot be output to the TV. Also, analog videos that can be output to the TV differ according to the “Analog to Analog Conversion” setting. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.130). S NETWORK DOCK AV 1 2 (1 ARC AV 1 (1 BD/DVD) AV 2 AV 3 Video input (S-video) HDMI OUT 1 AV 4 S VIDEO MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT Y PB AV 1 A PHONO S GND AV 2 B AUDIO 1 (2 TV) L • If you have connected any external device to the AUDIO1 jacks, connect the TV to one of the AUDIO2~4 jacks. To use the SCENE function (p.49), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV). AUDIO 2 (3 CD) AUDIO 3 AUDIO 4 AUDIO AUDIO 1 (2 TV) R 1 COAXIAL • To use the MONITOR OUT jacks for the TV in the main zone, set “Monitor Out Assign” (p.106) in the “Setup” menu to “Main” (default). 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL 5 OPTICAL L FRONT 6 COAXIAL L L R R R ANTENNA COMPONENT VIDEO connection (with a component video cable) (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω TV 5 OPTICAL MONITOR OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT PB PR Y This unit (rear) OPTICAL O Audio output AUDIO1 (OPTICAL or AUDIO) (digital optical or analog stereo) jacks PR PB HDMI HDMI OUT 1 AV 1 2 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5 Y (1 BD/DVD) ARC MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT OUT O Y PB COMPONENT VIDEO PR Y AV 3 PB C VIDEO (composite video) connection (with a video pin cable) PR AV 1 A Y MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT PB PR IN AV 2 B D AV 4 AUDIO 1 (2 TV) AUDIO 2 (3 CD) AUDIO 3 AUDIO 4 MULTI CH INPUT ZONE OUT CENTER PRE OUT Video input (component video) (SING This unit (rear) 5 OPTICAL FRONT 6 COAXIAL SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER ZONE 2 FRONT SURROUND SUR. BA PR SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R SURROUND BACK L Y PB NETWORK DOCK COMPONENT VIDEO HDMI OUT 1 2 AV 1 PR AV 1 (1 BD/DVD) AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT Y PB AV 1 PB A PHONO L R R AUDIO 2 5 OPTICAL 6 COAXIAL (3 CD) AUDIO 3 VIDEO V AUDIO 4 R L L AUDIO 1 (2 TV) L AUDIO SINGLE MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT B Y (2 TV) Video input (composite video) V GND AV 2 AUDIO 1 MONITOR OUT (VIDEO) jack (1 ARC 1 COAXIAL R 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL FRONT ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AM TV 5 OPTICAL FM 75Ω TV OPTICAL O AUDIO1 (OPTICAL or AUDIO) jacks O Audio output (digital optical or analog stereo) En 29 1 2 TV connection 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ■ Connecting another TV or a projector This unit has 2 HDMI output jacks. If you connect another TV or a projector to this unit with an HDMI cable, you can switch the TVs (or projector) to be used for watching videos with the remote control (p.48). HDMI OUT 2 jack HDMI OUT 1 2 ARC HDMI This unit (rear) NETWORK DOCK HDMI OUT 1 2 (1 BD/DVD) AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 (1 MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT HDMI input AV 1 ARC AV 1 Y PB HDMI AV 1 A PHONO GND AV 2 B AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 5 OPTICAL 6 COAXIAL (2 TV) L (3 CD) AUDIO 3 HDMI AUDIO 4 R 1 COAXIAL 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL FRONT Projector ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω TV (already connected) • HDMI Control is not available on the HDMI OUT 2 jack. En 30 1 2 3 Playback device connections 4 5 6 7 8 9 3 Connecting playback devices This unit is equipped with a variety of input jacks including HDMI input jacks to allow you to connect different types of playback devices. For information on how to connect an iPod, a Bluetooth component or a USB storage device, see the following pages. - Connecting an iPod (p.60) - Connecting a Bluetooth receiver (p.65) - Connecting a USB storage device (p.67) ■ HDMI connection Connect a video device to this unit with an HDMI cable. HDMI (AV1~7) jacks This unit (rear) HDMI 2 AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV 7 (1 BD/DVD) PB COMPONENT VIDEO PR Y AV 3 Connecting video devices (BD/DVD players, etc.) PB C TRIGG OUT PR Y MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT PB PR 1 REMOTE IN OUT 2 D AV 4 MULTI CH INPUT Connect video devices such as BD/DVD players, set-top boxes (STBs) and game consoles to this unit. Depending on the video/audio output jacks available on your video device, choose one of the following connections. We recommend using an HDMI connection if the video device has an HDMI output jack. +12V 0.1A ZONE OUT CENTER PRE OUT (SINGLE) SURROUND SUR. BACK HDMI output HDMI 1 HDMI 2 FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER ZONE 2 FRONT SUBWOOFER HDMI CENTER SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R SURROUND BACK L CENTER R FRONT L SINGLE Video device • Videos input to this unit via HDMI cannot be output to a TV connected to this unit with a cable other than HDMI. If you select the input source by pressing AV1~7, the video/audio played back on the video device will be output from this unit. • The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “Input Assignment” setting (p.108) in the “Setup” menu. As necessary, you can assign the COMPONENT VIDEO ( , , , ), COAXIAL (a, b, f) and OPTICAL (c, d, e) jacks to another input source. • If you make more than one audio connection for one input source, an audio signal played back on this unit will be determined according to the “Audio Select” setting (p.86) in the “Option” menu. En 31 1 2 3 Playback device connections 4 5 6 7 8 9 ■ Component video connection ■ S-video connection Connect a video device to this unit with a component video cable and an audio cable (digital coaxial, digital optical or stereo pin cable). Choose a set of input jacks (on this unit) depending on the audio output jacks available on your video device. Connect a video device to this unit with an S-video cable and an audio cable (digital coaxial, digital optical or stereo pin cable). Choose a set of input jacks (on this unit) depending on the audio output jacks available on your video device. Output jacks on video device Output jacks on video device Input jacks on this unit Video Input jacks on this unit Audio Component video Video Digital coaxial AV1~2 (COMPONENT VIDEO + COAXIAL) Digital optical AV3~4 (COMPONENT VIDEO + OPTICAL) Analog stereo AV1~4 (COMPONENT VIDEO + AUDIO) AV1~4 (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks Audio S-video NETWORK DOCK AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT PR AV1~4 (S VIDEO + AUDIO) Video output (S-video) PHONO This unit (rear) GND PB NETWORK DOCK Analog stereo AV1~4 (S VIDEO) jacks ARC PR AV3~4 (S VIDEO + OPTICAL) HD 1 AV 1 PB AV1~2 (S VIDEO + COAXIAL) Digital optical This unit (rear) (1 BD/DVD) Y Digital coaxial S Y HDMI OUT 1 2 AV 1 AV 2 AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 5 OPTICAL 6 COAXIAL (2 TV) L (3 CD) AU AV 3 (1 BD/DVD) ARC R AV 1 (1 BD/DVD) AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT Y PB COMPONENT VIDEO PR Y AV 3 PB C PR AV 1 1 COAXIAL A PHONO AV 2 B D AV 4 AUDIO 1 (2 TV) L AUDIO 2 (3 CD) AUDIO 3 AUDIO 4 MULTI CH INPUT ZONE O CENTER 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL S Video output (component video) GND S VIDEO ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω R 1 COAXIAL 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL 5 OPTICAL 6 COAXIAL FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK R SUBWOOFER SURROUND PR ZONE 2 L Y PB PR C C PB COAXIAL Y O Video device O ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω L C COAXIAL O Any of AV1~2 (COAXIAL), AV3~4 (OPTICAL), AV1~4 (AUDIO) jacks L R R R OPTICAL L R R L Video device O L L OPTICAL C R Audio output (any of digital coaxial, digital optical, analog stereo) Any of AV1~2 (COAXIAL), AV3~4 (OPTICAL), AV1~4 (AUDIO) jacks Audio output (any of digital coaxial, digital optical, analog stereo) If you select the input source by pressing AV1~4, the video/audio played back on the video device will be output from this unit. If you select the input source by pressing AV1~4, the video/audio played back on the video device will be output from this unit. En 32 1 2 3 Playback device connections 4 5 6 7 8 9 ■ Composite video connection Connecting audio devices (CD players, etc.) Connect a video device to this unit with a video pin cable and an audio cable (digital coaxial, digital optical or stereo pin cable). Choose a set of input jacks (on this unit) depending on the audio output jacks available on your video device. Connect audio devices such as CD players, MD players and a turntable to this unit. Depending on the audio output jacks available on your audio device, choose one of the following connections. Output jacks on video device Input jacks on this unit Video Audio Composite video AV 2 AV 3 Digital optical AV3~4 (VIDEO + OPTICAL) Analog stereo AV1~4 (VIDEO + AUDIO) AV1~4 (VIDEO) jacks NETWORK AV 1 (1 BD/DVD) AV1~2 (VIDEO + COAXIAL) • The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “Input Assignment” setting (p.108) in the “Setup” menu. As necessary, you can assign the COAXIAL (a, b, f) and OPTICAL (c, d, e) jacks to another input source. • If you make more than one audio connection for one input source, an audio signal played back on this unit will be determined according to the “Audio Select” setting (p.86) in the “Option” menu. This unit (rear) DOCK Digital coaxial AV 4 AV OUT Video output (composite video) V PHONO GND AUD (2 L R Audio output jacks on audio device Audio input jacks on this unit Digital coaxial AV1~2 (COAXIAL) AUDIO2 (COAXIAL) Digital optical AV3~4 (OPTICAL) AUDIO1 (OPTICAL) Analog stereo AV1~4 (AUDIO) AUDIO1~4 (AUDIO) Turntable (PHONO) PHONO VIDEO 1 COAXIAL 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL V 5 O ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω C C COAXIAL O Video device O L L L R R OPTICAL R Any of AV1~2 (COAXIAL), AV3~4 (OPTICAL), AV1~4 (AUDIO) jacks Audio output (any of digital coaxial, digital optical, analog stereo) If you select the input source by pressing AV1~4, the video/audio played back on the video device will be output from this unit. En 33 1 2 3 Playback device connections 4 5 6 7 8 9 Connecting to the jacks on the front panel Audio output (PHONO) PHONO jacks PHONO GND This unit (rear) Use the VIDEO AUX jacks on the front panel to temporarily connect devices such as a game console and a camcorder to this unit. Before making a connection, stop playback on the device and turn down the volume of this unit. GND PHONO L L NETWORK DOCK HDMI OUT L 1 AV 1 2 (1 BD/DVD) AV 2 R AV 3 AV 4 MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT AV 2 L AV 3 (1 BD/DVD) ARC AV 1 Y PB COMPONENT VIDEO PR Y AV 3 R PB C PR AV 1 R MULTI ZONE PROGRAM ZONE 2 RETURN B AUDIO 2 (3 CD) AUDIO 3 AUDIO 4 MULTI CH INPUT USB D AV 4 (2 TV) TUNING/CH VIDEO AUX PHONES AV 2 AUDIO 1 AM ZONE CONTROL DISPLAY GND L FM ENTER Turntable R A PHONO ZONE O CENTER iPod/iPhone YPAO MIC SILENT CINEMA S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R OPTICAL HDMI IN R 1 COAXIAL 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL 5 OPTICAL FRONT 6 COAXIAL SURROUND SUR. BACK R SUBWOOFER SURROUND ZONE 2 S L V L R O HDMI This unit (front) ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω C C COAXIAL O Audio device O OPTICAL L L R R Any of AV1~4, AUDIO1~4 (COAXIAL, OPTICAL, AUDIO) jacks Game console Audio output (any of digital coaxial, digital optical, analog stereo) If you select the input source by pressing AV1~4, AUDIO1~4 or PHONO, the audio played back on the audio device will be output from this unit. Camcorder If you select “V-AUX” as the input source by pressing V-AUX, the video/audio played back on the device will be output from this unit. • If you connect video devices to both the HDMI IN jack and analog video/audio jacks, this unit outputs video/ audio input through the HDMI IN jack. En 34 1 2 3 4 FM/AM antenna connections 5 6 7 8 9 4 Connecting the FM/AM antennas Connect the supplied FM/AM antennas to this unit. • Unwind the antenna cable from the AM antenna unit only the length needed. FM antenna • The wires of the AM antenna have no polarity. AM antenna NETWORK DOCK HDMI HDMI OUT 1 AV 1 2 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV 7 (1 BD/DVD) ARC AV 1 (1 BD/DVD) Y PB COMPONENT VIDEO PR Y AV 3 PB C PR AV 1 A PHONO Y GND MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT PB PR REMOTE IN OUT AV 2 B D AV 4 AUDIO 1 (2 TV) L AUDIO 2 (3 CD) AUDIO 3 AUDIO 4 MULTI CH INPUT ZONE OUT CENTER PRE OUT (SINGLE) SURROUND SUR. BACK 1 R 2 1 COAXIAL 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL 5 OPTICAL 6 COAXIAL FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER ZONE 2 FRONT SUBWOOFER CENTER SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R SURROUND BACK L CENTER R FR ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω SINGLE This unit (rear) Assembling and connecting the AM antenna Hold down Insert Release En 35 1 2 3 4 5 Network connections 6 7 8 9 5 Connecting to the network Connect this unit to your router with a commercially-available STP network cable (CAT-5 or higher straight cable). You can enjoy Internet radio or music files stored on PCs and DLNA servers such as Network Attached Storage (NAS) on this unit. • Some security software installed on your PC or the firewall settings of your network devices (such as a router) may block the access of this unit to the network devices or the Internet. In such cases, configure the security software or firewall settings appropriately. • You can connect this unit to up to 16 music servers (PC, etc.), and each server must be connected to the same subnet as this unit. Internet Network Attached Storage (NAS) • To use the service via the Internet, broadband connection is strongly recommended. WAN PC LAN Modem Router Network cable NETWORK DOCK HDMI OUT 1 2 AV 1 (1 ARC AV 1 (1 BD/DVD) AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT Y PB AV 1 A PHONO GND AV 2 B AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 5 OPTICAL 6 COAXIAL (2 TV) L (3 CD) AUDIO 3 AUDIO 4 R 1 COAXIAL 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL FRONT ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω This unit (rear) • When using a router that supports the DHCP function, the network parameters (IP address, etc.) will be automatically assigned to this unit without configuring the network settings of this unit. If your router does not support the DHCP function or you want to configure the network parameters manually, configure the network settings (p.105). • You can check whether the network parameters (IP address, etc.) are properly assigned to this unit in “Network” (p.111) in the “Information”. En 36 1 2 3 4 5 6 Other connections 7 8 9 Connecting a device with analog multi-channel output 6 Connecting other devices Connecting video/audio recording devices You can connect video/audio recording devices to the AV OUT jacks. These jacks output video/audio signals selected as the input. You can connect an analog multi-channel output device such as a DVD player and an SACD player to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks. This unit (rear) NETWORK DOCK HDMI OUT 1 2 AV 1 (1 BD/DVD) • The AV OUT jacks cannot output video/audio signals input through the HDMI or COMPONENT VIDEO jacks. AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT AV 2 AV (1 BD/DVD) ARC AV 1 Y PB COMPONENT VIDEO PR Y AV 3 PB C AV 1 A PHONO GND AV 2 B D AV 4 AV OUT jacks AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 V AV 4 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL AUDIO 4 MULTI CH INPUT FRONT SURROUND (2 TV) L (4 RADIO) AM SUR. BACK FM Channel output (Center) CENTER 75Ω (Subwoofer) AUDIO 5 OPTICAL Z L A L 4 OPTICAL SUBWOOFER SURROUND S R 3 OPTICAL CENTER S VIDEO S AUDIO 1 MULTI CH INPUT ANTENNA V MONITO ZONE AV OUT GND 2 COAXIAL 6 COAXIAL AUDIO 3 R PHONO 1 COAXIAL 5 OPTICAL (3 CD) VIDEO AV OUT NETWORK (1 BD/DVD) AUDIO 2 R Video/audio input 1 COAXIAL This unit (rear) DOCK AUDIO 1 (2 TV) L L L Video/audio recording device 6 R R R ANTENNA MULTI CH INPUT jacks FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER L (Surround back) R (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω L (Surround) Device with analog multi-channel output OPTICAL O O R L (Front) R If you select “MULTI CH” as the input source by pressing MULTI, the audio played back on the device will be output from this unit. • You can select a video source to be displayed when “MULTI CH” is selected as the input source using “Video Out” (p.89) in the “Input” menu. When connecting a video device (DVD player, etc.) to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks, use the input jack specified in “Video Out” for the video connection. • Since this unit does not redirect signals input to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks to accommodate for missing speakers, make appropriate settings on the external device (DVD player, etc.) that suit to the speaker configuration. • When “MULTI CH” is selected as the input source, sound mode selection and tone control adjustment are not available. En 37 1 2 3 4 5 6 Other connections 7 8 9 Connecting a device compatible with SCENE link playback (remote connection) Connecting a device compatible with the trigger function If you have a Yamaha product that has the capability of the SCENE control signal transmission, you can control the Yamaha product in conjunction with a scene selection (p.49) by connecting it to the REMOTE OUT jack with a monaural mini-jack cable. The trigger function can control an external device in conjunction with operations (power-on/off, input selection, etc.) on this unit. If you have a Yamaha subwoofer that supports a system connection or a device with a trigger input jack, you can use the trigger function by connecting the external device to one of the TRIGGER OUT jacks. REMOTE OUT jack TRIGGER OUT 1~2 jacks REMOTE This unit (rear) IN OUT This unit (rear) TRIGGER OUT HDMI 2 AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 RS-232C AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV 7 AV 5 AV 6 1 AV 7 (1 BD/DVD) Y PB COMPONENT VIDEO PR Y AV 3 PB C TR PR Y MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT PB PR TRIGGER OUT REMOTE IN T PR OUT 1 REMOTE IN 2 OUT 2 D AV 4 DIO 4 MULTI CH INPUT +12V ZONE OUT CENTER PRE OUT (SINGLE) SURROUND SUR. BACK +12V 0.1A MAX. 1 E OUT (SINGLE) RROUND SUR. BACK +12V 0.1A MAX. 1 2 2 Remote input FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER ZONE 2 FRONT SUBWOOFER CENTER SUBWOOFER CENTER SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R SURROUND BACK L CENTER R FRONT L L CENTER R FRONT L ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/ R BI–AMP EXTRA SP L AC IN System connection input REMOTE IN SINGLE Yamaha product (DVD player, etc.) GLE Yamaha subwoofer that supports a system connection • If you connect a Yamaha product compatible with SCENE link playback to the REMOTE OUT jack, you can start playback on the Yamaha product in conjunction with a scene selection (p.49). To enable the SCENE link playback, specify the device type in “Device Control” (p.90) in the “Scene” menu. • You also connect an infrared signal receiver/emitter to operate devices in the main zone from Zone2 (p.77). • You can configure the trigger function settings in “Trigger Output1” and “Trigger Output2” (p.109) in the “Setup” menu. En 38 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Power cable connection 8 9 7 Connecting the power cable After all the connections are complete, connect the supplied power cable to this unit and then to an AC wall outlet. This unit (rear) RS-232C AV 5 AV 6 AV 7 TRIGGER OUT T PR 1 REMOTE IN OUT 2 +12V 0.1A MAX. E OUT (SINGLE) RROUND SUR. BACK 1 2 L SUBWOOFER CENTER CENTER R FRONT L ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/ R BI–AMP EXTRA SP L AC IN To an AC wall outlet GLE En 39 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Language setting 9 ZONE 2 MAIN 8 Selecting an on-screen menu language CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING Select a desired on-screen menu language from English (default), Japanese, French, German, Spanish and Russian. AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY 1 Press RECEIVER to turn on this unit. on the TV and switch the TV input to display 2 Turn the video from this unit. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN ON SCREEN OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN POP-UP MENU Cursor keys ENTER DISPLAY A TOP MENU 3 Press ON SCREEN. the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press 4 Use ENTER. MUTE MODE 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 4 8 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH HDMI OUT the cursor keys ( / ) to select “Language” and 5 Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select a desired language. 6 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. • The information on the front display is provided in English only. En 40 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Automatic speaker setup MAIN ZONE 2 9 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN jack on the front panel. This unit (front) VOLUME RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 4 8 ENT TV INPUT TV CH • During the measuring process, the test tones are output at high volume. Take care that the test tone does not frighten small children. Also, refrain from using this function at night when it may be a nuisance to others. • During the measuring process, you cannot adjust the volume. • Do not connect headphones. • If your subwoofer supports the auto-standby function, disable it. MUTE MODE 1 • Use YPAO after connecting a TV and speakers to this unit. • During the measuring process, keep the room as quiet as possible. OPTION ENTER MUTE the YPAO microphone at ear height in your 5 Place listening position and connect it to the YPAO MIC Please note the following when using YPAO. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT TV VOL By using the Yamaha Parametric room Acoustic Optimizer (YPAO) function, this unit automatically detects speaker connections and distances from the listening position, and optimizes the speaker settings such as volume balance and acoustic parameters to suit your room. HDMI OUT 1 Press RECEIVER to turn on this unit. on the TV and switch the TV input to display 2 Turn the video from this unit. YPAO microphone Listening position on the subwoofer and set the volume to half. 3 Turned If the cross-over frequency is adjustable, set it to maximum. VOLUME MIN MAX Ear height CROSSOVER/ HIGH CUT MIN MAX Place the YPAO microphone at ear height in your listening position. We recommend using a tripod to adjust the height. You can use the tripod screws to fix the microphone in place. to your speaker configuration, configure 4 According the “Power Amp Assign” setting (p.98) in the “Setup” menu. For the basic speaker configuration (p.15): set to “Basic” (default). For any of the advanced speaker configurations (p.19): set to the appropriate setting. En 41 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Automatic speaker setup The following screen appears on the TV. ZONE 2 MAIN CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER • If you perform the single measure, you will be able to enjoy surround sound at that position with optimized speaker settings. If you perform the multi measure, the speaker settings will be optimized for you to enjoy surround sound in a wider space. AV 3 4 7 V-AUX 1 2 5 6 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY Single measure Multi measure (5 listening positions) SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT • To cancel the operation, disconnect the YPAO microphone before starting the measurement. SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN 6 OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN ENTER DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU Cursor keys MUTE 1 If desired, change the measuring method (multi/ single). b Use the cursor keys to select a setting and then press ENTER. Multi measure 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 5 213 a Use the cursor keys to select “Multi Position” and press ENTER. MODE 1 4 Multi measure (1 listening position + 4 circumferences) (2 listening positions + front/back) 2 3 1 5 4 3 1 2 4 4 8 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL TV CH HDMI OUT MUTE Settings Yes No (default) Select this if your listening position is variable or you will enjoy surround sound with your company. You can perform the measurement at up to 8 positions to optimize the speaker settings to suit all of those positions (multi measure). Select this if your listening position is fixed in one position. You will perform the measurement only once to optimize the speaker settings suit to the position (single measure). Now all preparations are complete. See the following page to start the measurement. When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes”: “Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure)” (p.44) When “Multi Position” is set to “No”: “Measuring at one listening position (single measure)” (p.43) En 42 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Automatic speaker setup ZONE 2 MAIN Measuring at one listening position (single measure) CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX When “Multi Position” is set to “No”, follow the procedure below to make the measurement. AUDIO 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB • YPAO measurement is not performed correctly when any obstacles are in the room. PRESET TUNING • During the measuring process (about 3 minutes), keep stuff in the corners or remove it from the room. TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY the cursor keys to select “Save/Cancel” and 2 Use press ENTER. save the measurement results, use the cursor 3 To keys to select “SAVE” and press ENTER. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY start the measurement, use the cursor keys to 1 To select “Measure” and press ENTER. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 BD/DVD TV ON SCREEN 3 4 CD RADIO OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN POP-UP MENU The corrected speaker settings are applied. • To cancel the measurement, press RETURN. • To finish the measurement without saving the result, select “CANCEL”. MUTE MODE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 The measurement will start in 10 seconds. Press ENTER again to start the measurement immediately. ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A TOP MENU Cursor keys The following screen appears on the TV when the measurement finishes. Now optimization of the speaker settings is complete. ENT TV Caution INPUT TV VOL 4 Disconnect the YPAO microphone from this unit. TV CH HDMI OUT • Since the YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat, do not place the microphone in any place where it will be subjected to direct sunlight or high temperatures (top of an AV equipment, etc). MUTE • If any error message (such as E-1) or warning message (such as W-1) appears, see “Error messages” (p.46) or “Warning messages” (p.47). • To check the measurement results, select “Result”. For details, see “Checking the measurement results” (p.45). En 43 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Automatic speaker setup ZONE 2 MAIN Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure) CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes”, follow the procedure below to make the measurement. AUDIO TUNER FM the measurement at all listening position are 3 Ifmade, use the cursor keys to select “CANCEL” and press ENTER. If you have made the measurement at 8 listening positions, the following screen appears automatically. • YPAO measurement is not performed correctly when any obstacles are in the room. AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY • During the measuring process, keep stuff in the corners or remove it from the room. It takes about 10 minutes to make the measurement at 8 listening positions. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT • If any error message (such as E-1) or warning message (such as W-1) appears, see “Error messages” (p.46) or “Warning messages” (p.47). ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN POP-UP MENU TOP MENU Cursor keys ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A MUTE start the measurement, use the cursor keys to 1 To select “Measure” and press ENTER. The measurement will start in 10 seconds. Press ENTER again to start the measurement immediately. • To check the measurement results, select “Result”. For details, see “Checking the measurement results” (p.45). MODE 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 4 8 ENT • To cancel the measurement, press RETURN. The following screen appears on the TV when the measurement at the first position finishes. TV INPUT TV VOL TV CH HDMI OUT the cursor keys to select “Save/Cancel” and 4 Use press ENTER. save the measurement result, use the cursor 5 To keys to select “SAVE” and press ENTER. MUTE the YPAO microphone to the next listening 2 Move position and press ENTER. Repeat step 2 until the measurement at all listening positions (up to 8) are made. The corrected speaker settings are applied. • To finish the measurement without saving the result, select “CANCEL”. 6 Disconnect the YPAO microphone from this unit. En 44 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Automatic speaker setup Now optimization of the speaker settings is complete. ZONE 2 MAIN Size Size of each speaker (cross-over frequency of the subwoofer) Large: The speaker can reproduce low-frequency signals effectively. Small: The speaker cannot reproduce low-frequency signals effectively. Distance Distance from the listening position to each speaker Level Output level adjustment for each speaker CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER Caution AV 3 4 7 V-AUX 1 2 5 6 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING • Since the YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat, do not place the microphone in any place where it will be subjected to direct sunlight or high temperatures (top of an AV equipment, etc). AUDIO TUNER FM INFO Checking the measurement results AM You can check the YPAO measurement results. MEMORY SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 BD/DVD TV ON SCREEN 3 4 CD RADIO ON SCREEN the measurement, use the cursor keys to 1 After select “Result” and press ENTER. OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU Cursor keys • You can also select “Result” from “Auto Setup” (p.96) in the “Setup” menu. In this case, the previous measurement results are displayed. The following screen appears. • A speaker with any problem is indicated with a red-boxed message. finish checking the results and return to the 3 To previous screen, press RETURN. Reloading the previous YPAO results MUTE MODE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 1 2 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL TV CH HDMI OUT 3 MUTE 1 Measurement result items When the speaker settings you have configured manually are not suitable, follow the procedure below to discard the manual settings and reload the previous YPAO results. the “Setup” menu, select “Speaker”, “Auto 1 InSetup” and then “Result” (p.95). the cursor keys to select “Setup Reload” and 2 Use press ENTER. 2 Measurement result details 3 The number of measured positions (when multi measure is performed) 2 Use the cursor keys to select an item Wiring Polarity of each speaker Normal: The speaker cable is connected with the correct polarity (+/-). Reverse: The speaker cable may be connected with the reversed polarity (+/-). 3 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. En 45 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Automatic speaker setup Error messages If any error message is displayed during the measurement, resolve the problem and perform YPAO again. Error message Cause Remedy E-1: No Front SP Front speakers are not detected. E-2: No Sur. SP Either of surround speakers is not detected. E-3: No F.PRNS SP Either of front presence speakers is not detected. E-4: SBRSBL A surround back speaker is connected to the R side only. When using only one surround back speaker, you need to connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side). Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off this unit, and then reconnect the speaker. E-5: Noisy The noise is too loud. Keep the room quiet and follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. If you select “PROCEED”, the measurement starts again on the condition this unit ignores the noisy error even if noises are detected. E-6: Check Sur. Any surround back speaker is connected while no surround speakers are connected. Surround speakers should be connected when using surround back speakers. Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off this unit, and then reconnect the speakers. E-7: No MIC The YPAO microphone has been removed. Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack firmly and follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. E-8: No Signal The YPAO microphone cannot detect test tones. Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack firmly and follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. If this error occurs repeatedly, contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center. E-9: User Cancel The measurement has been canceled. Follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. To cancel the measurement, select “EXIT”. E-10: Internal Error An internal error has occurred. Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off and on this unit. If this error occurs repeatedly, contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center. Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off this unit, and then check the speaker connections. En 46 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Automatic speaker setup Warning messages Even if any warning message is displayed after the measurement, you can save the measurement results by following on-screen instructions. However, we recommend you perform YPAO again to use this unit with the optimal speaker settings. Warning message Cause Remedy W-1: Out of Phase Any of the speaker cables may be connected with the reversed polarity (+/-). Select “Wiring” in “Result” (p.45) and check the cable connections (+/-) of the speaker indicated with “Reverse”. If the speaker is connected incorrectly, turn off this unit and then reconnect the speaker cable. Depending on the type of speakers or room environment, this message may appear even if the speakers are connected correctly. W-2: Over Distance Any of the speakers is placed more than 24 m from the listening position. Select “Distance” in “Result” (p.45) and move the speaker indicated with “>24.0m (>80.0ft)” within 24 m of the listening position. W-3: Level Error There are a significant volume differences between the speakers. Check the use environment and cable connections (+/-) of each speaker, and the volume of the subwoofer. We recommend using the same speakers or speakers with as similar specifications as possible. En 47 ZONE 2 MAIN PLAYBACK CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO Basic playback procedure Input selection keys on external devices (TV, BD/DVD player, etc.) 1 Turn connected to this unit. the input selection keys to select an input 2 Use source. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE ON SCREEN ON SCREEN OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN VOLUME DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE MUTE Cursor keys ENTER MODE 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 4 8 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH playback on the external device, or select a 3 Start radio station. Refer to the instruction manual of the external device. For details on the following operations, see the corresponding pages. - Listening to FM/AM radio (p.56) - Playing back iPod music/videos (p.60) - Playing back music via Bluetooth (p.65) - Playing back music stored on a USB storage device (p.67) - Playing back music stored on PCs (p.70) - Listening to Internet radio (p.73) HDMI OUT HDMI OUT 4 Press VOLUME to adjust the volume. Selecting an HDMI output jack 1 Press HDMI OUT to select an HDMI OUT jack. Each time you press the key, the HDMI OUT jack to be used for signal output switches. DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 HDMIOUTSel. OUT1+2 HDMI OUT 1+2 HDMI OUT 1 MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Outputs the same signal at both the HDMI OUT 1 and HDMI OUT 2 jacks. HDMI OUT 2 Outputs the signals at the selected HDMI OUT jack. HDMI OUT Off Does not output the signals at the HDMI OUT jacks. • You can also select an HDMI output jack by selecting a scene (p.49). • When “HDMI OUT 1+2” is selected, this unit outputs video signals at the highest resolution that both TVs connected to this unit support. (For example, if you have connected a 1080p TV to the HDMI OUT 1 jack, and a 720p TV to the HDMI OUT 2 jack, this unit outputs 720p video signals.) • To mute the audio output, press MUTE. Press MUTE again to unmute. • To adjust treble/bass parts of sound, use the “Option” menu or TONE/ BALANCE on the front panel (p.85). On-screen input selection a Press ON SCREEN. b Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER. c Use the cursor keys to select a desired input source and press ENTER. En 48 MAIN ZONE 2 Selecting the input source and favorite settings at once (SCENE) CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING The SCENE function allows you to select the assigned input source, sound program, HDMI output and various settings at once. You can use up to 12 scenes to register your favorite settings and switch them depending on a playback source. AUDIO TUNER FM 1 Press SCENE. The input source and settings registered to the corresponding scene are selected. This unit turns on automatically when it is in standby mode. AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT By default, the following settings are registered for each scene. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN SCENE VOLUME RETURN POP-UP MENU Cursor keys ENTER DISPLAY A TOP MENU 1 (BD/DVD) 2 (TV) 3 (CD) 4 (RADIO) Input (p.48) AV1 AUDIO1 AUDIO2 TUNER Audio Select (p.86) Auto Auto Auto — HDMI Output (p.48) OUT 1+2 OUT 1+2 OUT 1+2 OUT 1+2 Sound Program (p.51) Drama STRAIGHT STRAIGHT 7ch Stereo Pure Direct Mode (p.102) Auto Auto Auto Auto Tone Control (p.85): SP (speakers), HP (headphones) Treble/Bass: 0.0dB Treble/Bass: 0.0dB Treble/Bass: 0.0dB Treble/Bass: 0.0dB Adaptive DRC (p.85) Off On Off Off Enhancer (p.55) Off On Off On Input OPTION ENTER SCENE (SCENE key) MUTE HDMI Output ON SCREEN Mode MODE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 Sound ENT TV INPUT TV VOL TV CH HDMI OUT MUTE • You can select SCENE1~4 by pressing SCENE on the remote control. Additionally, you can create 8 scenes (SCENE5~12) and select those scenes from the “Scene” menu (p.89). • You can also include other setting items (surround settings, video settings, etc.) as the scene assignments (p.91). On-screen scene selection a Press ON SCREEN. b Use the cursor keys to select “Scene” and press ENTER. c Use the cursor keys to select a desired scene and press ENTER. En 49 ZONE 2 MAIN Configuring scene assignments CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER SOURCE/RECEIVER Follow the procedure below to register the current status (input source, sound program, etc.) to a scene. As necessary, you can select items to be included as the scene assignments (p.91). AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 7 V-AUX 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY this unit to the condition (input source, sound 1 Set program, etc.) that you want to assign to a scene. down the desired SCENE key until “SET 2 Hold Complete” appears on the front display. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 3 4 SCENE DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 BD/DVD TV CD ON SCREEN SCENE1 SETComplete MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR RADIO OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE MODE 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 4 you want to control the corresponding playback 3 Ifdevice after selecting the scene, hold down the corresponding SCENE key and input selection key together for more than 3 seconds. Once the setting is completed successfully, SOURCE/ RECEIVER blinks twice. 8 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH HDMI OUT • If you have not registered the remote control code of the playback device yet, see “Setting the remote control codes for playback devices” (p.116) to register it. • You can start playback of external devices connected to this unit via HDMI or a Yamaha product connected to the REMOTE OUT jack, in conjunction with a scene selection (SCENE link playback). To enable the SCENE link playback, specify the device type in “Device Control” (p.90) in the “Scene” menu. En 50 ZONE 2 MAIN Selecting the sound mode CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX This unit is equipped with a variety of sound programs and surround decoders that allow you to enjoy playback sources with a favorite sound mode (sound field effect, stereo playback, etc). AUDIO 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY Selecting a sound program suitable for movies (p.52) Press MOVIE repeatedly. PRESET TUNING SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN MOVIE MUSIC SUR.DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU Press MUSIC repeatedly. ENTER. c Use the cursor keys to select a sound program/surround • You can change the settings of the surround programs and surround decoders in the “Sound Program” menu (p.92). • The sound mode can be applied separately to each input source. Press SUR.DECODE repeatedly. • When you play back audio signals with sampling frequency of higher than 96 kHz or DTS Express sources, the straight decode mode (p.54) is automatically selected. Switching to the straight decode mode (p.54) • You can check which speakers are currently outputting sound with the speaker indicators on the front panel (p.10) or the “Audio Signal” screen in the “Information” menu (p.110). Cursor keys ENTER b Use the cursor keys to select “Sound Program” and press decoder and press ENTER. Selecting a surround decoder (p.54) VOLUME ENTER a Press ON SCREEN. Selecting a sound program suitable for music or stereo playback (p.53) ON SCREEN OPTION On-screen sound program/surround decoder selection MUTE MODE Press STRAIGHT. 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 4 8 ENT TV Switching to the Pure Direct mode (p.55) Press PURE DIRECT. INPUT TV VOL TV CH HDMI OUT MUTE Enable Compressed Music Enhancer (p.55) Press ENHANCER. En 51 Enjoying sound field effects (CINEMA DSP) This unit is equipped with a variety of sound programs that utilize Yamaha's original DSP technology (CINEMA DSP). It allows you to easily create sound fields like actual movie theaters or concert halls in your room. Drama This program features stable reverberations that match a wide range of movie genres from serious dramas to musicals and comedies. The reverberations are modest but offer an optimum 3D feeling, reproducing effects tones and background music softly but cubically around clear words and center positioning in a way that does not fatigue the listener even after long hours of viewing. Mono Movie This program is provided for reproducing monaural video sources such as a classic movie in an atmosphere of a good old movie theater. The program produces the optimum expansion and reverberation to the original audio to create a comfortable space with a certain sound depth. Sound program category MOVIE DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 MOVIETHEATER Sci-Fi “CINEMA DSP” lights up MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC ❑ ENTERTAINMENT PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Sound program Sports This program allows the listeners to enjoy stereo sport broadcasts and studio variety programs with enriched live feeling. In sports broadcasts, the voices of the commentator and sportscaster are positioned clearly at the center while the atmosphere of the stadium expands in an optimal space to offer the listeners a feeling of presence in the stadium. Action Game This program is suitable for action games such as car racing, fighting games and FPS games. The reality of, and emphasis on, various effects makes the player feel like they are right in the middle of the action, allowing for greater concentration. Use this program in combination with Compressed Music Enhancer for a more dynamic and strong sound field. Roleplaying Game This program is suitable for role-playing and adventure games. This program adds depth to the sound field for natural and realistic reproduction of background music, special effects and dialog from a wide variety of scenes. Use this program in combination with Compressed Music Enhancer for a more clear and spatial sound field. Music Video This program offers an image of a concert hall for live performance of pop, rock and jazz music. The listener can indulge oneself in a hot live space thanks to the presence sound field that emphasizes the vividness of vocals and solo play and the beat of rhythm instruments, and to the surround sound field that reproduces the space of a big live hall. • When you play back DTS-HD sources, the DTS decoder is automatically selected. ■ Sound programs suitable for movies (MOVIE) The following sound programs are optimized for viewing video sources such as movies, TV programs and games. ❑ MOVIE THEATER Standard This program creates a sound field emphasizing the surround feeling without disturbing the original acoustic positioning of multi-channel audio such as Dolby Digital and DTS. It has been designed with the concept of an ideal movie theater, in which the audience is surrounded by beautiful reverberations from the left, right and rear. Spectacle This program represents the spectacular feeling of large-scale movie productions. It reproduces a broad theater sound field that matches cinemascope and wider-screen movies with an excellent dynamic range providing everything from very small sound effects to large, impressive sounds. Sci-Fi This program clearly reproduces the finely elaborated sound design of the latest science fiction and special effects-featuring movies. You can enjoy a variety of cinematographically created virtual spaces reproduced with clear separation between dialog, sound effects and background music. Adventure This program is ideal for precisely reproducing the sound design of action and adventure movies. The sound field restrains reverberations but puts emphasis on reproducing a powerful space expanded widely to the left and right. The reproduced depth is also restrained relatively to ensure the separation between audio channels and the clarity of the sound. En 52 ■ Sound programs suitable for music/stereo playback (MUSIC) The following sound programs are optimized for listening to music sources. You can also select stereo playback. ❑ CLASSICAL Hall in Munich This program simulates a concert hall with approximately 2500 seats in Munich, using stylish wood for the interior finishing as normal standards for European concert halls. Fine, beautiful reverberations spread richly, creating a calming atmosphere. The listener's virtual seat is at the center left of the arena. Hall in Vienna This program simulates an approximately 1700-seat, middle-sized concert hall with a shoebox shape that is traditional in Vienna. Pillars and ornate carvings create extremely complex reflections from all around the audience, producing a very full, rich sound. Chamber This program creates a relatively wide space with a high ceiling like an audience hall in a palace. It offers pleasant reverberations that are suitable for courtly music and chamber music. ❑ LIVE/CLUB Cellar Club This program simulates a live house with a low ceiling and homey atmosphere. A realistic, live sound field features powerful sound as if the listener is in a row in front of a small stage. The Roxy Theatre This program creates the sound field of a rock music live house in Los Angeles, with approximately 460 seats. The listener's virtual seat is at the center left of the hall. The Bottom Line This program creates the sound field at stage front in The Bottom Line, a famous New York jazz club once. The floor can seat 300 people to the left and right in a sound field offering real and vibrant sound. ❑ STEREO 2ch Stereo Use this program to mix down multi-channel sources to 2 channels. When multi-channel signals are input, they are down mixed to 2 channels and output from the front speakers (this program does not utilizes CINEMA DSP). 7ch Stereo Use this program to output sound from all speakers. When you playback multi-channel sources, this unit down-mixes the source to 2 channels, and then outputs the sound from all speakers. This program creates a larger sound field and is ideal for background music at parties, etc. En 53 ZONE 2 MAIN ■ Enjoying stereoscopic sound fields (CINEMA DSP 3D) CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER You can play back input sources without any sound field effect processing. AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 7 V-AUX 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SUR.DECODE STRAIGHT CINEMA DSP 3D enables to create a natural stereoscopic sound field in your room. CINEMA DSP 3D functions when both of the following conditions are met. - One of the sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo) is selected (p.52). - “CINEMA DSP 3D Mode” (p.85) in the “Option” menu is set to “On” (default). MUSIC SCENE DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP 3 ON SCREEN CLASSICAL HallinVienna MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN “CINEMA DSP 3” lights up DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE MODE 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 4 TV INPUT TV VOL TV CH • We recommend using front presence speakers to have a full effect of the stereoscopic sound fields. However, this unit creates Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center and surround speakers to produce stereoscopic sound fields even when no front presence speakers are connected. 8 ENT HDMI OUT Enjoying unprocessed playback ■ Enjoying sound field effects without surround speakers (Virtual CINEMA DSP) MUTE If you select one of the sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo) when no surround speakers are connected, this unit automatically creates the surround sound field using the front-side speakers. ■ Enjoying unprocessed sounds in original channels (straight decode) When the straight decode mode is enabled, each speaker produces each channel audio signal directly (without sound field processing). When you play back 2-channel sources such as CD, stereo sound is heard from the front speakers. When you play back multi-channel sources, this unit produces unprocessed multichannel sounds. 1 Press STRAIGHT. Each time you press the key, the straight decode mode is enabled or disabled. DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP STRAIGHT MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR HD 3 ■ Enjoying unprocessed multi-channel sounds (surround decoder) The surround decoder enables unprocessed multi-channel playback from 2-channel sources. When a multi-channel source is input, it works the same way as the straight decode mode. For details on each decoder see “Glossary” (p.127). 1 Press SUR.DECODE to select a surround decoder. Each time you press the key, the surround decoder switches. DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 Pro Logic PLIIx Movie PLII Movie SUR.DECODE ProLogic MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Uses the Dolby Pro Logic decoder suitable for any sources. Uses the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro Logic II decoder) suitable for movies. En 54 MAIN ZONE 2 PLIIx Music CODE SET PLII Music SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING PLIIx Game PLII Game AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MUSIC SLEEP PARTY ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE MODE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH HDMI OUT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT Enjoying compressed music with enhanced sound (Compressed Music Enhancer) Uses the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro Logic II decoder) suitable for games. Neo: 6 Cinema Uses the DTS Neo: 6 decoder suitable for movies. Neo: 6 Music Uses the DTS Neo: 6 decoder suitable for music. • You cannot select the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoders when headphones are connected or when “Surround Back” in the “Setup” menu is set to “None”. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE Uses the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro Logic II decoder) suitable for music. • To enable 6.1/7.1-channel playback from 5.1-channel sources when surround back speakers are used, set “Extended Surround” (p.86) in the “Option” menu to “ PLIIx Movie”, “ PLIIx Music” or “EX/ES”. Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (Pure Direct) When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, this unit plays back the selected source with the least circuitry to reduce the electrical noise from other circuitry (front display, etc). It allows you to enjoy Hi-Fi sound quality. Compressed Music Enhancer improves the sound enhancer near to the original depth and width of compressed music sources. This function can be used along with any other sound modes. 1 Press ENHANCER. Each time you press the key, Compressed Music Enhancer is enabled or disabled. DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP EnhancerOn HD 3 MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR “ENHANCER” lights up • Compressed Music Enhancer does not work on the following audio sources. - Signals of which sampling rate is over 48kHz - High-definition streaming audio 1 Press PURE DIRECT. Each time you press the key, the Pure Direct mode is enabled or disabled. DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP PUREDIRECT HD 3 • You can also use “Enhancer” (p.86) in the “Option” menu to enable/disable Compressed Music Enhancer. MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Enjoying surround sound with headphones (SILENT CINEMA) • When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, the following functions are not available. - Selecting sound programs - Adjusting the tone control - Operating the on-screen menu - Viewing information on the front display (when not operated) You can enjoy surround or sound field effects like a multi-channel speaker system with stereo headphones by connecting the headphones to the PHONES jack and selecting a sound program or a surround decoder. En 55 ZONE 2 MAIN Listening to FM/AM radio CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING You can tune into a radio station by specifying its frequency or selecting from registered radio stations. AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY 1 2 BD/DVD TV SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT TUNER FM AM MEMORY TUNING • If you cannot have a good reception on the radio, adjust the direction of the FM/ AM antennas. ON SCREEN 3 4 CD RADIO OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN Registering favorite radio stations (preset) Selecting a frequency for reception You can register up to 40 radio stations as presets. Once you registered stations, you can easily tune into those stations by selecting the preset number. TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input 1 Press source. • You can automatically register FM radio stations with strong signals using “Auto Preset” (p.59). ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE MODE MODE 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 8 ENT TV TV VOL TV CH HDMI OUT 2 Press FM or AM to select a band. DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP FM87.50MHz MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR HD 3 4 INPUT MUTE • The radio frequencies differ depending on the country or region where the unit is being used. The explanation of this section uses a display with frequencies used in Europe model. • You can switch between “Stereo” (stereo) and “Mono” (monaural) for FM radio reception by pressing MODE. When signal reception for FM radio station is unstable, switching to “Mono” may improve it. Numeric keys ENT 3 Use the following keys to set a frequency. TUNING: Increase/decrease the frequency. Hold down the key for about a second to search the station automatically. Numeric keys: Enter a frequency directly. For example, to select 98.50 MHz, press “9”, “8”, “5” and “0” (or ENT). DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP HD 3 FM98.50MHz MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC ■ Registering a radio station Select a radio station manually and register it to a preset number. “Selecting a frequency for reception” (p.56) 1 Follow to tune into a desired radio station. 2 Hold down MEMORY for more than 2 seconds. The radio station will be registered to the preset number “01” for the first time. After that, it will be registered to an empty preset number (next to the lastly-registered preset number). Preset number PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR “TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station. “STEREO” also lights up when a stereo signal is received. Preset DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP HD 3 01:FM98.50MHz PresetOK MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR • “Wrong Station!” appears when you enter a frequency that is out of receivable range En 56 MAIN ZONE 2 Radio Data System tuning CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER • To select a preset number to which the station will be registered, press MEMORY once after tuning into a desired radio station, use PRESET or numeric keys to select a preset number, and then press MEMORY again. AV 3 4 7 V-AUX 1 2 5 6 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB “Empty” (not in use) or frequency currently registered AUDIO TUNER Preset TUNER DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP HD 3 FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET TUNING SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT INFO MEMORY PRESET ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 02:Empty FM98.50MHz MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR ■ Displaying the Radio Data System information ■ Selecting a preset station Tune into a registered radio station by selecting the preset number. SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input 1 Press source. OPTION (Europe model only) Radio Data System is a data transmission system used by FM stations in many countries. This unit can receive various Radio Data System data such as “Program Service”, “Program Type,” “Radio Text” and “Clock Time” when tuning into a Radio Data System broadcasting station. into a desired Radio Data System broadcasting 1 Tune station. VOLUME ENTER RETURN PRESET repeatedly to select a desired radio 2 Press station. DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE • We recommend using “Auto Preset” to tune into the Radio Data System broadcasting stations (p.59). MODE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 0 ENT You can also enter a preset number (01 to 40) directly by using the numeric keys after pressing PRESET once. Numeric keys Preset DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP HD 3 TV 01:FM98.50MHz 2 Press INFO. Each time you press the key, the item switches. MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR INPUT DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP HD 3 TV VOL TV CH Info ProgramType MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR HDMI OUT MUTE Item name • “No Presets” appears when no radio stations are registered. About 3 seconds later, the information is displayed. • “Wrong Num.” appears when an invalid number is entered. Frequency (always displayed) • “Empty” appears when a preset number not in use is entered. DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP HD 3 • To clear preset stations, use “Clear Preset” or “Clear All Preset” (p.59). FM98.50MHz CLASSICS MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Information Program Service Program service name Program Type Type of the current program Radio Text Information on the current program Clock Time Current time DSP Program Sound mode name Audio Decoder Decoder name En 57 MAIN ZONE 2 Operating the radio on the TV CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER • “Program Service”, “Program Type”, “Radio Text” and “Clock Time” do not appear when the radio station does not provide the Radio Data System service. AV 3 4 7 V-AUX 1 2 5 6 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY TUNER When “TUNER” is selected as the input source, this unit automatically receives traffic information. To enable this function, follow the procedure below to set the traffic information station. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO “TUNER” is selected as the input source, 1 When press OPTION. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE ON SCREEN OPTION OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE MODE 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 Cursor keys ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A ■ Receiving traffic information automatically 8 The traffic information station search will start in 5 seconds. Press ENTER again to start the search immediately. • To search upward/downward from the current frequency, press the cursor keys ( / ) while “Ready” is displayed. INPUT TV VOL TV CH HDMI OUT The playback screen is displayed on the TV. ■ Playback screen 1 3 2 4 1 Radio station information Displays the information of the selected radio station such as the selected band (FM/AM) and frequency. • To cancel the search, press RETURN. TV TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input 1 Press source. the cursor keys to select “Traffic Program” 2 Use (TrafficProgram) and press ENTER. 4 ENT You can view the radio information or select a radio station on the TV. • Texts in parentheses denote indications on the front display. (Europe model only) When tuning into a Radio Data System broadcasting station (p.57), the Radio Data System information (“Program Service”, “Program Type,” “Radio Text” and “Clock Time”) is also displayed. MUTE The following screen appears for about 3 seconds when the search finishes. Finished DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP HD 3 TrafficProgram TPFM101.30MHz MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Traffic information station (frequency) • “TP Not Found” appears for about 3 seconds when no traffic information stations are found. 2 Band icon (Except for Europe model) Select this icon and press ENTER to switch between FM and AM. 3 TUNED/STEREO indicators “TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station. “STEREO” lights up when a stereo signal is received. 4 Operation menu Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. En 58 ZONE 2 MAIN Menu CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER Submenu Function FM AM (Europe model only) Switches to FM/AM. Tuning (+/-) Selects a frequency. Auto (+/-) Selects a radio station automatically. Memory Registers the selected station as presets. Direct Enters a frequency directly. AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK AUDIO TUNER FM NET USB PRESET TUNING Manual Tuning AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT Browse Moves to the browse screen (preset station list). Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN VOLUME RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU 1 3 2 1 Preset station list Displays the list of preset stations. Use the cursor keys to select a preset station and press ENTER to tune into it. 2 Preset number 3 Operation menu OPTION ENTER ■ Browse screen MUTE Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. Menu Submenu Function Memory Registers the current station to the preset number selected in the list. Auto Preset Automatically registers FM radio stations with strong signals (up to 40 stations). Clear Preset Clear the preset station selected in the list. Clear All Preset Clear all the preset stations. MODE 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 4 8 ENT Utility TV INPUT TV VOL TV CH HDMI OUT MUTE 1 Page Up 1 Page Down Moves to the previous/next page of the list. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. En 59 Playing back iPod music/videos You can play back iPod music/videos on this unit using a USB cable supplied with iPod, an optional Yamaha iPod dock (such as YDS-12) or an optional Yamaha iPod wireless system (YID-W10). Connecting an iPod ■ Using a USB cable • This manual describes both the “iPod” and “iPhone” as the “iPod”. “iPod” means both “iPod” and “iPhone” unless the explanation describes exceptions. • Some features may not be compatible depending on the model or software version of an iPod, or the model of an iPod dock. Connect your iPod to this unit with the USB cable supplied with the iPod. 1 Connect the USB cable to the iPod. Functional differences depending on the way of connection USB cable supplied with iPod Yamaha iPod universal dock (such as YDS-12) Yamaha iPod wireless system (YID-W10) Audio output ✓ ✓ ✓ Video output ✓* ✓ — Operation with remote control of the unit ✓ ✓ — Operation with iPod ✓ Operation on TV screen ✓ ✓ — Charging ✓ ✓ ✓ Charging during standby mode — ✓ ✓ 2 Connect the USB cable to the USB jack. This unit (front) INPUT ON SCREEN ✓ OPTION TONE/BALANCE SCENE STRAIGHT 1 ✓ 2 3 MULTI ZONE PROGRAM ENTER ZONE 2 RETURN Supported iPod (as of April 2011) iPod touch iPod nano iPod classic iPod with video iPod with color display iPod with click wheel iPod mini iPhone 4 iPhone 3GS iPhone 3G iPhone iPod touch iPod nano iPod classic iPod with video iPhone 4 iPhone 3GS iPhone 3G iPhone VIDEO AU PHONES iPod/iPhone iPod touch iPod nano (2 gen. to 6 gen.) iPod classic iPhone 4 iPhone 3GS iPhone 3G iPhone ZON DISPLAY USB DOCK TAG HD IN OUT 1 OUT 2 PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP HD 3 YPAO MIC SILENT CINEMA USB Connected S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR * Requires an Apple Composite AV Cable (not supplied). Connect the USB and composite video plugs of the Apple Composite AV cable to the USB jack and VIDEO AUX (VIDEO) jack of this unit and set “Video Out (USB)” (p.89) in the “Input” menu to “V-AUX”. En 60 ■ Using an iPod dock DOCK NETWORK DOCK HD Refer to the instruction manual of the iPod dock in addition. 1 ARC AV 1 (1 BD/DVD) this unit to standby mode and connect the iPod 1 Set dock to the DOCK jack. AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT PHONO GND AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 5 OPTICAL 6 COAXIAL (2 TV) L (3 CD) AU R Locate the iPod dock at the distance as far as from this unit. 1 COAXIAL 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL DOCK NETWORK DOCK HD 1 ARC 12 A AV 1 (1 BD/DVD) AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 3 B MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω PHONO GND iPod wireless system (receiver) AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 5 OPTICAL 6 COAXIAL (2 TV) L (3 CD) AU This unit (rear) R 1 COAXIAL 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω iPod dock 2 Connect the power cable to an AC wall outlet. your iPod to the iPod wireless system 3 Connect (transmitter). This unit (rear) 2 4 On your iPod, select the content and start playback. Connect your iPod to the iPod dock and turn on this unit. This unit automatically turns on and selects “DOCK” as the input source. • While an iPod is connected to the iPod dock, the iPod is charged. You can select whether to charge the iPod when this unit is in standby mode using “Standby Charge” (p.88) in the “Input” menu. • You can select whether to control this unit (power on/off, input selection and volume adjustment) in conjunction with iPod operations using “iPod Interlock” (p.88) in the “Input” menu. When the iPod interlock function is disabled, turn on this unit and select the input source manually. ■ Using an iPod wireless system When using an iPod wireless system, operate your iPod itself to start playback after making a connection. Refer to the instruction manual of the iPod wireless system in addition. the power cable from the AC wall outlet 1 Disconnect and connect the iPod wireless system (receiver) to the DOCK jack. • While the iPod wireless system (transmitter) is placed on the iPod wireless system (receiver), the iPod is charged. You can select whether to charge the iPod when this unit is in standby mode using “Standby Charge” (p.88) in the “Input” menu. Caution • When you use iPod controls to adjust volume, the volume may be unexpectedly loud. This could result in damage to this unit or speakers. If the volume suddenly increases during playback, remove the iPod from the iPod wireless system (transmitter) immediately. To prevent this problem, we recommend using “Max Volume” (p.102) in the “Setup” menu to set the maximum volume level for this unit. Locate the iPod wireless system (receiver) at the distance as far as from this unit. En 61 ZONE 2 MAIN Playback of iPod contents CODE SET ■ Browse screen SOURCE RECEIVER 3 4 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 When using a USB cable or an iPod dock, you can control the iPod with the menu displayed on the TV. AV 1 2 5 6 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK DOCK NET USB USB PRESET TUNING AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY 1 2 BD/DVD TV using a USB cable: press USB to select 1 When “USB” as the input source. When using an iPod dock: press DOCK to select “DOCK” as the input source. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT The browse screen is displayed on the TV. SCENE ON SCREEN 3 4 CD RADIO VOLUME RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE 1 Status indicators Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.64) and playback status (play/pause, etc). 3 Contents list Menu operation keys Cursor keys Displays the list of iPod contents. Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. ENTER RETURN 4 Item number/total MODE 5 Operation menu 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 8 TV CH * Display example (when using an iPod dock) Menu Function ENT TV TV VOL Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. 4 INPUT MUTE 4 2 List name OPTION ENTER 5 • When using an iPod wireless system, you cannot control the iPod from the TV screen. Operate your iPod itself to select the content and start playback. HDMI OUT the cursor keys to select an item and press 2 Use ENTER. If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback screen is displayed. 1 Page Up Moves to the previous/next page of the list. 1 Page Down 10 Pages Up Moves to 10 pages forward/backward. 10 Pages Down Return Returns to the higher-level list. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. • To return to the previous screen, press RETURN. • To operate the iPod itself to select a content or control playback, switch to the simple play mode (p.63). En 62 ZONE 2 MAIN ■ Playback screen CODE SET ■ Operating the iPod itself or remote control (simple play) SOURCE RECEIVER 1 2 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 Press MODE to switch to the simple play mode. AUDIO 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY 3 MUSIC SLEEP PARTY Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.64) and playback status (play/pause, etc). ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN 2 Playback information OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN External device operation keys MODE 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 4 8 MODE Displays the artist name, album name, song title and elapsed/remaining time. Use the cursor keys to select information to be scrolled. 3 Album image Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. Menu ENT Function Cursor keys Select an item. ENTER Confirms the selection. RETURN Returns to the previous screen. Starts playback or stops playback temporarily. Submenu Function External device operation keys Stops playback. Skips forward/backward. Resumes playback from pause. TV TV CH Operational remote control keys 4 Operation menu INPUT TV VOL The TV menu screen turns off and iPod operations are enabled. To display the TV menu screen, press MODE again. your iPod itself or the remote control to 2 Operate start playback. 1 Status indicators SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE 4 Stops playback. HDMI OUT MUTE Searches forward/backward (while holding down). Stops playback temporarily. Play Control Skips forward/backward. Searches forward/backward (by holding down). Browse Moves to the browse screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. • You can also use the external device operation keys on the remote control to control playback. En 63 ZONE 2 MAIN ■ Shuffle/repeat settings CODE SET You can configure the shuffle/repeat settings of your iPod. SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING • When using an iPod wireless system, configure the shuffle/repeat settings directly on your iPod. AUDIO TUNER • During simple play, configure the shuffle/repeat settings directly on your iPod, or press MODE to display the TV menu screen and then follow the procedure below. • Texts in parentheses denote indications on the front display. FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY “USB” or “DOCK” is selected as the input 1 When source, press OPTION. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN OPTION OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN POP-UP MENU TOP MENU Cursor keys ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or 2 Use “Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER. • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. MUTE • Texts in parentheses denote indications on the front display. MODE MODE 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 4 8 ENT TV the cursor keys ( 3 Use press ENTER. Item / ) to select a setting and Setting Function Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function. Songs (Songs) Plays back songs in random order. “ appears in the TV screen. Albums (Albums) Plays back albums in random order. “ appears in the TV screen. Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function. One (One) Plays back the current song repeatedly. “ 1 ” appears in the TV screen. All (All) Plays back all songs repeatedly. “ appears in the TV screen. INPUT TV VOL TV CH HDMI OUT MUTE Shuffle (Shuffle) Repeat (Repeat) ” ” ” 4 To exit from the menu, press OPTION. En 64 ZONE 2 MAIN Playing back music via Bluetooth CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY DOCK MEMORY • When connecting your Bluetooth component to the Bluetooth receiver for the first time, you need to perform “pairing” (mutual recognition for 2 Bluetooth components). After that, you only need to establish a wireless connection between those components to play back music via Bluetooth. “Pairing” must be performed between each combination. So if you have several Bluetooth components, you need to pair each of your Bluetooth components with the Bluetooth receiver. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 BD/DVD TV You can play back music stored on a Bluetooth component on this unit using a Yamaha Bluetooth wireless audio receiver (such as YBA-10, optional). Refer to the instruction manuals of the Bluetooth receiver and your Bluetooth component in addition. This unit supports A2DP (Advanced Audio Distribution Profile) of the Bluetooth profile. ON SCREEN 3 4 CD RADIO OPTION OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU Cursor keys Connecting a Bluetooth receiver MUTE this unit is in standby mode, connect the 1 When Bluetooth receiver to the DOCK jack. MODE 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 4 8 ENT Locate the Bluetooth receiver at the distance as far as from this unit. TV DOCK INPUT NETWORK DOCK TV VOL TV CH HD 1 HDMI OUT ARC MUTE AV 1 (1 BD/DVD) AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT Pairing Bluetooth components Be sure to perform pairing when connecting a Bluetooth component to the Bluetooth receiver for the first time, or when the pairing setting has been deleted. • The Yamaha Bluetooth receiver (YBA-10) can be paired with up to eight Bluetooth components. When the ninth component is paired, the pairing setting for the component which has not been used for the longest period of time will be deleted. • Texts in parentheses denote indications on the front display. 1 Press DOCK to select “DOCK” as the input source. on your Bluetooth component and set it to the 2 Turn pairing mode. OPTION, use the cursor keys to select 3 Press “Pairing” (Pairing), and then press ENTER. Searching starts. If your Bluetooth component recognizes the Bluetooth receiver, the model name (such as “YBA-10 YAMAHA”) will be displayed in the device list of your component. DOCK TAG HD PHONO GND AUDIO 1 (2 TV) L AUDIO 2 (3 CD) AU IN OUT 1 OUT 2 PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP HD 3 DOCK Searching... MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR R 1 COAXIAL 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL 5 OPTICAL 6 COAXIAL • To cancel the search, press RETURN. ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω • You can also start the search by holding down MEMORY instead of step 3. (To cancel the search, press MEMORY again.) Bluetooth receiver This unit (rear) 2 Turn on this unit. En 65 ZONE 2 MAIN the Bluetooth receiver from the device list 4 Select and enter the pass key “0000”. CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX “Completed” appears when the pairing is complete. DOCK TAG HD AUDIO 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING IN OUT 1 OUT 2 TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY DOCK MUSIC SLEEP PARTY HD 3 DOCK Completed MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR • Depending on Bluetooth components, “BT connected” appears when the pairing is complete. In this case, the wireless connection has been already established. You just need to start playback on your Bluetooth component to enjoy it on this unit. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP ENHANCER PURE DIRECT Establishing a wireless connection and playing back When the pairing is complete, follow the procedure below to establish a wireless connection between your Bluetooth component and the Bluetooth receiver. When the connection is established, this unit outputs sounds played back on the Bluetooth component. • Depending on Bluetooth components, a wireless connection is established automatically or by operating the Bluetooth component. In this case, you can skip steps 2 and 3 below. • Texts in parentheses denote indications on the front display. SCENE 1 2 BD/DVD TV ON SCREEN 3 4 CD RADIO OPTION OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE MODE 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 Cursor keys ENTER DISPLAY A 4 5 To exit from the menu, press OPTION. 1 Press DOCK to select “DOCK” as the input source. 2 Press OPTION. the cursor keys to select “Connect” (Connect) 3 Use and then press ENTER. “BT connected” appears when the wireless connection is established. 8 ENT TV DOCK TAG HD IN OUT 1 OUT 2 INPUT PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP HD 3 TV VOL TV CH BTconnected MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR HDMI OUT MUTE • If the Bluetooth receiver is paired with more than one Bluetooth component, the lastly-connected component is automatically chosen. When you cannot establish a connection with an intended component, perform pairing again or perform the connection operation from the intended component. • “Not found” appears if a connection cannot be established. Check the followings and try again. - The Bluetooth component and Bluetooth receiver are paired. - The Bluetooth component is turned on and the Bluetooth mode is enabled. - The Bluetooth component is within 10 m of the Bluetooth receiver. 4 Start playback on your Bluetooth component. • To terminate the wireless connection, select “Disconnect” (Disconnect) in step 3. En 66 ZONE 2 MAIN Playing back music stored on a USB storage device CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING You can play back music files stored on a USB storage device on this unit. Refer to the instruction manuals of the USB storage device in addition. This unit supports USB mass storage class devices (FAT16 or FAT32 format, except USB HDDs). AUDIO TUNER FM INFO • This unit supports playback of WAV (PCM format only), MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC and FLAC files. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY Follow the procedure below to operate the USB storage device contents and start playback. 1 Press USB to select “USB” as the input source. USB AM MEMORY Playback of USB storage device contents The browse screen is displayed on the TV. • This unit is compatible with sampling frequency of up to 96 kHz for WAV and FLAC files, and 48 kHz for other files. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN Connecting a USB storage device OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU Cursor keys MUTE 1 Connect the USB storage device to the USB jack. This unit (front) MODE MULTI ZONE PROGRAM ENTER ZONE 2 RETURN 1 2 3 ZON DISPLAY VIDEO AU PHONES 4 USB 5 6 7 8 iPod/iPhone 9 0 10 YPAO MIC SILENT CINEMA S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO the cursor keys to select an item and press 2 Use ENTER. ENT TV INPUT TV VOL TV CH • If playback is ongoing on your USB storage device, the playback screen is displayed. R HDMI OUT MUTE If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback screen is displayed. USB USB storage device DOCK TAG HD IN OUT 1 OUT 2 PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP HD 3 USB Connected MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR • To return to the previous screen, press RETURN. • If the USB storage device contains many files, it may take time to load the files. In this case, “Loading...” appears in the front display. • Files not supported by this unit are not listed. • You can register your favorite items as shortcuts (p.80) and access them directly by selecting the shortcut numbers. En 67 ZONE 2 MAIN ■ Browse screen CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER 1 2 3 AV 3 4 7 V-AUX 1 2 5 6 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING ■ Playback screen 1 2 AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY 3 5 4 4 SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT 1 Status indicators ENHANCER PURE DIRECT Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.69) and playback status. 1 Status indicators Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.69) and playback status. SCENE 1 2 BD/DVD TV ON SCREEN 3 4 CD RADIO VOLUME ENTER DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN External device operation keys MODE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT TV Displays the artist name, album name, song title and elapsed time. Use the cursor keys to select information to be scrolled. Displays the list of USB storage device contents. Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. 4 Item number/total 5 Operation menu Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. TV CH 3 Album image 4 Operation menu Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. Menu Menu Function 1 Page Up Submenu Function Stops playback. Moves to the previous/next page of the list. Play Control Skips forward/backward. Moves to 10 pages forward/backward. Browse Moves to the browse screen. Return Returns to the higher-level list. Screen Off Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. 1 Page Down INPUT TV VOL 2 Playback information 3 Contents list OPTION RETURN MUTE 2 List name HDMI OUT 10 Pages Up 10 Pages Down • You can also use the external device operation keys ( remote control to control playback. , , , ) on the En 68 ZONE 2 MAIN ■ Shuffle/repeat settings CODE SET You can configure the shuffle/repeat settings for playback of USB storage device contents. SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING AUDIO • The shuffle/repeat settings are shared by USB and network sources. TUNER FM “USB” is selected as the input source, press 1 When OPTION. AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or 2 Use “Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN OPTION OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE MODE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 TV CH • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. ENTER RETURN • Texts in parentheses denote indications on the front display. the cursor keys ( 3 Use press ENTER. Item / ) to select a setting and Setting Function Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function. On (On) Plays back songs in the current album (folder) in random order. “ ” appears in the TV screen. Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function. Single (Single) Plays back the current song repeatedly. “ 1 ” appears in the TV screen. All (All) Plays back all songs in the current album (folder) repeatedly. “ ” appears in the TV screen. ENT Shuffle (Shuffle) TV INPUT TV VOL Cursor keys HDMI OUT MUTE Repeat (Repeat) 4 To exit from the menu, press OPTION. En 69 ZONE 2 MAIN Playing back music stored on PCs CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING You can play back music files stored on your PC or DLNAcompatible NAS on this unit. AUDIO TUNER FM Follow the procedure below to operate the PC music contents and start playback. NET AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO • This unit is compatible with sampling frequency of up to 96 kHz for WAV and FLAC files, and 48 kHz for other files. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT VOLUME POP-UP MENU MUTE MODE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH Cursor keys ENTER DISPLAY A TOP MENU The browse screen is displayed on the TV. Requirements OPTION RETURN NET repeatedly to select “PC” as the input 1 Press source. • To play back FLAC files, you need to install server software that supports sharing of FLAC files via DLNA on your PC or use a NAS that supports FLAC files. SCENE ENTER • To use this function, this unit and your PC must be connected to the network properly (p.36). You can check whether the network parameters (IP address, etc.) are properly assigned to this unit in “Network” (p.111) in the “Information”. • This unit supports playback of WAV (PCM format only), MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC and FLAC files. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ON SCREEN Playback of PC music contents HDMI OUT This unit can play back music files stored on the following music servers. - PC with Windows Media Player 11 or later installed - PC with DLNA/UPnP certificate server software installed - NAS with DLNA/UPnP certification Media sharing setup To play back music files stored on your PC or DLNA-compatible NAS, first you need to configure the media sharing setting on each music server. ■ For a PC with Windows Media Player installed that Windows Media Player 11 or later is 1 Check installed on your PC. • If playback of a music file selected from this unit is ongoing on your PC, the playback screen is displayed. This function works only when “DMC Control” (p.89) in the “Input” menu is set to “Disable”. the cursor keys to select a music server and 2 Use press ENTER. the cursor keys to select an item and press 3 Use ENTER. If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback screen is displayed. the media sharing settings, enable the media 2 Insharing and select this unit as a device to which the media is shared. ■ For a NAS or a PC with other DLNA sever software installed Refer to the instruction manual of the device or software and configure the media sharing setting. En 70 ZONE 2 MAIN ■ Playback screen CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER • To return to the previous screen, press RETURN. 1 2 AV 3 4 7 V-AUX 1 2 5 6 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING • Files not supported by this unit are not listed (or cannot be selected even if listed). • You can register your favorite items as shortcuts (p.80) and access them directly by selecting the shortcut numbers. AUDIO TUNER FM INFO MEMORY MUSIC SLEEP PARTY 1 2 3 SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 1 Status indicators Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.72) and playback status (play/pause). SCENE 1 2 BD/DVD TV ON SCREEN 3 4 CD RADIO VOLUME RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE 6 ENTER RETURN 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL TV CH HDMI OUT 2 Playback information Displays the artist name, album name, song title and elapsed time. Use the cursor keys to select information to be scrolled. 5 Menu operation keys Cursor keys External device operation keys MODE MUTE 4 OPTION ENTER 4 ■ Browse screen AM MOVIE 3 3 Album image 1 Status indicators Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.72) and playback status (play/pause). 2 List name 4 Operation menu Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. Menu 3 Contents list Function Resumes playback from pause. Displays the list of PC contents. Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. Stops playback. Play Control 4 Album image Submenu Stops playback temporarily. 5 Item number/total Skips forward/backward. 6 Operation menu Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. Menu Function 1 Page Up Browse Moves to the browse screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. Moves to the previous/next page of the list. 1 Page Down 10 Pages Up Moves to 10 pages forward/backward. • You can also use the external device operation keys ( remote control to control playback. Return Returns to the higher-level list. • You can also use a DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control playback. For details, see “DMC Control” (p.89). Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. 10 Pages Down , , , , ) on the En 71 ZONE 2 MAIN ■ Shuffle/repeat settings CODE SET You can configure the shuffle/repeat settings for playback of PC music contents. SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO • The shuffle/repeat settings are shared by USB and network sources. “PC” is selected as the input source, press 1 When OPTION. the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or 2 Use “Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE ON SCREEN OPTION OPTION • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. VOLUME ENTER RETURN ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE MODE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL TV CH Cursor keys • Texts in parentheses denote indications on the front display. the cursor keys ( / ) to select a setting and 3 Use press ENTER. Item Shuffle (Shuffle) Setting Function Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function. On (On) Plays back songs in the current album (folder) in random order. “ ” appears in the TV screen. Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function. Single (Single) Plays back the current song repeatedly. “ 1 ” appears in the TV screen. All (All) Plays back all songs in the current album (folder) repeatedly. “ ” appears in the TV screen. HDMI OUT MUTE Repeat (Repeat) 4 To exit from the menu, press OPTION. En 72 ZONE 2 MAIN Listening to Internet radio CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING You can listen to Internet radio stations using the vTuner Internet radio station database service particularly customized for this unit, providing a database of numerous radio stations in the world. AUDIO TUNER FM INFO NET AM 1 2 3 • To use this function, this unit must be connected to the Internet (p.36). You can check whether the network parameters (IP address, etc.) are properly assigned to this unit in “Network” (p.111) in the “Information”. 4 6 MEMORY • This service may be discontinued without notice. • Some Internet radio stations may not be played. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY 5 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT NET repeatedly to select “NET RADIO” as the 1 Press input source. SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN The browse screen is displayed on the TV. OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE Menu operation keys Cursor keys 1 Playback indicator 2 List name 3 Contents list ENTER RETURN Displays the list of Internet radio contents. Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. 4 Station art MODE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 5 Item number/total 6 Operation menu Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE ■ Browse screen TV CH HDMI OUT the cursor keys to select an item and press 2 Use ENTER. If an Internet radio station is selected, playback starts and the playback screen is displayed. Menu Function Bookmark On Adds the station selected in the list to “Bookmarks”. 1 Page Up Moves to the previous/next page of the list. 1 Page Down 10 Pages Up Moves to 10 pages forward/backward. 10 Pages Down Return Returns to the higher-level list. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. • To return to the previous screen, press RETURN. • You can register your favorite Internet radio stations as shortcuts (p.80) and access them directly by selecting the shortcut numbers. En 73 ZONE 2 MAIN CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER • By adding your favorite Internet radio stations to “Bookmarks”, you can access to them quickly from “Bookmarks”. To remove stations from “Bookmarks”, select the station in “Bookmarks” and then “Bookmark Off”. AV 3 4 7 V-AUX 1 2 5 6 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING • You can also register your favorite Internet radio stations by accessing the following website with the web browser on your PC. To use this feature, you need the vTuner ID of this unit and your e-mail address to create your personal account. You can check the vTunerID (MAC address of this unit) in the “Network” screen (p.111) in the “Information” menu. http://yradio.vtuner.com/ AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY ■ Playback screen SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 1 2 SCENE 1 2 BD/DVD TV ON SCREEN 3 4 CD RADIO OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE 4 ENTER RETURN External device operation keys MODE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT TV TV VOL 1 Playback indicators 2 Playback information Displays the station name and elapsed time. 3 Station art INPUT MUTE 3 Menu operation keys Cursor keys TV CH HDMI OUT 4 Operation menu Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. Menu Submenu Function Bookmark On Adds the current station to “Bookmarks”. Play Control Stops playback. Browse Moves to the browse screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. • You can also use the external device operation keys ( control to control playback. , ) on the remote En 74 Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) The multi-zone function allows you to play back separate input sources in the room where this unit is installed (main zone) and another room (Zone2). For example, while you are watching a TV in the living room (main zone), another person can listen to radio in the bedroom (Zone2). Preparing for Zone2 Connect devices to be set in Zone2 to this unit. The connection method varies depending on an amplifier to use (this unit or external amplifier). Caution • Since there are many possible ways to use this unit in a multi-zone configuration, we recommend that you consult with your nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center about the multi-zone connections that best meet your requirements. • Remove the power cable of this unit from an AC wall outlet before connecting speakers or an external amplifier. • Be careful that the core of the speaker cable does not touch anything or come into contact with the metal areas of this unit. This may damage this unit or the speakers. If the speaker cables short circuit, “CHECK SP WIRES” will appear on the front display when this unit is turned on. ■ Using the internal amplifier of this unit Connect the speakers placed in Zone2 to this unit with speaker cables. For details, see “Connecting Zone2 speakers” (p.22). Bedroom (Zone2) Living room (main zone) • Only analog audio signals (including radio, USB and network sources) can be output to Zone2. To listen to playback sounds of an external device in Zone2, you need to connect the device to the AUDIO jacks of this unit with a stereo pin cable. The party mode (p.79) allows you to enjoy main zone sources in Zone2 simultaneously regardless of input audio signal types. En 75 ■ Using an external amplifier ■ Connecting a video monitor for Zone2 Connect the external amplifier placed in Zone2 to this unit with a stereo pin cable. Connect a video monitor for Zone2 to watch videos at Zone2. Depending on the video input jacks available on your video monitor, choose one of the video connection methods. This unit (rear) HDMI HDMI OUT 2 AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 (1 BD/DVD) Y PB COMPONENT VIDEO PR Y AV 3 PB C ZONE OUT (ZONE 2) jacks PR • The video conversion between the analog video jacks does not work for Zone2 video output. To watch videos played back on a video device on the Zone2 video monitor, you need to connect the video monitor to this unit in the same way as the video device. AV 1 A Y MONITOR OUT/ZON PB ZONE OUT AV 2 B D AV 4 AUDIO 3 AUDIO 4 MULTI CH INPUT ZONE OUT CENTER L ZONE OUT jacks (any of COMPONENT VIDEO, VIDEO, S VIDEO) R FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER ZONE 2 FRONT SPEAKER R SURROUND L R SURROUND B ZONE 2 External amplifier Audio input (analog stereo) Y MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT PB PR Video input (any of component video, composite video, S-video) PR PB HDMI HDMI OUT 1 L AV 1 2 R AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5 Y (1 BD/DVD) ARC MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT Y PB COMPONENT VIDEO PR Y AV 3 PB C COMPONENT VIDEO PR AV 1 A Y MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT PB PR RE IN AUDIO Y PR AV 2 PB PR B D AV 4 AUDIO 1 (2 TV) AUDIO 2 (3 CD) AUDIO 3 AUDIO 4 MULTI CH INPUT ZONE OUT CENTER PB PRE OUT (SINGLE SURROUND SUR. BACK Y MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT 5 OPTICAL 6 COAXIAL FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK V SUBWOOFER ZONE 2 FRONT VIDEO SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R SURROUND BACK L C V S S VIDEO SINGLE Zone2 This unit (rear) S Main zone Zone2 Main zone To assign the ZONE OUT jacks to the Zone2 video monitor, set “Monitor Out Assign” (p.106) in the “Setup” menu to “Zone2”. En 76 ■ Operating this unit from Zone2 (remote connection) By connecting an infrared signal receiver/emitter to the REMOTE IN/OUT jacks of this unit, you can operate this unit and external devices from Zone2 with the supplied remote control. • To operate external devices with the supplied remote control, register a remote control code for each device in advance (p.115). REMOTE IN/OUT jacks This unit (rear) HDMI AV 2 AV 3 ONENT VIDEO Y AV 3 PB C AV 4 AV 6 AV 7 Y MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT PB PR REMOTE IN REMOTE OUT IN D AV 4 CH INPUT AV 5 PR ZONE OUT CENTER PRE OUT (SINGLE) SURROUND SUR. BACK OUT 1 2 D SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER ZONE 2 FRONT SUBWOOFER CENTER SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R SURROUND BACK L CENTER R FRO SINGLE Infrared signal transmitter Infrared signal receiver External device (CD player, etc.) Remote control Zone2 Main zone En 77 ZONE 2 MAIN CODE SET MAIN/ZONE2 SOURCE RECEIVER RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET AV1~4 V-AUX AUDIO1~4 PHONO DOCK TUNER NET USB ❑ Remote connections between Yamaha products If you are using Yamaha products that support remote connections like this unit, an infrared signal transmitter is unnecessary. You can transmit remote control signals by connecting the REMOTE IN/OUT jacks with monaural mini-jack cables and an infrared signal receiver. REMOTE IN/OUT jacks REMOTE REMOTE IN/OUT jacks REMOTE IN IN OUT OUT TUNING SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 BD/DVD TV ON SCREEN 3 4 CD RADIO Yamaha products (up to 6, including this unit) VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A Remote control POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE MODE Zone2 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 4 8 ENT 1 Set MAIN/ZONE2 to “ZONE2”. 2 Press RECEIVER . Each time you press the key, Zone2 output is enabled or disabled. When Zone2 output is enabled, “ZONE2” lights up in the front display. 3 Use the following keys to select an input source. Infrared signal receiver OPTION Controlling Zone2 AV1~4: AV1~4 (AUDIO) jacks V-AUX: VIDEO AUX (AUDIO) jacks (on the front panel) AUDIO1~4: AUDIO1~4 (AUDIO) jacks PHONO: PHONO jacks DOCK: DOCK jack TUNER: FM/AM radio NET: NETWORK jack (press repeatedly to select a desired network source) USB: USB jack (on the front panel) TV INPUT TV VOL TV CH HDMI OUT MUTE • You cannot select USB and network sources exclusively for each zone. For example, if you select “PC” for Zone2 when “USB” is selected for the main zone, the input source for the main zone also switches to “PC”. En 78 ZONE 2 MAIN 4 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX AUDIO 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SLEEP PARTY SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN Adjusting the high-/low-frequency range of sounds Start playback on the external device, or select a radio station. Refer to the instruction manual of the external device. For details on the following operations, see the corresponding pages. - Listening to FM/AM radio (p.56) - Playing back iPod music (p.60) - Playing back music via Bluetooth (p.65) - Playing back music stored on a USB storage device (p.67) - Playing back music stored on PCs (p.70) - Listening to Internet radio (p.73) SCENE OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN VOLUME DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE MODE MUTE • The on-screen operations are not available for Zone2. Use the front display or web control (p.81) to control Zone2. Caution • To avoid unexpected noise, never play back DTS-CDs in Zone2. 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 8 ENT INPUT TV CH Setting range -10.0dB ~ +10.0dB (2.0dB steps) Default 0.0dB Adjusting the Zone2 front speaker balance a Press ZONE CONTROL on the front panel. b Press TONE/BALANCE repeatedly to select “Balance”. c Press PROGRAM to make an adjustment. ■ Enjoying main zone sources in Zone2 (party mode) The party mode allows you to enjoy main zone sources in Zone2 simultaneously. During the party mode, stereo playback is automatically selected for all zones. Utilize this function when you want to play back main sources as background music in a home party, etc. 4 TV TV VOL a Press ZONE CONTROL on the front panel. b Press TONE/BALANCE repeatedly to select “Treble” or “Bass”. c Press PROGRAM to make an adjustment. HDMI OUT ■ Other operations for Zone2 The following functions are also available when Zone2 output is enabled. MUTE Adjusting the volume Press VOLUME or MUTE. 1 Press PARTY. Each time you press the key, the party mode is turned on or off. When the party mode is turned on, “PARTY” lights up in the front display. Selecting the input source and settings at once (SCENE) Press SCENE. • If the party mode does not work on Zone2, set “Party Mode Set” (p.106) in the “Setup” menu to “Enable” (default). • To register the current settings (input source, volume and tone control) to a scene, hold down the desired SCENE key until “SET Complete” appears on the front display. Setting the sleep timer Press SLEEP repeatedly to set the time (120 min, 90 min, 60 min, 30 min, off). En 79 ZONE 2 MAIN Useful functions CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING Registering favorite items (shortcut) ■ Recalling a registered item AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY Recall a registered item by selecting the shortcut number. NET USB You can register up to 40 favorite USB and network contents as shortcuts and access them directly by selecting the shortcut numbers. MEMORY PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT • You can also use the “Bookmarks” feature to register Internet radio stations (p.73). ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN ■ Registering an item 1 Play back a song or a radio station to be registered. 2 Press MEMORY. VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE MODE DOCK TAG HD 1 2 5 6 9 0 3 7 10 4 8 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP HD 3 Numeric keys MemoryPreset 01:Empty IN OUT 1 OUT 2 PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP HD 3 RecallPreset 01:USB MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR • “No Presets” appears when no items are registered. • “Empty” appears when a preset number not in use is entered. • The registered item cannot be recalled in the following cases. MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR - A USB storage device which contains the registered item is not connected to this unit. - A PC which contains the registered item is turned off or not connected to the network. Shortcut number (flashes) ENT You can also enter a shortcut number (01 to 40) directly by using the numeric keys. DOCK TAG HD Select a desired item and register it to a shortcut number. OPTION 1 Press NET or USB. 2 Press PRESET repeatedly to select a desired item. TV - The registered network content is temporarily unavailable or out of service. INPUT TV VOL TV CH HDMI OUT - The registered item (file) has been deleted or moved to another location. MUTE • To change a shortcut number to which the item will be registered, use PRESET or numeric keys to select the shortcut number after step 2. DOCK TAG HD IN OUT 1 OUT 2 PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP HD 3 MemoryPreset 02:Empty • When you register music files stored on a USB storage device or a PC, this unit memorizes the relative position of the music files in the folder. If you have added or deleted any music files to or from the folder, this unit may not recall the music file correctly. In such cases, register the items again. MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR “Empty” (not in use) or item currently registered 3 To confirm the registration, press MEMORY. En 80 Controlling this unit from the web browser (web control) You can control this unit with the web control screen displayed in the web browser. ■ Top menu screen 1 5 Web browser Web control PC 2 6 3 4 7 Web control Router This unit 1 CONTROL Moves to the control screen for the selected zone. 2 STATUS • To use this function, this unit and your PC must be connected to the network properly (p.36). • Some security software installed on your PC may block the access of this unit to your PC. In such cases, configure the security software appropriately. • We recommend using Internet Explorer 7.x or 8.x as a web browser. Turns on/off the power for each zone, or displays the input source and volume set for each zone. 3 SETTINGS Moves to the settings screen. 4 PARTY MODE Turns on/off the party mode (p.79). • If you set “Network Standby” (p.82) to “On”, you can display the web control screen even when this unit is in standby mode. • You can limit access to this unit from the network devices (PCs, etc.) with the MAC address filter (p.82). 1 Start the web browser. the IP address of this unit in the address bar 2 Enter of the web browser. 5 SYSTEM POWER Turns on/off the power for all zones. 6 MAIN VOLUME Adjusts the volume or mutes the audio output for the main zone. You can also switch the step for the volume adjustment. 7 RELOAD Reloads the current status of this unit. (Example) • You can check the IP address in “Network” (p.111) in the “Information” menu. • By adding the IP address of this unit to the bookmark of the browser, you will be able to open it without entering the IP address from the next time. However, the IP address of this unit may change if you are using a DHCP server. En 81 ■ Control screen ■ Settings screen 3 1 4 1 5 2 6 1 PLAY INFO Selects an input source or controls playback for the selected zone. 2 TOP MENU Moves to the top menu screen. 3 SCENE Select a scene for the selected zone. 4 POWER Turns on/off the power for the selected zone. 5 VOLUME Adjusts the volume or mutes the audio output for the selected zone. You can also switch the step for the volume adjustment. 6 RELOAD Reloads the current status of this unit. 2 3 1 Rename Edits the friendly name (name for this unit in the network) or the name of each zone (p.107). Click “APPLY” to apply the changes to this unit. MAC Filter Sets the MAC address filter (p.105) to limit access to this unit from the network devices. Click “APPLY” to apply the changes to this unit. Auto Reload Enables/disables automatic reloading. When “Auto Reload” is “On” (enabled), the web control screen reloads the status of this unit every 5 seconds. Network Standby Enables/disables the network standby function (p.105). Tips 1/ 2 Displays the tips for use of the web control. Create Link Creates a shortcut link to the desired control screen. Backup/Recovery Creates backup of the settings of this unit on the PC, or restores the settings from the backup. 2 BACK Moves to the top menu screen. 3 RELOAD Reloads the current status of this unit. Note • Do not operate this unit during the recovery process (restoring the settings). Otherwise, the settings may not be restored correctly. When the recovery finishes, click “OK” to set this unit to standby mode. • The backup does not contain user information (user account, password, etc.) or unit-specific information (MAC address, IP address, etc). En 82 MAIN ZONE 2 Viewing the current status CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING ■ Switching information on the front display PC USB Song (song title), Artist (artist name), Album (album name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name) * When iPod is connected via USB, the display item switches in the same manner as “DOCK”. AUDIO TUNER FM INFO 1 Press INFO. DOCK TAG HD INFO IN OUT 1 OUT 2 PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP HD 3 Info DSPProgram MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY Item name ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 BD/DVD TV ON SCREEN 3 4 CD RADIO About 3 seconds later, the corresponding information appears. OPTION DOCK TAG HD VOLUME ENTER IN OUT 1 OUT 2 RETURN POP-UP MENU TOP MENU PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP HD 3 DISPLAY AV1 TheRoxyTheat 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 TV CH The following information is displayed on the TV. Input source Volume PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Information MUTE 4 8 ENT TV MUTE 1 Press DISPLAY. DISPLAY • Available items vary depending on the selected input source. Also, the display item can be applied separately to each input source group. Input source group Item AV1~7 V-AUX AUDIO1~4 PHONO DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name) INPUT TV VOL ■ Viewing the status information on the TV MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC MODE 1 Station (station name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name) Each time you press the key, the display item switches. AM MEMORY NET RADIO HDMI OUT Audio format/ Decoder Sound mode CINEMA DSP status 2 To close the information display, press DISPLAY. Frequency (frequency), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name) TUNER * (Europe model only) When tuning into a Radio Data System broadcasting station, Radio Data System data is also available (p.57). Song (song title), Artist (artist name), Album (album name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name) DOCK * When using iPod wireless system, Bluetooth receiver, or during simple play: DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name) En 83 Configuring settings in accordance with a playback source (Option menu) You can configure the playback-related settings in accordance with a playback source. Since this menu is operational on the front panel (or on the TV screen), you can easily configure the settings during playback. 1 Press OPTION. DOCK TAG HD IN OUT 1 OUT 2 PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP HD 3 Option ToneControl Option menu items • Available items vary depending on the selected input source. • Texts in parentheses denote indications on the front display. MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Front display TV screen 2 Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER. • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. 3 Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select a setting and press ENTER. 4 To exit from the menu, press OPTION. Item Function Tone Control (Tone Control) Adjusts the high-frequency range and low-frequency range of sounds. Page 85 Adaptive DRC (Adaptive DRC) Sets whether dynamic range (from maximum to minimum) is adjusted automatically in conjunction with adjusting the volume level. 85 CINEMA DSP 3D Mode (CINEMA DSP 3D) Enables/disables CINEMA DSP 3D. 85 Dialogue Lift (Dialog Lift) Adjusts the vertical position of center sound when front presence speakers are used. 85 Extended Surround (EXTD Surround) Selects the 5.1 to 7.1-channel signal playback method when surround back speakers are used. 86 Volume Trim (Volume Trim) Corrects volume differences between input sources. 86 Enhancer (Enhancer) Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer. 86 Audio Select (Audio Select) Selects the audio input jack to use when more than one audio connection is made for one input source. 86 Traffic Program (TrafficProgram) (Europe model only) Searches for a traffic information station automatically. 58 Shuffle (Shuffle) Configures the shuffle setting for the iPod (p.64), USB storage device (p.69) or PC (p.72). — Repeat (Repeat) Configures the repeat setting for the iPod (p.64), USB storage device (p.69) or PC (p.72). — Connect/Disconnect (Connect/Disconnect) Establishes/terminates a wireless connection between your Bluetooth component and the Bluetooth receiver. 66 Pairing (Pairing) Performs pairing of your Bluetooth component and the Bluetooth receiver. 65 En 84 ■ Tone Control (Tone Control) ■ CINEMA DSP 3D Mode (CINEMA DSP 3D) Adjusts the high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range (Bass) of speaker sounds. When connecting headphones, you can adjust high-frequency range and lowfrequency range of sounds output from headphones. Enables/disables CINEMA DSP 3D. If this function is set to “On”, CINEMA DSP 3D functions according to the selected sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo). Choices Treble (Treble), Bass (Bass) Settings Setting range -6.0db ~ Bypass (Bypass) ~ +6.0dB *0.5dB steps Default Bypass (Bypass) On (On) (default) Enables CINEMA DSP 3D. Off (Off) Disables CINEMA DSP 3D. ■ Dialogue Lift (Dialog Lift) • If you set the balance extremely off, sounds may not match those from other channels well. Adjusting with the front panel controls a Press TONE/BALANCE to select “Treble” or “Bass”. b Press PROGRAM to make an adjustment. Adjusts the vertical position of center sound such as dialogues when front presence speakers are used. If dialogues are heard from a position lower than the TV screen, adjust this setting to raise the position. Setting range 0~5 (higher raises the position) Default 0 ■ Adaptive DRC (Adaptive DRC) Sets whether dynamic range (from maximum to minimum) is adjusted automatically in conjunction with adjusting the volume level. When it is set to “On”, it is useful for listening to playback at low volume at night. Ideal position Settings On (On) Adjusts the dynamic range automatically. Off (Off) (default) Does not adjust the dynamic range automatically. If “On” is selected, the dynamic range becomes narrow at a low volume, and becomes wide at a high volume. On Off Input level Volume: high Output level Output level Volume: low On Off Input level En 85 ■ Extended Surround (EXTD Surround) ■ Enhancer (Enhancer) Selects how to play back 5.1- to 7.1-channel sources when surround back speakers are used. Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer (p.55). Settings • This setting is applied separately to each input source. Auto (Auto) (default) Automatically selects the most suitable decoder if a flag for reproducing surround back channel is present, and reproduces the signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel. When the DTS or DTS-HD signal is input, the unit reproduces the signal in 7.1-channel regardless of a flag for surround back channel. ( PLIIx Movie PLIIxMo) Always reproduces signals in 7.1-channel using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie decoder. This setting is available only when two surround back speakers are connected. ( PLIIx Music PLIIxMu) Always reproduces signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music decoder. This setting is available only when one or two surround back speakers are connected. EX/ES (EX/ES) Automatically selects the most suitable decoder, and reproduces signals in 6.1-channel. Off (Off) Always reproduces signals in original channels. ■ Volume Trim (Volume Trim) Corrects volume differences between input sources. If you are bothered by volume differences when switching between input sources, use this function to correct it. Settings Off (Off) Disables Compressed Music Enhancer. On (On) Enables Compressed Music Enhancer. Default TUNER, DOCK, (network sources), USB: On (On) Others: Off (Off) ■ Audio Select (Audio Select) Selects the audio input jack to use when more than one audio connection is made for one input source. • This setting is applied separately to each input source. Settings Auto (Auto) (default) Automatically selects the audio input jack in the following priority order. 1. HDMI input 2. Digital input (COAXIAL or OPTICAL) 3. Analog input (AUDIO) HDMI (HDMI) Always selects HDMI input. No sounds are produced when no signals are input through the HDMI jack. Coax/Opt (Coax/Opt) Always selects digital input (COAXIAL or OPTICAL). No sounds are produced when no signals are input through the COAXIAL or OPTICAL jack. Analog (Analog) Always selects analog input (AUDIO). No sounds are produced when no signals are input through the AUDIO jacks. • This setting is applied separately to each input source. Setting range -6.0dB ~ +6.0dB (0.5dB steps) Default 0.0dB En 86 CONFIGURATIONS Configuring input sources (Input menu) 4 Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select an item and press ENTER. You can change the input source settings using the TV screen. 1 Press ON SCREEN. 2 Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER. • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. the cursor keys ( / ) to select an input source to be configured 3 Use and press the cursor key ( ). 5 Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER. 6 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Input menu items • Available items vary depending on the selected input source. Item Function Page Rename/Icon Select Changes the input source name and icon. 88 Decoder Mode Sets the format of digital audio playback to DTS. 88 Standby Charge Selects whether to charge the iPod when this unit is in standby mode. 88 iPod Interlock Selects whether to control this unit in conjunction with iPod operations. 88 Video Out Selects a video to be output with the audio input source. 89 DMC Control Selects whether to allow a DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control playback. 89 The input source of this unit also changes. • You can still switch the input source by using cursor keys ( / ) after step 3. En 87 ■ Rename/Icon Select ■ Standby Charge Changes the input source name and icon displayed on the front display or TV screen. Selects whether to charge the iPod connected to the iPod dock or iPod wireless system when this unit is in standby mode. Input sources AV1~7, V-AUX, AUDIO1~4, PHONO, USB, DOCK, MULTI CH ■ Setup procedure 1 Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select an icon and press the cursor key ( ). 2 Press ENTER, use the cursor keys to rename, and then press ENTER again. Input sources DOCK (iPod) Settings On (default) Charges the iPod even when this unit is in standby mode. Off Does not charge the iPod when this unit is in standby mode. ■ iPod Interlock Selects whether to control this unit in conjunction with operations of the iPod connected to the iPod wireless system. Input sources DOCK (iPod) 3 Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. • This function is available only when an iPod wireless system is connected to this unit. • To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. 4 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. ■ Decoder Mode Sets the format of digital audio playback to DTS. For example, if this unit does not detect DTS audio and outputs noise, set “Decoder Mode” to “DTS”. Input sources AV1~7, V-AUX, AUDIO1~4 (available only when any audio digital input jack is assigned) ❑ Power & Input Selects whether to control the power and input source selection of this unit in conjunction with iPod operations. Settings On (default) Enables power and input interlocking controls. When you start playback of the iPod, this unit turns on and “DOCK” is selected as the input source. When you stop playback, this unit enters standby mode after a short time. Off Disables power and input interlocking controls. Settings Auto (default) Automatically selects an audio format to match the input audio signal. DTS Selects DTS only. (Other audio signals are not reproduced.) • When “Power & Input” is set to “On”, the iPod connected to the iPod wireless system is charged regardless of the “Standby Charge” setting (p.88). ❑ Volume Selects whether to control the volume of this unit in conjunction with iPod operations. Settings On (default) Enables volume interlocking controls. When you adjust the iPod volume, the volume of the unit is also adjusted. Off Disables volume interlocking control. En 88 ■ Video Out Selects a video to be output with the audio input source. Input sources TUNER, (network sources), USB, MULTI CH Settings Off (default) Does not output videos. AV1~7, V-AUX Outputs videos input through the corresponding video input jacks. Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) You can change the settings of the SCENE function (p.49) using the TV screen. 1 Press ON SCREEN. 2 Use the cursor keys to select “Scene” and press ENTER. ■ DMC Control Selects whether to allow DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control playback. Input source PC Settings Disable Does not allow DMCs to control playback. Enable (default) Allows DMCs to control playback. the cursor keys ( / ) to select a scene to be configured and 3 Use press the cursor key ( ). • A Digital Media Controller (DMC) is a device that can control other network devices through the network. When this function is enabled, you can control playback of this unit from DMCs (Windows Media Player 12, etc.) on the same network. • You can still switch the scene by using cursor keys ( / ) after step 3. 4 Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select an item and press ENTER. En 89 ■ Load 5 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to change the setting. 6 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Loads the settings registered to the selected scene. Select “DETAIL” to configure the SCENE link playback setting, select items to be included as the scene assignments, or view the settings currently assigned to the selected scene. ❑ Device Control Scene menu items Item Function Page Save Registers the settings currently applied to this unit to the selected scene. 90 Load Loads the settings registered to the selected scene. You can also configure the SCENE link playback setting, select items to be included as the scene assignments, or view the settings currently assigned to the selected scene. 90 Rename/Icon Select Changes the scene name and icon. 91 Reset Restores the default settings for the selected scene. 91 ■ Save Registers the settings currently applied to this unit (input source, sound program, etc.) to the selected scene. • If you have changed the input assignment for a scene, you also need to change the external device assigned to the corresponding SCENE key (p.50). Enables to start playback of external devices connected to this unit via HDMI or a Yamaha product connected to the REMOTE OUT jack, in conjunction with a scene selection (SCENE link playback) Settings Off Disables the SCENE link playback function. HDMI Control Enables SCENE link playback using HDMI Control signals. Select this if HDMI Control-compatible device (BD/DVD players, etc.) is connected to this unit via HDMI. It also turns on the HDMI Control-compatible TV concurrently. IR: Yamaha BD/DVD 1 Enables SCENE link playback using remote control signals. Select this if a Yamaha BD/DVD player is connected to the REMOTE OUT jack. Enables SCENE link playback using remote control signals. Select this IR: Yamaha BD/DVD 2 if a Yamaha BD/DVD player is connected to the REMOTE OUT jack and “IR: Yamaha BD/DVD 1” does not work properly. IR: Yamaha CD Enables SCENE link playback using remote control signals. Select this if a Yamaha CD player is connected to the REMOTE OUT jack. Default SCENE1 (BD/DVD), SCENE2 (TV): HDMI Control SCENE3 (CD): IR: Yamaha CD SCENE4 (RADIO), SCENE5~12: Off • To control playback of an HDMI Control-compatible device by SCENE link playback, you need to set “HDMI Control” in the “Setup” menu to “On” and perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.131). En 90 ❑ Detail ■ Rename/Icon Select Selects items to be included as the scene assignments. You can also view the settings currently assigned to the selected scene. To include items as the scene assignments, use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to check the box (or uncheck the box to exclude). For example, if you often adjust the volume while watching TV but listen to radio with low volume at night, exclude “Volume” from the assignments for SCENE2 (TV) and include “Volume” in the assignments for SCENE4 (RADIO). Changes the scene name and icon displayed on the front display or TV screen. ■ Setup procedure 1 Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select an icon and press the cursor key ( ). 2 Press ENTER, use the cursor keys to rename, and then press ENTER again. Check or uncheck 3 Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. Choices Input Input (p.48), Audio Select (p.86) HDMI Output HDMI Output (p.48) Mode Sound Program (p.51), Pure Direct Mode (p.102) Sound Tone Control (p.85), Adaptive DRC (p.85), Enhancer (p.55) Surround CINEMA DSP 3D Mode (p.85), Dialogue Lift (p.85), Extended Surround (p.86) Video Video Processing (p.103) Volume Master Volume (p.48) Lipsync Lipsync (p.101), Delay (p.101) Speaker Setup Setting Pattern (p.98), PEQ Select (p.100) • To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. 4 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. ■ Reset Restores the default settings (p.49) for the selected scene. Default Input, HDMI Output, Mode, Sound: selected Surround, Video, Volume, Lipsync, Speaker Setup: not selected En 91 Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) 4 Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select an item and press ENTER. You can change the settings of the sound programs and surround decoders using the TV screen. 1 Press ON SCREEN. 2 Use the cursor keys to select “Sound Program” and press ENTER. • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. • To restore the default settings for the selected sound program, select “Reset”. 5 Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER. 6 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. the cursor keys ( / ) to select a sound program to be 3 Use configured and press the cursor key ( ). • You can still switch the sound program by using cursor keys ( / ) after step 3. En 92 Sound Program menu items Item Function Settings Reverb Level Adjusts the volume of the reverberant sound. 0% ~ 100% Higher to strengthen the reverberant sound and lower to weaken. • Available items vary depending on the selected sound program or surround decoder. The following items are available when you select “2ch Stereo” or “7ch Stereo”. ■ Settings for sound programs Sound program Item Function Settings Decode Type Selects a surround decoder to be used in combination with the selected sound program. PLIIx Movie ( PLII Movie), Neo:6 Cinema DSP Level Adjusts the sound field effect level. -6dB ~ +3dB (default: 0dB) Higher to enhance the sound field effect and lower to reduce. Initial Delay Adjusts the delay between the direct sound and presence sound field generation. 1ms ~ 99ms Higher to enhance the delay effect and lower to reduce. Surround Initial Delay Adjusts the delay between the direct sound and surround sound field generation. Surround Back Initial Delay Adjusts the delay between the direct sound and surround back sound field generation. Room Size Adjusts the broadening effect of the presence sound field. Surround Room Size Adjusts the broadening effect of the surround sound field. 1ms ~ 49ms Higher to enhance the delay effect and lower to reduce. 0.1 ~ 2.0 Higher to enhance the broadening effect and lower to reduce. Surround Back Room Size Adjusts the broadening effect of the surround back sound field. Liveness Adjusts the loss of the presence sound field. Surround Liveness Adjusts the loss of the surround sound field. Surround Back Liveness Adjusts the loss of the surround back sound field. Reverb Time Adjust the decay time of the reverberant sound. 1.0s ~ 5.0s Higher to enrich the reverberant sound and lower to have clear sound. Reverb Delay Adjusts the delay between the direct sound and reverberant sound generation. 0 ms ~ 250ms Higher to enhance the delay effect and lower to reduce. 0 ~ 10 Higher to enhance the reflectivity and lower to reduce. 2ch Stereo Item Function Settings Direct Selects whether to automatically bypass the DSP and tone control circuits when an analog audio source is played back. Auto (default), Off Select “Auto” to bypass the circuits (when both “Treble” and “Bass” are set to “Bypass”). Center Level Adjusts the volume of the center channel. Surround L Level Adjusts the volume of the surround left channel. Surround R Level Adjusts the volume of the surround right channel. Surround Back Level Adjusts the volume of the surround back channel. Surround Back L Level Adjusts the volume of the surround back left channel. Surround Back R Level Adjusts the volume of the surround back right channel. Front Presence L Level Adjusts the volume of the front presence left channel. Front Presence R Level Adjusts the volume of the front presence right channel. 0% ~ 100% (default: 100%) 0% ~ 100% (default: 50%) 7ch Stereo 0% ~ 100% (default: 35%) 0% ~ 100% (default: 33%) • Available items in “7ch Stereo” vary depending on the speaker system being used. En 93 ■ Settings for decoders The following items are available when you set “Decode Type” of “Surround Decoder” to “PLIIx Music” or “Neo:6 Music”. Decode Type PLIIx Music Neo:6 Music Item Function Settings Panorama Adjusts the broadening effect of the front sound field. Off (default), On Select “On” to wrap front right/left channel sounds around the field and generate a spacious sound field in combination with the surround sound field. Center Width Adjusts the broadening effect of the center sound field. 0 ~ 7 (default: 3) Higher to enhance the broadening effect and lower to reduce (closer to center). Dimension Adjusts the difference in level between the front and surround sound fields. -3 ~ +3 (default: 0) Higher to strengthen the front sound field and lower to strengthen the surround sound field. Center Image Adjusts the center orientation level (broadening effect) of the front sound field. 0.0 ~ 1.0 (default: 0.3) Higher to strengthen the center orientation level (less broadening effect) and lower to weaken (more broadening effect). En 94 Configuring various functions (Setup menu) You can configure the various functions of this unit using the TV screen. 1 Press ON SCREEN. 2 Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. 3 Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select a menu. 4 Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select an item and press ENTER. 5 Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER. 6 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. En 95 Setup menu items Menu Item Function Auto Setup Optimizes the speaker settings automatically (YPAO). Page 41 Setting Pattern Registers two speaker setting patterns and switches between them. 98 Setting Data Copy Copies the “Setting Pattern” parameters in the specified direction. 98 Power Amp Assign Selects a speaker system. 98 Front Selects the size of the front speakers. 98 Center Selects whether or not a center speaker is connected and its size. 99 Surround Selects whether or not surround speakers are connected and its size. 99 Surround Back Selects whether or not surround back speakers are connected and its size. 99 Front Presence Selects whether or not front presence speakers are connected. 99 Subwoofer Selects whether or not a subwoofer is connected and its phase. 99 Configuration Speaker Manual Setup Extra Bass Sets the speakers to produce the front channel low-frequency components. Bass Cross Over Sets the lower limit of low-frequency component produced from speakers of which the size is set to “Small”. 99 100 Distance Sets the distance between each speaker and listening position. 100 Level Adjusts the volume of each speaker. 100 PEQ Select Selects a type of equalizer to be used. 100 PEQ Data Copy Copies the parametric equalizer values acquired with “Auto Setup” to the “Manual” fields for fine adjustment. 100 Enables/disabled the test tone output. 101 Lipsync Adjusts the delay between video and audio output. 101 Dynamic Range Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for bitstream audio (Dolby Digital and DTS signals) playback. 102 Max Volume Sets the maximum volume so that sound is not too loud. 102 Initial Volume Sets the initial volume for when this receiver is turned on. 102 Pure Direct Mode Selects whether to output video signals during the Pure Direct mode. 102 Adaptive DSP Level Selects whether to automatically adjust the CINEMA DSP effect level in conjunction with volume adjustments. 102 Analog to Analog Conversion Enables/disables the video conversion between the analog video jacks. 102 Processing Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio). 103 HDMI Control Enables/disables HDMI Control. You can also configure the relevant settings (ARC, TV audio input, etc). 103 Audio Output Selects a device to output audio. 104 Standby Through Select whether to output videos/audio (input through HDMI jacks) to the TV when this unit is in standby mode. 104 Parametric EQ Test Tone Sound Video HDMI En 96 Menu Network Item Function Page IP Address Configures the network parameters (IP address, etc). 105 Network Standby Selects whether or not to turn on this unit by the command from other network devices. 105 MAC Address Filter Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to this unit from other network devices. 105 Volume Enables/disables volume adjustments for Zone2 output. 106 Max Volume Sets the Zone2 maximum volume so that sound is not too loud. 106 Initial Volume Sets the Zone2 initial volume for when this unit is turned on. 106 Mono Switches between stereo and monaural for Zone2 output. 106 Monitor Out Assign Select the zone for which the MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT jacks are used. 106 Party Mode Set Enables/disables switching to the party mode. 106 Zone Scene Rename Changes the scene names (for Zone2) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 106 Zone Rename Changes the zone names displayed on the front display or TV screen. 107 Auto Power Down Sets the amount of time for auto-standby. 107 Zone2 Set Multi Zone Input Assignment Dimmer Assigns the COMPONENT VIDEO, COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks to another input source. 108 Adjusts the brightness of the front display. 108 Front Panel Display Sets the scrolling manner of the front display. 108 Short Message Selects whether to display short messages on the TV screen when this unit is operated. 108 Wall Paper Selects a wall paper displayed on the TV. 108 Trigger Mode Specifies the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function. 109 Specifies the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions synchronized. 109 Specifies the output level of the electronic signal transmitted with each input switching. 109 Scroll Display Set Function Trigger Output1 Target Zone Trigger Output2 Target Source Manual Memory Guard Language Switches the output level for electronic signal transmission manually. 109 Prevents accidental changes to the settings. 109 Select an on-screen menu language. 110 En 97 Speaker (Manual Setup) Configures the speaker settings manually. ■ Power Amp Assign Selects a speaker system. This unit has 7 built-in amplifiers. You can connect 2 to 9 speakers and up to 2 subwoofers (with built-in amplifier) to create the favorite acoustic space in your room. You can also apply bi-amp connections, channel expansion (using an external power amplifier) or multi-zone configurations to enhance your system. Settings Basic (default) Select this when you use the basic speaker configuration (7-channel plus front presence speakers) (p.15). 7ch +1ZONE Select this when you use 7-channel speakers in the main zone and Zone2 speakers (p.21). 5ch BI-AMP Select this when you use 5-channel speakers (including bi-amp front speakers) (p.20). 5ch BI-AMP +SB Select this when you use 5-channel speakers (including bi-amp front speakers) plus surround back channel expansion using an external amplifier (p.21). ■ Setting Pattern Registers two speaker setting patterns and switches between them. When you configure the following speaker settings, the settings will be memorized in the selected pattern. - Measurement results (Auto Setup) - Power Amp Assign - Configuration - Distance - Level - Parametric EQ Settings Pattern1 (default), Pattern2 ■ Configuration Configures the output characteristics of the speakers. • When you configure the speaker size, select “Large” if the woofer diameter of your speaker is 16 cm or larger or “Small” if it is smaller than 16 cm. ❑ Front Selects the size of the front speakers. • The setting pattern currently selected is shown at the top of the “Auto Setup” and “Manual Setup” screens. ■ Setting Data Copy Settings Large Select this for large speakers. The front speakers will produce all of the front channel frequency components. Small (default) Select this for small speakers. The subwoofer will produce front channel low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”). Copies the “Setting Pattern” parameters in the specified direction. Choices Pattern1 > 2 Copies the “Pattern1” parameters to “Pattern2”. Pattern2 > 1 Copies the “Pattern2” parameters to “Pattern1”. • “Front” is automatically set to “Large” when “Subwoofer” is set to “None”. En 98 ❑ Center Selects whether or not a center speaker is connected and its size. Settings Large Select this for large speaker. The center speaker will produce all of the center channel frequency components. Small (default) Select this for small speaker. The subwoofer will produce center channel low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”). None Select this when no center speaker is connected. The front speakers will produce center channel audio. • “Surround Back” is automatically set to “None” when “Surround” is set to “None”. ❑ Front Presence Selects whether or not front presence speakers are connected. Settings ❑ Surround Use (default) Select this when front presence speakers are connected. None Select this when no front presence speakers are connected. ❑ Subwoofer Selects whether or not subwoofer is connected and its phase. Selects whether or not surround speakers are connected and its size. Settings Settings Select this for large speakers. The surround speakers will produce all of the surround channel frequency components. Large Select this for small speakers. The subwoofer will produce surround channel low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”). Small (default) Select this when a subwoofer is connected (not to reverse the phase). The subwoofer will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and low-frequency components from other channels. Reverse Select this when a subwoofer is connected (reverse the phase). The subwoofer will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and low-frequency components from other channels. Use None Select this when no surround speakers are connected. The front speakers will produce surround channel audio. Virtual CINEMA DSP works when you select a sound program. None ❑ Surround Back Selects whether or not surround back speakers are connected and its size. Select this when no subwoofer is connected. The front speakers will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and low-frequency components from other channels. • When the bass sound is lacking or unclear, switch the subwoofer phase. ❑ Extra Bass Sets the speakers to produce the front channel low-frequency components. Settings Large x1 Normal (default) Select this when 1 large speaker is connected. The surround back speaker will produce all of the surround back channel frequency components. Large x2 Select this when 2 large speakers are connected. The surround back speakers will produce all of the surround back channel frequency components. Small x1 Select this when 1 small speaker is connected. The subwoofer will produce surround back channel low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”). Small x2 (default) Select this when 2 small speakers are connected. The subwoofer will produce surround back channel low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”). None Select this when no surround back speakers are connected. The surround speakers and subwoofer (or front speakers) will produce surround back channel audio. Settings Off (default) Depending on the size of the front speakers, either the subwoofer or front speakers produce the front channel low-frequency components. On Both the front speakers and subwoofer produce the front channel lowfrequency components. • This setting is not available when “Subwoofer” is set to “None” or “Front” is set to “Small”. En 99 ❑ Bass Cross Over ■ Parametric EQ Sets the lower limit of low-frequency component produced from speakers of which the size is set to “Small”. A frequency sound lower than the specified value will be produced from the subwoofer or front speakers. Adjusts sound quality of tone with an equalizer. Settings 40Hz, 60Hz, 80Hz (default), 90Hz, 100Hz, 110Hz, 120Hz, 160Hz, 200Hz ❑ PEQ Select Selects a type of equalizer to be used. Settings Manual Select this when you want to adjust the equalizer manually. For details, see “Manual equalizer adjustment”. YPAO:Flat Adjusts individual speakers to achieve the same characteristics. ■ Distance YPAO:Front Adjusts individual speakers to achieve the characteristics same as the front speakers. Sets the distance between each speaker and listening position so that sounds from the speakers reach the listening position at the same time. First, select the unit of distance from “Meter” or “Feet”. YPAO:Natural Adjusts all speakers to achieve a natural sound. Through Does not use the equalizer. • If the volume and cross-over frequency are adjustable on your subwoofer, set the volume to half and crossover frequency to maximum. Choices Front L, Front R, Center, Surround L, Surround R, Surround Back L, Surround Back R, Front Presence L, Front Presence R, Subwoofer • “YPAO:Flat”, “YPAO:Front” and “YPAO:Natural” are available only when the measurement results of “Auto Setup” have already been saved (p.41). Setting range 0.30m ~ 24.00m (1.0ft ~ 80.0ft) *0.05m (0.2ft) steps ❑ PEQ Data Copy Default 3.00m (10.0ft) Copies the parametric equalizer values acquired with “Auto Setup” (p.41) to the “Manual” fields for fine adjustment. Choices ■ Level Flat > Manual Copies the “Flat” values acquired with “Auto Setup”. Adjusts the volume of each speaker. Front > Manual Copies the “Front” values acquired with “Auto Setup”. Natural > Manual Copies the “Natural” values acquired with “Auto Setup”. Choices Front L, Front R, Center, Surround L, Surround R, Surround Back L, Surround Back R, Front Presence L, Front Presence R, Subwoofer Setting range -10.0dB ~ +10.0dB (0.5dB steps) Default 0.0dB ■ Manual equalizer adjustment 1 Set “PEQ Select” to “Manual” and press ENTER. 2 Use the cursor keys to select a speaker and press ENTER. 3 Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER. Band / Gain: You can select a center frequency from the preset 7 bands and adjust the gain. Freq. / Gain: You can adjust the center frequency of the selected band and adjust the gain. Q / Gain: You can adjust the Q factor (bandwidth) of the selected band and adjust the gain. Clear: Restores the default settings for the selected speaker. En 100 4 Use the cursor keys to adjust parameters and press ENTER. Setting range Gain: -20.0dB ~ +6.0dB (0.5dB steps) Center frequency: 31.3Hz ~ 16.0kHz Q factor: 0.500 ~ 10.08 5 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Sound Configures the audio output settings. ■ Lipsync Adjusts the delay between video and audio output. ■ Test Tone Enables/disabled the test tone output. Test tone output helps you to adjust the speaker balance or equalizer while confirming its effect. Settings Off (default) Does not output test tones. On Outputs test tones automatically when you adjust the speaker balance, equalizer, etc. ❑ Auto Adjusts the delay between video and audio output automatically when a TV that supports an automatic lipsync function is connected to this unit via HDMI. If necessary, you can fine-adjust the audio output timing. “Offset” shows the difference between automatic adjustment and fine adjustment. Setting range 0ms ~ 250ms (1ms steps) Default 0ms ❑ Manual Adjusts the delay between video and audio output manually. Setting range 0ms ~ 250ms (1ms steps) Default 0ms En 101 ■ Dynamic Range ■ Adaptive DSP Level Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for bitstream audio (Dolby Digital and DTS signals) playback. Selects whether to automatically adjust the CINEMA DSP effect level in conjunction with volume adjustments. Settings Settings Maximum (default) Produces audio without adjusting the dynamic range. Off Does not adjust the effect level automatically. Standard Optimizes the dynamic range for regular home use. On (default) Adjusts the effect level automatically. Minimum/Auto Sets the dynamic range to make clear sound even at night or at low volumes. When playing back Dolby TrueHD signals, the dynamic range is automatically adjusted based on the input signal information. Video Configures the video output settings. ■ Max Volume Sets the maximum volume so that sound is not too loud. Setting range -30.0dB ~ +15.0dB (5.0dB steps), +16.5dB Default +16.5dB ■ Initial Volume Sets the initial volume for when this receiver is turned on. Settings Off (default) Sets at the level when this unit last entered standby mode. On Sets at Mute, or -80.0dB ~ +16.5dB (0.5dB steps). (This setting works only when “Max Volume” is set higher.) ■ Pure Direct Mode ■ Analog to Analog Conversion Enables/disables the video conversion (p.130) between the analog video jacks (COMPONENT VIDEO, S VIDEO and VIDEO). Settings Off Disables the video conversion between the analog video jacks. On (default) Enables the video conversion between the analog video jacks. Converted video signals are output from the MONITOR OUT jacks only. Selects whether to output video signals during the Pure Direct mode (p.55). Settings • This function does not work when “Monitor Out Assign” (p.106) is set to “Zone2”. Auto (default) Automatically outputs video signals when any videos are input from the selected input source or an input source that can be operated with the on-screen display is selected. When no video signals are input, the wall paper is displayed. Video Off Does not output video signals including the wall paper. • This unit does not convert 480-line and 576-line video signals interchangeably. • 480p/576p-, 1080i- and 720p-resolution video signals cannot be output from the S VIDEO and VIDEO jacks (p.130). En 102 ■ Processing HDMI Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio). Configures the settings related to HDMI. Settings Off (default) Disables the video signal processing. On Enables the video signal processing. Select a resolution and an aspect ratio in “Resolution” and “Aspect”. • 720p-, 1080i- and 1080p-resolution video signals cannot be converted (p.130). ❑ Resolution Selects a resolution to output HDMI video signals when “Processing” is set to “On”. ■ HDMI Control Settings Through Does not convert the resolution. Auto (default) Selects a resolution automatically in accordance with TV resolution. 480p/576p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p Output video signals with a selected resolution. (Only the resolutions supported by your TV are selectable.) • If you need to select a resolution that is not supported by your TV, set “MONITOR CHECK” (p.113) in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “SKIP” and try again. (Note that output videos may not be displayed on your TV normally.) ❑ Aspect Selects an aspect ratio to output HDMI video signals when “Processing” is set to “On”. Settings Through (default) Does not convert the aspect ratio. 16:9 Normal Outputs 4:3 video signals to a 16:9 TV with black bands on either side of the screen. Enables/disables HDMI Control (p.131). Settings Off (default) Disables HDMI Control. On Enables HDMI Control. Configure the settings in “TV Audio Input”, “ARC” and “Standby Sync”. • To use HDMI control, you need to perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.131) after connecting HDMI Control-compatible devices. ❑ TV Audio Input Selects an audio input jack of this unit to be used for TV audio input when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”. The input source of this unit automatically switches to TV audio (input jack selected in here) when the TV input is switched to its built-in tuner. Settings AUDIO1~4 Default AUDIO1 • This setting functions only when 480i/576i or 480p/576p signals are converted into 720p, 1080i or 1080p signals. • When using ARC to input TV audio to this unit, you cannot use the input jacks selected in here for connecting an external device because the input will be used for TV audio input. En 103 ❑ ARC ■ Audio Output Enables/disables ARC (p.25) when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”. Selects a device to output audio. Settings Off Disables ARC. On (default) Enables ARC. • The “Amp” and “HDMI OUT1” settings are available only when “HDMI Control” is set to “Off”. ❑ Amp Enables/disables the audio output from the speakers connected to this unit. • You do not need to change this setting normally. In case noises are produced from the speakers connected to this unit because TV audio signals input to this unit via ARC are not supported by this unit, set “ARC” to “Off” and use the TV speaker. ❑ Standby Sync Select whether to set this unit to standby in conjunction with TV power-off when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”. Off Disables the audio output from the speakers. On (default) Enables the audio output from the speakers. ❑ HDMI OUT1, HDMI OUT2 Enables/disables the audio output from a TV connected to the HDMI OUT 1 jack or HDMI OUT 2 jack. Settings Off Does not set this unit to standby mode in conjunction with TV power-off. On Sets this unit to standby mode in conjunction with TV poweroff. Auto (default) Settings Settings Off (default) Disables the audio output from the TV. On Enables the audio output from the TV. Sets this unit to standby mode in conjunction with TV power-off only when this unit is receiving TV audio or HDMI signals. ■ Standby Through Select whether to output videos/audio (input through HDMI jacks) to the TV when this unit is in standby mode. Settings Off (default) Does not output videos/audio to the TV. On Outputs videos/audio to the TV. (This unit consumes approximately 3 W of power.) • This setting is available only when “HDMI Control” is set to “Off”. En 104 Network ■ Network Standby Configures the network settings. Selects whether to turn on this unit by the command from other network devices (network standby). Settings Off (default) Disables the network standby function. On Enables the network standby function. (This unit consumes approximately 5 W of power.) ■ MAC Address Filter Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to this unit from other network devices. ❑ Mode ■ IP Address Configures the network parameters (IP address, etc). Enables/disables the MAC address filter. Settings ❑ DHCP Off (default) Disables the MAC address filter. On Enables the MAC address filter. In “Address Setup”, specify the MAC addresses of the network devices that will be permitted access to this unit. Select whether to use a DHCP server. Settings Off Does not use a DHCP server. Configure the network parameters manually. On (default) Uses a DHCP server to automatically obtain the network parameters (IP address, etc.) of this unit. ❑ Address Setup Specifies the MAC addresses (up to 10) of the network devices that will be permitted access to this unit when “Mode” is set to “On”. ❑ Manual Setup Configures the network parameters of this unit manually when “DHCP” is set to “Off”. Submenu IP Address Specifies an IP address. Subnet Mask Specifies a subnet mask. Default Gateway Specifies the IP address of the default gateway. DNS Server (P) Specifies the IP address of the primary DNS server. DNS Server (S) Specifies the IP address of the secondary DNS server. En 105 ❑ Mono Multi Zone Switches between stereo and monaural for Zone2 output. Configures the multi zone settings. Settings Off (default) Produces stereo sounds in Zone2. On Produces monaural sounds in Zone2. ■ Monitor Out Assign Select the zone for which the MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO, S VIDEO and VIDEO) jacks are used. Settings Main (default), Zone2 ■ Zone2 Set Configures the audio output settings for Zone2. ❑ Volume Enables/disables volume adjustments for Zone2 output. Settings Fixed Disables volume adjustments for Zone2 output. Variable (default) Enables volume adjustments for Zone2 output. • The video conversion between the analog video jacks does not work for Zone2 video output. To watch videos played back on a video device on the Zone2 video monitor, you need to connect the video monitor to this unit in the same way as the video device. ■ Party Mode Set Enables/disables switching to the party mode (p.79). Choice Target: Zone 2 Settings • This setting is available only when Zone2 speakers are connected to this unit via an external amplifier (p.76). ❑ Max Volume Sets the Zone2 maximum volume so that sound is not too loud. Setting range -30.0dB ~ +15.0dB (5.0dB steps), +16.5dB Default +16.5dB Disable Disables switching to the party mode. Enable (default) Enables switching to the party mode. You can turn on/off the party mode by pressing PARTY on the remote control. ■ Zone Scene Rename Changes the scene names (for Zone2) displayed on the front display or TV screen. ■ Setup procedure 1 While “Zone2” is selected, press ENTER. 2 Use the cursor keys to select a scene to be renamed and press ENTER. ❑ Initial Volume Sets the Zone2 initial volume for when this unit is turned on. Settings Off (default) Sets at the level when this unit last entered standby mode. On Sets at Mute, or -80.0dB ~ +16.5dB (0.5dB steps). (This setting works only when “Max Volume” is set higher.) En 106 3 Press ENTER, use the cursor keys to rename, and then press ENTER again. Function Configures the functions that make this unit easier to use. 4 Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. • To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. 5 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. ■ Zone Rename Changes the zone names displayed on the front display or TV screen. ■ Setup procedure 1 Use the cursor keys to select a zone to be renamed and press ENTER. 2 Press ENTER, use the cursor keys to rename, and then press ENTER again. ■ Auto Power Down Sets the amount of time for auto-standby. If you do not operate this unit for the specified time, this unit will automatically go into standby mode. Settings Off Does not set this unit to standby mode automatically. 4 Hours, 8 Hours, 12 Hours Sets this unit to standby mode when you have not operated this unit for the specified time. Default Europe model: 8 Hours Other models: Off 3 Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. • To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. 4 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. En 107 ■ Input Assignment ■ Display Set Assigns the COMPONENT VIDEO, COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks to another input source. Configures the settings related to the front display and TV screen display. ■ Setup procedure ❑ Front Panel Display Example: assigning the OPTICAL (e) jack to the input source “AV2” Configures the front display settings. 1 Use the cursor keys to select the cell at the intersection of “AV2” and “Optical”, and Dimmer press ENTER. Adjusts the brightness of the front display. Setting range -4 ~ 0 (higher to brighten) Default 0 Scroll Sets the scrolling manner of the front display. The display scrolls automatically if the text exceeds 14 characters. 2 Use the cursor keys to select “e” and press ENTER. Settings Continue (default) Sets the display to scroll continuously. Once Sets the display to scroll all characters once and then halt scrolling for display of the first 14 characters. ❑ Short Message Selects whether to display short messages on the TV screen when this unit is operated (input selection, volume adjustment, etc). Settings 3 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. • You cannot assign both COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks to the same input source. On (default) Displays short messages on the TV screen. Off Does not display short messages on the TV screen. ❑ Wall Paper Selects a wall paper displayed on the TV. Settings Picture1, Picture2, Picture3 Displays the selected image on the TV screen when there is no video signal. Gray Displays a gray background on the TV screen when there is no video signal. En 108 ■ Trigger Output1, Trigger Output2 ❑ Target Source Sets the TRIGGER OUT 1~2 jacks to function synchronized with power status of each zone or input switching. Specifies the output level of the electronic signal transmitted with each input switching when “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”. ❑ Trigger Mode Choices AV1~7, V-AUX, AUDIO1~4, PHONO, TUNER, (network sources), USB, DOCK, MULTI CH Specifies the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function. Settings Settings Power (default) The TRIGGER OUT jack functions synchronized with the power status of the zone specified with “Target Zone.” Source The TRIGGER OUT jack functions synchronized with the input switching in the zone specified with “Target Zone.” Electronic signal is transmitted according to the setting made in “Target Source.” Manual Select this to manually switch the output level for electronic signal transmission with “Manual.” ❑ Target Zone Low Stops the electronic signal transmission when you switch to the input source specified in this option. High (default) Transmits the electronic signal when you switch to the input source specified in this option. ❑ Manual Switches the output level for electronic signal transmission manually when “Trigger Mode” is set to “Manual”. This setting can also be used to confirm proper function of the external component connected via the TRIGGER OUT jack. Choices Specifies the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions synchronized. Settings Main When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with power status of the main zone. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with input switching in the main zone. Zone2 When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with power status of Zone2. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with input switching in Zone2. All (default) When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with power status of the main zone or Zone2. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with input switching in the main zone or Zone2. Low Stops the electronic signal transmission. High (default) Transmits the electronic signal. ■ Memory Guard Prevents accidental changes to the settings. Settings Off (default) Does not protect the settings. On Protects the settings until “Off” is selected. En 109 Language Select an on-screen menu language. Viewing information about this unit (Information menu) You can view information about this unit using the TV screen. 1 Press ON SCREEN. 2 Use the cursor keys to select “Information” and press ENTER. Settings English (default) English Japanese Français French Deutsch German Español Spanish Russian 3 Use the cursor keys ( / ) to select an information type. • The information on the front display is provided in English only. 4 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. En 110 ■ Network Types of information Displays the network information on this unit. ■ Audio Signal Displays information about the current audio signal. IP Address IP address Subnet Mask Subnet mask Default Gateway The IP address of the default gateway Format Audio format of the input signal DNS Server (P) The IP address of the primary DNS server DNS Server (S) The IP address of the secondary DNS server Channel The number of source channels in the input signal (front/ surround/LFE) For example, “5.1 (3/2/0.1)” means 5.1ch in total (3 front channels, 2 surround channels, and LFE). MAC Address MAC address Status Network connection status Sampling The number of samples per second of the input digital signal Bitrate The amount of data per second of the input bitstream signal Dialogue The dialogue normalization level of the input bitstream signal Input Output ■ System Displays the system information on this unit. The speaker terminals from which signals are output • Even when this unit is set to output bitstream signals directly, the signal may be converted depending on the specifications and settings of the playback device. ■ Video Signal Remote ID The remote control ID setting of the main unit (p.113) TV Format The video signal type setting of this unit (p.113) Speaker Impedance The speaker impedance setting of this unit (p.112) System ID System ID number Firmware Version The version of firmware installed on this unit Displays information about the current video signal. HDMI Signal Presence or absence of HDMI signal input/output HDMI Resolution Resolutions of input signal (analog or HDMI) and output signal (HDMI) Analog Resolution Resolutions of input signal (analog) and signal output at the MONITOR OUT jacks (analog) HDMI Error Errors related to HDMI HDCP Error: The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection). Device Over: The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack is over the limit. • If this unit detects a newer firmware over the network, “!” (exclamation mark) appears at the upper right of the “Information” and “System” icons, and the corresponding message will be displayed in this screen. You can update the firmware of this unit by pressing ENTER in this screen and following the procedure in “Updating the firmware of this unit” (p.119). ■ Zone Displays information about Zone2. Input The input source selected for Zone2 Volume The volume setting for Zone2 ■ HDMI Monitor Displays information about the TVs connected to the HDMI OUT jacks. Use the cursor keys ( / ) to switch between “OUT1” and “OUT2”. Interface TV interface Video Resolution Resolutions supported by the TV En 111 ADVANCED SETUP menu items Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) You can configure the system settings of this unit using the front display. 1 Set this unit to standby mode. 2 While holding down STRAIGHT on the font panel, press MAIN ZONE MAIN ZONE STRAIGHT . Item Function Page SPEAKER IMP. Changes the speaker impedance setting. 112 REMOTE SENSOR Turns on/off of the remote control sensor on the main unit. 113 REMOTE CON AMP Selects the remote control ID of the main unit. 113 TV FORMAT Switches the video signal type. 113 MONITOR CHECK Removes the limitation on HDMI video output. 113 RECOV./BACKUP Creates backup of the settings of this unit, or recovers the settings from the backup. 114 INITIALIZE Restores the default settings. 114 FIRM UPDATE Updates the firmware. 114 VERSION Checks the version of firmware currently installed on this unit. 114 PROGRAM 3 Press PROGRAM to select an item. 4 Press STRAIGHT to select a setting. MAIN ZONE to set this unit to standby mode and turn it on 5 Press again. The new settings become effective. Changing the speaker impedance setting (SPEAKER IMP.) SPIMP.- DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 SPEAKERIMP. 8MIN MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Change the speaker impedance settings of unit depending on the impedance of the speakers connected. Settings 6 Ω MIN Select this when you connect 6-ohm speakers to this unit. You can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers. 8 Ω MIN (default) Select this when you connect 8-ohm or higher speakers to this unit. En 112 Turning on/off the remote control sensor (REMOTE SENSOR) SPIMP.- DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 REMOTESENSOR ON DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP HD 3 PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Settings ON (default) Turns on the remote control sensor. OFF Turns off the remote control sensor. Selecting the remote control ID (REMOTE CON AMP) SPIMP.HD 3 REMOTECONAMP ID1 TVFORMAT PAL MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC Turn on/off the remote control sensor on the main unit. While the remote control sensor is turned off, you cannot control this unit from the remote control. DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP Switching the video signal type (TV FORMAT) Switch the video signal type of this unit so that it matches to the format of your TV. Settings NTSC, PAL Default Canada model: NTSC Other models: PAL Removing the limitation on HDMI video output (MONITOR CHECK) SPIMP.- MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Select the remote control ID of the main unit so that it matches to the ID of the remote control (default: ID1). When using multiple Yamaha AV receivers, you can set each remote control with a unique remote control ID for its corresponding receiver. Settings ID1 (default), ID2 DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 MONITORCHECK YES MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR This unit automatically detects resolutions supported by a TV connected to the HDMI OUT jacks. If you want to select a resolution in “Resolution” (p.103) regardless of the detection results or if this unit does not detect it correctly, disable the monitor check function. Settings ■ Changing the remote control ID of the remote control YES (default) Enables the monitor check function. (Outputs video signals with a resolution supported by the TV only.) Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be automatically canceled. SKIP Disables the monitor check function. (Outputs video signals with a specified resolution regardless of compatibility with the TV.) 1 Press CODE SET on the remote control using a pointed object such as the tip of a ballpoint pen. 2 Press SOURCE/RECEIVER. 3 Use the numeric keys to enter “5019” (ID1) or “5020” (ID2). • In case this unit becomes inoperable because videos from this unit cannot be displayed on the TV after “MONITOR CHECK” is set to “SKIP”, reset the setting to “YES”. Once the remote control ID is registered successfully, SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice. If it blinks 6 times, registration failed. Repeat from step 1. • The registered remote control codes (p.115) are not cleared even if you change the remote control ID. En 113 Backing up/recovering the settings (RECOV./BACKUP) SPIMP.- DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 RECOV./BACKUP BACKUP MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Updating the firmware (FIRM UPDATE) New firmware will be released irregularly for the purpose of additional features or product improvements. It can be downloaded from our website. If this unit is connected to the Internet, you can download the firmware via the network. For details, refer to the information supplied with updates. Creates backup of the settings of this unit, or recovers the settings from the backup. SPIMP.- DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP ■ Backup/recovery procedure HD 3 1 Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select “BACKUP” or “”RECOVERY” and press INFO FIRMUPDATE USB MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR to start the process. ■ Firmware update procedure Choices Do not perform this procedure unless firmware update is necessary. Also, make sure you read the information supplied with updates before updating the firmware. BACKUP Creates backup of the settings of this unit in the internal memory. RECOVERY Recovers the settings of this unit from the backup (available only when backup has been created). 1 Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select “USB” or “NETWORK” and press INFO to start firmware update. Choices Note • Do not turn off this unit during the recovery process. Otherwise, the settings may not be restored correctly. USB Update the firmware using a USB memory device. NETWORK Update the firmware via the network. • The backup does not contain user information (user account, password, etc.) or unit-specific information (MAC address, IP address, etc). Restoring the default settings (INITIALIZE) SPIMP.- DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 INITIALIZE CANCEL • If this unit detects a newer firmware over the network, the corresponding message will be displayed after ON SCREEN is pressed. In this case, you can also update the firmware of this unit by following the procedure in “Updating the firmware of this unit” (p.119). Checking the firmware version (VERSION) MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Restores the default settings for the selected item. Choices Check the version of firmware currently installed on this unit. SPIMP.- DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD VIDEO Restores the default settings for video configurations. ALL Restores the default settings for this unit. CANCEL Does not perform an initialization. 3 VERSION x.xx MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR • You can also check the firmware version in “System” (p.111) in the “Information” menu. En 114 ZONE 2 MAIN CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER CODE SET SOURCE/RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING Controlling external devices with the remote control By setting the code for external devices (BD/DVD players, etc.), you can operate it with the remote control of this unit. AUDIO TUNER FM INFO • You cannot control an external device that does not have a remote control sensor. • Make sure the remote control ID of the external device is set to “ID1”. If any other ID is selected, the remote control operations may not work properly. AM • If the remote control is without batteries for more than 2 minutes, the registered codes may be cleared. In this case, insert new batteries and setting the codes again. MEMORY SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN • When HDMI control of both this unit and playback device such as a BD/DVD player are enabled, you may be able to control the device with the remote control without registering the remote control code. OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU Setting the remote control code for a TV MUTE MODE By setting the remote control code for your TV, you can operate it with the remote control of this unit. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH Numeric keys HDMI OUT TV operation keys TV • You can also register a remote control code of your TV to the input selection keys (p.116). In this case, you can use the cursor keys or numeric keys to operate the TV depending on its model. However, you need to press the corresponding input selection key to play back TV audio on this unit. CODE SET using a pointed object such as the 2 Press tip of a ballpoint pen. SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice. Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. In this case, repeat from step 2. 3 Press TV the numeric keys to enter the 4-digit remote 4 Use control code. Once the remote control code is set successfully, SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice. If it blinks 6 times, registration failed. Repeat from step 2. ■ TV operations Once you have set the remote control code for your TV, you can control it using the TV operation keys regardless of an input source selected on this unit. • (China and Europe models only) You can also assign a function to each key using the learning function (p.117). “Remote Control Code Search” in the CD-ROM 1 Use to find a remote control code for your TV. TV operation keys INPUT Switches the video inputs of the TV. MUTE Mutes the audio output of the TV. TV VOL Adjust the volume of the TV. TV CH Switch the channels of the TV. TV Turns on/off the TV. • If multiple remote control codes exist, first set the first code in the list, if it does not work then try the other codes. En 115 ZONE 2 MAIN CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER SOURCE CODE SET SOURCE/RECEIVER Setting the remote control codes for playback devices AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX AUDIO 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY 1 2 BD/DVD TV Input selection key Once you have registered the remote control code for your playback device, you can control it using the following keys after selecting the input source or scene. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT • (China and Europe models only) You can also assign a function to each key using the learning function (p.117). SCENE ON SCREEN 3 4 CD RADIO OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY POP-UP MENU TOP MENU Menu operation keys DISPLAY 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 4 8 Numeric keys ENT TV TV operation keys INPUT TV CH device. HDMI OUT • By pressing SOURCE/RECEIVER, you can switch the devices (this unit or external device) to operate with the menu operation keys, DISPLAY and numeric keys. You can operate this unit when SOURCE/RECEIVER lights up in orange, and an external device when SOURCE/RECEIVER lights up in green. For example, if you register the remote control code of your external device on TUNER, you can operate FM/AM radio built in this unit when SOURCE/ RECEIVER lights up in orange, and the external device when SOURCE/ RECEIVER lights up in green. SOURCE External device operation keys 1 “Remote Control Code Search” in the CD-ROM 1 Use to find a remote control code for your playback MUTE MODE MUTE ■ Playback device operations • At the factory, Yamaha CD player code (5095) is set for AUDIO2. For the other input selection keys, no codes are set. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT TV VOL By setting the remote control codes for your playback devices, you can operate those devices with the remote control of this unit. Since the codes are assigned to each input source key, you can select the input source and device to control with the remote control concurrently. • For details on how to register the input selection key applied the remote control code on a corresponding SCENE key, refer to “Configuring scene assignments” (p.50). • If multiple remote control codes exist, first set the first code in the list, if it does not work then try the other codes. CODE SET using a pointed object such as the 2 Press tip of a ballpoint pen. Menu operation keys Once the remote control code is registered successfully, SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice. If it blinks 6 times, registration failed. Repeat from step 2. Confirms a selected item. RETURN Returns to the previous screen. TOP MENU Displays the top menu. POP-UP MENU Displays the pop-up menu. Switches information on the display. Stops playback. Stops playback temporarily. External device operation keys Starts playback of the selected song/ video. Search forward/backward (by holding down). For example, press AV1 to set the remote control code for the playback device connected to the AV1 jack. the numeric keys to enter the 4-digit remote 4 Use control code. Select an item. ENTER DISPLAY SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice. Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. In this case, repeat from step 2. 3 Press a corresponding input selection key. Turns on/off the playback device. Cursor keys Skip forward/backward. Numeric keys Enter numerical values. TV operation keys Control the TV (p.115). • These keys work only when the corresponding function is available on your playback device and is possible to be operated with an infrared remote control. En 116 ZONE 2 MAIN CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER SOURCE CODE SET SOURCE/RECEIVER Programming from other remote controls (learning) AV 1 2 3 7 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING (China and Europe models only) The remote control of this unit can receive remote control signals from other remote controls and learn the remote control operation. If you cannot find a remote control code for your playback device or if any key on the remote control does not work after you set the remote control code, use the learning function to assign a function to each key. V-AUX AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT 1 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE External device operation keys MODE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 TV VOL Numeric keys ENT TV TV operation keys INPUT MUTE Menu operation keys DISPLAY A TV CH HDMI OUT TV Press CODE SET using a pointed object such as the tip of a ballpoint pen. SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice. Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. In this case, repeat from step 1. one of the following keys depending on the 2 Press type of your device. For playback device: press the input selection key (corresponding to the input jacks where the device is connected). For TV: press TV . 3 Use the numeric keys to enter “9990”. the infrared transmitters of the remote controls 4 Aim at each other. 5 Perform the following steps within 10 seconds. a On this unit, press one of the following keys to which you want to assign a function. For playback device: SOURCE external device operation keys , menu operations keys, For TV: TV operation keys b On the external device, press the key from which the operation is learned. Once the operation is learned successfully, SOURCE/ RECEIVER blinks twice. If it blinks 6 times, learning failed. Repeat step 5. step 5 until all desired operations are 6 Repeat learned. CODE SET using a pointed object such as the 7 Press tip of a ballpoint pen. SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks once. Note • If you press SOURCE/RECEIVER in step 2, you can assign functions of an external receiver to the menu operation keys, external device operation keys or numeric keys. However, it makes these keys to control this unit impossible. If you need to restore the remote control code for this unit, perform the following steps. a Press CODE SET using a pointed object such as the tip of a ballpoint pen. b Press SOURCE/RECEIVER. c Use the numeric keys to enter “9992”. Remote control of external device 3 ZONE 2 2 6 MAIN 5 1 1 USB 2 AV 4 CODE SET 3 SOURCE RECEIVER V-AUX 4 7 AUDIO TUNING DOCK PRESET PHONO AM MULTI MEMORY NET FM TUNER INFO 4 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT RADIO SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT 3 PARTY CD MUSIC 2 SLEEP TV MOVIE 1 SCENE BD/DVD 5 to 10 cm apart En 117 ZONE 2 MAIN CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER CODE SET Resetting remote control codes SOURCE/RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX AUDIO 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB PRESET TUNING TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY ■ Resetting all remote control codes Input selection key • The settings for controlling playback devices after selecting a scene (p.50) will be also cleared. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT CODE SET using a pointed object such as the 1 Press tip of a ballpoint pen. SCENE 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO ON SCREEN SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice. Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. In this case, repeat from step 1. OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY A POP-UP MENU TOP MENU MUTE MODE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 Numeric keys ENT TV TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH HDMI OUT You can clear all remote control codes (including functions learned from other remote controls [China and Europe models only]) and restore the default settings. 2 Press SOURCE/RECEIVER. 3 Use the numeric keys to enter “9981”. Once the remote control codes are reset successfully, SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice. If it blinks 6 times, resetting failed. Repeat from step 1. ■ Clearing functions learned from other remote controls (China and Europe models only) ❑ Clearing the assignment of each key CODE SET using a pointed object such as the 1 Press tip of a ballpoint pen. SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice. Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. In this case, repeat from step 1. one of the following keys to select the device 2 Press for which key assignments will be cleared. For playback device: press the input selection key. For TV: press TV . 3 Use the numeric keys to enter “9991”. 4 Press the key that you want to reset. Once the key assignment is cleared successfully, SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice. If it blinks 6 times, clearing failed. Repeat from step 2. step 4 until all desired key assignments are 5 Repeat cleared. CODE SET using a pointed object such as the 6 Press tip of a ballpoint pen. SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks once. ❑ Clearing the key assignments for each input source CODE SET using a pointed object such as the 1 Press tip of a ballpoint pen. SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice. Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. In this case, repeat from step 1. one of the following keys to select the device 2 Press for which key assignments will be cleared. For playback device: press the input selection key. For TV: press TV . 3 Use the numeric keys to enter “9992”. Once the key assignment is cleared successfully, SOURCE/RECEIVER blinks twice. If it blinks 6 times, clearing failed. Repeat from step 1. En 118 ZONE 2 MAIN Updating the firmware of this unit CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 MULTI PHONO DOCK NET USB If this unit is connected to the Internet, the corresponding message will be displayed on the TV when a newer firmware is available. In this case, follow the procedure below to update the firmware of this unit. AUDIO TUNER FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY 1 2 3 4 BD/DVD TV CD RADIO PRESET Note TUNING ENHANCER PURE DIRECT SCENE • You can also update the firmware using the USB memory device from the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu (p.114). OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN POP-UP MENU The firmware update is complete. Cursor keys • If you want to update the firmware later, select “CLOSE” in step 2. In this case, “!” (exclamation mark) appears at the upper right of the “Information” and “System” icons, and the corresponding message will be displayed in the “System” screen (p.111). You can update the firmware of this unit by pressing ENTER in the “System” screen. If the following message is displayed after ON SCREEN is pressed, firmware update is available. ENTER DISPLAY A TOP MENU appears on the front display, press MAIN ZONE on the front panel. • Do not operate this unit or disconnect the power cable or network cable during firmware update. Firmware update takes about 15 minutes. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ON SCREEN 3 If “UPDATE SUCCESS PLEASE POWER OFF!” MUTE Information icon MODE 1 2 3 5 6 7 9 0 10 4 8 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE TV CH HDMI OUT 1 Read the on-screen description. start the firmware update, use the cursor keys to 2 To select “START” and press ENTER. The on-screen display turns off. Message System icon En 119 APPENDIX Frequently asked questions The new speaker system does not provide an ideal sound balance... I want to turn off the onscreen messages displayed during operations... If you have changed speakers or speaker system, use “Auto Setup” to optimize the speaker settings again (p.41). If you want to adjust the speaker settings manually, use “Manual Setup” in the “Setup” menu (p.98). By default, short messages are displayed on the TV screen when this unit is operated (input selection, volume adjustment, etc). In case that the short messages bother you when you are watching movies or sports, configure “Short Message” (p.108) in the “Setup” menu to turn off the short messages. Since we have small children, we want to set limitations on the volume control... If a small child, etc. accidentally operates the controls on the main unit or remote control, the volume may suddenly increase. And this may cause injury or damage this unit or speakers. We recommend using “Max Volume” in the “Setup” menu to set the maximum volume level for this unit in advance (p.102). You can also set the maximum volume for Zone2 (p.106). I am occasionally startled by a sudden large sound when turning on this unit... By default, the volume level when this unit last entered standby mode is automatically applied. If you want to fix the volume, use “Initial Volume” to set the volume to be applied when this receiver is turned on (p.102). You can also set the initial volume for Zone2 (p.106). I made HDMI connections but HDMI Control does not work at all... To use HDMI Control, you need to perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.131). After connecting HDMI Control-compatible devices (TV, BD/DVD players, etc.) to this unit, enable HDMI Control on each device and perform the HDMI Control link setup. This setup is required every time when you add a new HDMI Control-compatible device to your system. For information on how HDMI Control works between your TV and playback devices, refer to the instruction manuals of each device. I want to prevent accidental changes to the settings... You can protect the settings configured on this unit (speaker settings, etc.) by utilizing “Memory Guard” in the “Setup” menu (p.109). The web control screen (p.81) becomes inaccessible... If you are using a DHCP server, the IP address of this unit may change each time this unit is turned on. Check the IP address of this unit in “Network” (p.111) in the “Information” menu. Also, if you have enabled “MAC Address Filter” (p.105), you need to specify the MAC address of your PC in “Address Setup” (p.105) to allow the PC to access this unit. For information on how to check the MAC address of your PC, refer to the instruction manuals of it. The supplied remote control concurrently controls this unit and another Yamaha product that is not intended... When using multiple Yamaha products, the supplied remote control may work on another Yamaha product or another remote control may work on this unit. In this case, set each remote control with a unique remote control ID for its corresponding receiver (p.113). En 120 Troubleshooting Refer to the table below when this unit does not function properly. If the problem you are experiencing is not listed below, or if the instructions below do not help, turn off this unit, disconnect the power cable, and contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center. First, check the followings: a The power cables of this unit, TV and playback devices (BD/DVD player, etc.) are connected to AC outlets securely. b This unit, subwoofer, TV and playback devices (BD/DVD player, etc.) are turned on. c The connectors of each cable are inserted to jacks on each devices securely. Power and system Problem Cause Remedy The power does not turn on. The protection circuitry has been activated 3 times consecutively. As a safety precaution, capability to turn on the power is disabled. Contact your nearest Yamaha dealer or service center to request repair. The power does not turn off. The internal microcomputer is hung-up due to an external electric shock (such as lightning and excessive static electricity) or by a drop in power supply voltage. Hold down MAIN ZONE and reboot this unit. The power turns off (standby mode) immediately. This unit was turned on while a speaker cable was shorted. Twist the bare wires of each speaker cable firmly and reconnect to this unit and speakers (p.18). The unit enters standby mode automatically. This unit is uncontrollable. on the front panel for more than 10 seconds to initialize The sleep timer worked. Turn on the unit and start playback again. Since this unit was not operated for the specified time, autostandby worked. To disable auto-standby, set “Auto Power Down” in the “Setup” menu to “Off” (p.107). The speaker impedance setting is incorrect. Set the speaker impedance to match your speakers (p.112). The protection circuitry has been activated because of a short circuit. Twist the bare wires of each speaker cable firmly and reconnect to this unit and speakers (p.18). The internal microcomputer is hung-up due to an external electric shock (such as lightning and excessive static electricity) or by a drop in power supply voltage. Hold down MAIN ZONE and reboot this unit. on the front panel for more than 10 seconds to initialize En 121 Audio Problem No sound. The volume cannot be increased. No sound is heard from a specific speaker. No sound is heard from the surround back speaker. No sound is heard from the subwoofer. No sound from the playback device (connected to this unit with HDMI). No sound from the TV (when HDMI Control is used). Cause Remedy Another input source is selected. Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys Signals that this unit cannot reproduce are being input. Some digital audio formats cannot be played back on this unit. To check the audio format of the input signal, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.111). The cable connecting this unit and playback device is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable. The maximum volume is set. Use “Max Volume” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the maximum volume (p.102). Any device connected to the output jacks of this unit is not turned on. (This may happen due to the nature of AV receivers.) Turn on all devices connected to the output jacks of this unit The playback source does not contain corresponding channel signals. To check it, select “7ch Stereo” (p.51). The sound program/decoder currently selected does not use the corresponding speaker. To check it, select “7ch Stereo” (p.51). Audio output of the corresponding speaker is disabled. Perform “Auto Setup” (p.41) or use “Configuration” in the “Setup” menu to change the speaker setting (p.98). The volume of the corresponding speaker is too low. Perform “Auto Setup” (p.41) or use “Level” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the speaker volume (p.100). The speaker cable connecting this unit and corresponding speaker is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another speaker cable. The corresponding speaker is malfunctioning. To check it, replacing with another speaker. If the problem persists, this unit may be malfunctioning. The extended surround is disabled. Use “Extended Surround” in the “Option” menu to select a decoder to be used (p.86). The playback source does not contain LFE or low-frequency signals. To check it, set “Extra Bass” in the “Setup” menu to “On”, to output the front channel low-frequency components from the subwoofer (p.99). Subwoofer output is disabled. Perform “Auto Setup” (p.41) or set “Subwoofer” in the “Setup” menu to “Use” (p.99). The subwoofer is turned off by the auto-standby function on it. Disable the auto-standby function of the subwoofer or adjust its sensitivity level. The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection). To check it, use “Video Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.111). This unit is set not to output audio input through HDMI jacks from the SPEAKERS terminals. In “Audio Output” in the “Setup” menu, set “Amp” to “On” (p.104). The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack is over the limit. Disconnect some of the HDMI devices. (If the TV is connected to this unit with an audio cable) The TV audio input setting does not match the actual connection. Use “TV Audio Input” in the “Setup” menu to select the correct audio input jack (p.103). (If you are trying to use ARC) ARC is disabled on this unit or TV. Set “ARC” in the “Setup” menu to “On” (p.104). Also, enable ARC on the TV. En 122 Problem Only the front speakers work on multichannel audio. Noise/hum is heard. The sound is distorted. Cause The playback device is set to output 2-channel audio (PCM, etc.) only. Remedy Change the digital audio output setting on the playback device. This unit is too close to other digital or radio frequency device. Move this unit further away from such device. The cable connecting this unit and playback device is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable. Any device connected to the output jacks of this unit is not turned on. (This may happen due to the nature of AV receivers.) Turn on all devices connected to the output jacks of this unit Video Problem Cause Another input source is selected on this unit. No video. No video from the playback device (connected to this unit with HDMI). Remedy Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys Another input source is selected on the TV. Switch the TV input to display the video from this unit. The video signal output from this unit is not supported by the TV. Set “MONITOR CHECK” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “YES” (p.113). The cable connecting this unit and TV (or playback device) is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable. The input video signal (resolution) is not supported by this unit. To check the information about the current video signal (resolution), use “Video Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.111). For information about video signals supported by this unit, see “HDMI signal compatibility” (p.132). The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection). To check it, use “Video Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.111). The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack is over the limit. Disconnect some of the HDMI devices. En 123 FM/AM radio Problem Cause There is multi-path interference. FM radio reception is weak or noisy. AM radio reception is weak or noisy. Remedy Adjust the FM antenna height or orientation, or place it in a different location. Press MODE to select “Mono” (monaural reception) (p.56). Your area is too far from the FM station transmitter. Use an outdoor FM antenna commercially available. We recommend using a sensitive multi-element antenna. The noises may be caused by fluorescent lamps, motors, thermostats, or other electrical equipment. It is difficult to completely eliminate noise. It may be reduced by using an outdoor AM antenna commercially available. Select the station manually (p.56). Your area is too far from the FM station transmitter. Radio stations cannot be selected automatically. Use an outdoor antenna commercially available. We recommend using a sensitive multi-element antenna. Adjust the AM antenna orientation. Select the station manually (p.56). The AM radio signal is weak. Use an outdoor AM antenna commercially available. Connect it to the ANTENNA (AM) jack together with the supplied AM antenna. AM radio stations cannot be registered as presets. “Auto Preset” has been used. “Auto Preset” is for registering FM radio stations only. Register AM radio stations manually (p.56). USB and network Problem Cause Remedy This unit does not detect the USB device. The USB cable connecting this unit and USB device is not compliant with USB 2.0. Use a USB cable compliant with USB 2.0. Folders and files in the USB device cannot be viewed. The folder structure not supported by this unit is applied. This unit supports folder hierarchies of up to 8 levels and up to 500 items (total of files and subfolders) per folder. If necessary, modify the folder structure on your USB device. The network feature does not function. The network parameters (IP address) is not obtained properly. Enable the DHCP server function on your router and set “DHCP” in the “Setup” menu to “On” on this unit (p.105). If you want to configure the network parameters manually, make sure using an IP address which is not used by other network devices in your network (p.105). The media sharing setting is not correct. Configure the sharing setting and select this unit as a device to which music contents are shared (p.70). Some security software installed on your PC is blocking the access of this unit to your PC. Check the settings of security software installed on your PC. This unit and PC are not in the same network. Check the network connections and the settings of your router to connect them to the same network. This unit does not detect the PC. En 124 Problem The files in the PC cannot be viewed or played back. The Internet radio cannot be played. Cause Remedy The files are not supported by this unit or the media server. Use the file format supported by both this unit and the media server. For information about the file formats supported by this unit, see “Playing back music stored on PCs” (p.70). The selected Internet radio station is currently not available. It may not be available to listen because there might be a network problem, or the station might be broadcasting in limited hour. Try the station later or select another station. The selected Internet radio station broadcasts audio silence currently. Some Internet radio stations broadcast audio silence during particular periods of time in a day. Try the station later or select another station. Access to the network is restricted by the firewall settings of your network devices (router, etc). Check the firewall settings of your network devices. The Internet radio can be played only when it passes through the port designated by each radio station. The port number is variable depending on radio station. Remote control Problem This unit cannot be controlled using the remote control. External devices cannot be controlled using the remote control. The remote control does not learn new functions. (China and Europe models only) Cause Remedy Out of the operating range. Use the remote control in the operating range (p.5). The batteries are weak. Replace with new batteries. Direct sunlight or lighting is striking the remote control sensor of this unit. Adjust the lighting angle, or reposition this unit. The remote control is set to control external devices. Press SOURCE/RECEIVER to set the remote control to control this unit (the key lights up in orange). The remote control IDs of the main unit and remote control are not identical. Change the remote control ID of the main unit or remote control (p.113). The remote control is set to control this unit. Press SOURCE/RECEIVER to set the remote control to control external devices (the key lights up in green). The corresponding remote control code is not set properly. Set the remote control code again (p.115). Even if the remote control code is registered properly set, some products may not respond to the remote control. The batteries of the remote control of this unit and/or the external device are weak. Replace with new batteries. The distance between the two remote controls is not appropriate. Place the remote controls at a proper distance (p.117). The signal coding or modulation of the other remote control is not compatible with this remote control. Learning is impossible in this case. Memory capacity is full. Clear unnecessary assignments to free some memory space for the new functions (p.118). En 125 Error indications on the front display Message (alphabetical order) Access denied Access error Cause Remedy Access to the PC is denied. Configure the sharing setting and select this unit as a device to which music contents are shared (p.70). This unit cannot access the USB device. Turn off this unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device. This unit cannot access the iPod connected to the USB jack. Turn off the iPod and turn on it again. Make sure your router and modem are turned on. There is a problem with the signal path from the network to this unit. Check the connection between this unit and your router (or hub) (p.36). No device This unit cannot detect the USB device. This unit cannot detect the iPod connected to the USB jack. Turn off this unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device. Turn off the iPod and turn on it again. (When pairing) Turn on the Bluetooth component and set it in pairing mode. Not found The Bluetooth component is not found. (When establishing a wireless connection) - Turn on the Bluetooth component. - Place the Bluetooth component within 10 m of the Bluetooth receiver. - Perform pairing again. Unknown iPod The connected iPod is not supported by the unit. Use an iPod supported by this unit (p.60). The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the iPod for some reasons. Check the song data. If it cannot be played on the iPod itself, the song data or storage area may be defective. The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the PC for some reasons. Check if the format of files you are trying to play is supported by this unit. For information about the formats supported by this unit, see “Playing back music stored on PCs” (p.70). If this unit cannot play back any files, the network may be overloaded with heavy traffic, and playback is interrupted. Over current passes through the USB device. Turn off this unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device. Unable to play USB Overloaded En 126 Glossary Audio information Audio and video synchronization (Lipsync) Lip sync, an abbreviation for lip synchronization, is a technical term that involves both a problem, and the capability of maintaining audio and video signals synchronized during post-production and transmission. Whereas the audio and video latency requires complex end-user adjustment, HDMI version 1.3 incorporates an automatic audio and video syncing capability that allows devices to perform this synchronization automatically and accurately without user interaction. Bi-amplification connection (Bi-amp) A bi-amplification connection uses two amplifiers for a speaker. One amplifier is connected to the woofer section of a loudspeaker while the other is connected to the combined mid and tweeter section. With this arrangement each amplifier operates over a restricted frequency range. This restricted range presents each amplifier with a much simpler job and each amplifier is less likely to influence the sound in some way. CINEMA DSP Since the Dolby Surround and DTS systems were originally designed for use in movie theaters, their effect is best felt in a theater having many speakers designed for acoustic effects. Since home conditions, such as room size, wall material, number of speakers, and so on, can differ so widely, it is inevitable that there are differences in the sound that is heard. Based on a wealth of actually measured data, Yamaha CINEMA DSP uses Yamaha’s original DSP technology to combine Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby Digital, and DTS systems to provide the audiovisual experience of a movie theater in the listening room of your own home. CINEMA DSP 3D The actually measured sound field data contain the information of the height of the sound images. CINEMA DSP 3D feature achieves the reproduction of the accurate height of the sound images so that it creates the accurate and intensive stereoscopic sound fields in a listening room. Dolby Digital Plus Dolby Digital Plus is an advanced audio technology developed for highdefinition programming and BD (Blu-ray disc). Selected as an optional audio standard for BD, this technology delivers multichannel sound with discrete channel output. Supporting bitrates up to 6.0 Mbps, Dolby Digital Plus can carry up to 7.1 discreet audio channels simultaneously. Supported by HDMI version 1.3 and designed for the optical disc players and AV receivers/amplifiers of the future, Dolby Digital Plus also remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that incorporate Dolby Digital. Dolby Pro Logic II Dolby Pro Logic II is an improved technique used to decode vast numbers of existing Dolby Surround sources. This new technology enables a discrete 5-channel playback with 2 front left and right channels, 1 center channel, and 2 surround left and right channels, instead of only 1 surround channel for conventional Pro Logic technology. There are three modes available: “Music mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources, and “Game mode” for game sources. Dolby Pro Logic IIx Dolby Pro Logic IIx is a new technology enabling discrete multichannel playback from 2-channel or multi-channel sources. There are three modes available: “Music mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources (for 2channel sources only) and “Game mode” for game sources. Dolby Surround Dolby Surround uses a 4-channel analog recording system to reproduce realistic and dynamic sound effects: 2 front left and right channels (stereo), a center channel for dialog (monaural), and a surround channel for special sound effects (monaural). The surround channel reproduces sound within a narrow frequency range. Dolby Surround is widely used with nearly all video tapes and laser discs, as well as in many TV and cable broadcasts. The Dolby Pro Logic decoder built into this unit employs a digital signal processing system that automatically stabilizes the volume on each channel to enhance moving sound effects and directionality. Dolby TrueHD The Compressed Music Enhancer feature of this unit enhances your listening experience by regenerating the missing harmonics in compression artifacts. As a result, it compensates for flattened complexity due to the loss of highfrequency fidelity as well as lack of bass due to the loss of low-frequency bass, providing improved performance for the overall sound system. Dolby TrueHD is an advanced lossless audio technology developed for high-definition disc-based media including Bluray Disc. Selected as an optional audio standard for BD (Blu-ray disc), this technology delivers sound that is bit-for-bit identical to the studio master, offering a high-definition home theater experience. Supporting bitrates up to 18.0 Mbps, Dolby TrueHD can carry up to 8 discrete channels of 24-bit/96 kHz audio simultaneously. Dolby TrueHD also remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems and retains the metadata capability of Dolby Digital, allowing dialog normalization and dynamic range control. Dolby Digital DTS 96/24 Dolby Digital is a digital surround sound system that gives you completely independent multi-channel audio. With 3 front channels (front L/R and center), and 2 surround stereo channels, Dolby Digital provides 5 full-range audio channels. With an additional channel especially for bass effects, referred to as LFE (Low-Frequency Effect), the system has a total of 5.1-channels (LFE is counted as 0.1 channel). By using 2-channel stereo for the surround speakers, more accurate moving sound effects and surround sound environments are possible than with Dolby Surround. The wide dynamic range from maximum to minimum volumes that are reproduced by the 5 full-range channels, and the precise sound orientation generated using digital sound processing provides listeners with unprecedented excitement and realism. With this unit, any sound environment from monaural up to a 5.1-channel configuration can be freely selected for your enjoyment. DTS 96/24 offers an unprecedented level of audio quality for multichannel sound on DVD video, and is fully backwardcompatible with all DTS decoders. “96” refers to a 96 kHz sampling rate compared to the typical 48 kHz sampling rate. “24” refers to 24-bit word length. DTS 96/24 offers sound quality transparent to the original 96/24 master, and 96/24 5.1channel sound with full-quality full-motion video for music programs and motion picture soundtracks on DVD video. Compressed Music Enhancer En 127 DTS Digital Surround MP3 DTS Digital Surround was developed to replace the analog soundtracks of movies with a 5.1-channel digital sound track, and is now rapidly gaining popularity in movie theaters around the world. DTS, Inc. has developed a home theater system so that you can enjoy the depth of sound and natural spatial representation of DTS Digital Surround in your home. This system produces practically distortion-free 5.1-channel sound (technically, left, right and center channels, 2 surround channels, plus an LFE 0.1 channel as a subwoofer, for a total of 5.1-channels). This unit incorporates a DTS-ES decoder that enables 6.1-channel reproduction by adding the surround back channel to the existing 5.1-channel format. One of the audio compression methods used by MPEG. It employs the irreversible compression method, which achieves a high compression rate by thinning out the data of hardly audible part to the human ears. It is said to be capable of compressing the data quantity by about 1/11 (128 kbps) while maintaining a similar audio quality to music CD. DTS Express This is an audio format for next-generation optical discs such as BD (Blu-ray disc). It uses optimized low bit rate signals for network streaming. In the case of a BD, this format is used with secondary audio, enabling you to enjoy the commentary of the movie producer via the Internet while playing the main program. DTS-HD High Resolution Audio DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is a high resolution audio technology developed for high-definition disc-based media including BD (Blu-ray disc). Selected as an optional audio standard for BD, this technology delivers sound that is virtually indistinguishable from the original, offering a high-definition home theater experience. Supporting bitrates up to 6.0 Mbps for BD, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio can carry up to 7.1 discrete channels of 24bit/96 kHz audio simultaneously. DTS-HD High Resolution Audio also remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that incorporate DTS Digital Surround. MPEG-4 AAC An MPEG-4 audio standard. As it allows compression of data at a bit rate lower than that of MPEG-2 AAC, it is used among others for mobile telephones, portable audio players and other low-capacity devices requiring high sound quality. In addition to the above types of devices, MPEG-4 AAC is also used to distribute contents on the Internet, and as such is supported by computers, media servers and many other devices. Neo:6 Neo:6 decodes the conventional 2-channel sources for 6-channel playback by the specific decoder. It enables playback with the full-range channels with higher separation just like digital discrete signal playback. There are two modes available: “Music mode” for music sources and “Cinema mode” for movie sources. PCM (Linear PCM) Linear PCM is a signal format under which an analog audio signal is digitized, recorded and transmitted without using any compression. This is used as a method of recording CDs and DVD audio. The PCM system uses a technique for sampling the size of the analog signal per very small unit of time. Standing for “Pulse Code Modulation,” the analog signal is encoded as pulses and then modulated for recording. DTS-HD Master Audio DTS-HD Master Audio is an advanced lossless audio technology developed for high-definition disc-based media including BD (Blu-ray disc). Selected as an optional audio standard for BD, this technology delivers sound that is bit-forbit identical to the studio master, offering a high-definition home theater experience. Supporting bitrates up to 24.5 Mbps for BD, DTS-HD Master Audio can carry up to 7.1 discrete channels of 24-bit/96 kHz audio simultaneously. Supported by HDMI version 1.3 and designed for the optical disc players and AV receivers/ amplifiers of the future, DTS-HD Master Audio also remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that incorporate DTS Digital Surround. Sampling frequency and number of quantized bits When digitizing an analog audio signal, the number of times the signal is sampled per second is called the sampling frequency, while the degree of accuracy when converting the sound level into a numeric value is called the number of quantized bits. The range of rates that can be played back is determined based on the sampling rate, whereas the dynamic range representing the sound level difference is determined by the number of quantized bits. In principle, the higher the sampling frequency, the wider the range of frequencies that can be played back, and the higher the number of quantized bits, the more accurately the sound level can be reproduced. DSD SILENT CINEMA Direct Stream Digital (DSD) technology stores audio signals on digital storage media, such as Super Audio CDs. Using DSD, signals are stored as single bit values at a high-frequency sampling rate of 2.8224 MHz, while noise shaping and oversampling are used to reduce distortion, a common occurrence with very high quantization of audio signals. Due to the high sampling rate, better audio quality can be achieved than that offered by the PCM format used for normal audio CDs. The frequency is equal to or higher than 100 kHz, with a dynamic range of 120 dB. This unit can transmit or receive DSD signals via the HDMI jack. Yamaha has developed a natural, realistic sound effect DSP algorithm for headphones. Parameters for headphones have been set for each sound program, so that accurate representations of all the sound programs can be enjoyed on headphones. FLAC This is a file format for lossless audio data compression. FLAC is inferior to lossy compression formats in compression rate but provides higher audio quality. LFE 0.1 channel This channel reproduces low-frequency bass signals, and has a frequency range from 20 Hz to 120 Hz. This channel is counted as 0.1, because it only enforces a low-frequency range compared to the full-range reproduced by the other 5channels in Dolby Digital or DTS 5.1-channel systems. Virtual CINEMA DSP Yamaha has developed a Virtual CINEMA DSP algorithm that allows you to enjoy DSP surround effects even without any surround speakers, by using virtual surround speakers. It is even possible to enjoy Virtual CINEMA DSP using a minimal two-speaker system that does not include a center speaker. WAV Windows standard audio file format, which defines the method of recording the digital data obtained by converting audio signals. It does not specify the compression (coding) method so a desired compression method can be used with it. By default, it is compatible with the PCM method (no compression) and some compression methods including the ADPCM method. WMA An audio compression method developed by Microsoft Corporation. It employs the irreversible compression method, which achieves a high compression rate by thinning out the data of hardly audible part to the human ears. It is said to be capable of compressing the data quantity by about 1/22 (64 kbps) while maintaining a similar audio quality to music CD. En 128 Video information Component video signal With the component video signal system, the video signal is separated into the Y signal for luminance and the Pb and Pr signals for chrominance. Color can be reproduced more faithfully with this system because each of these signals is independent. The component signal is also called the “color difference signal” because the luminance signal is subtracted from the color signal. A monitor with component input jacks is required in order to output component signals. Composite video signal With the composite video signal system, the video signal comprises the three basic elements of a video picture: color, brightness and synchronization data. A composite video jack on a video component transmits these three elements combined. Deep Color Deep Color refers to the use of various color depths in displays, up from the 24-bit depths in previous versions of the HDMI specification. This extra bit depth allows HDTVs and other displays increase from millions of colors to billions of colors and eliminate on-screen color banding for smooth tonal transitions and subtle gradations between colors. The increased contrast ratio can represent many times more shades of gray between black and white. Additionally, Deep Color increases the number of available colors within the boundaries defined by the RGB or YCbCr color space. HDMI HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) is the first industry supported, uncompressed, all-digital audio/video interface. Providing an interface between any sources (such as set-top boxes or AV receivers) and audio/video monitors (such as digital televisions), HDMI supports standard, enhanced or high-definition video as well as multichannel digital audio using a single cable. HDMI transmits all ATSC HDTV standards and supports 8-channel digital audio, with bandwidth to spare to accommodate future enhancements and requirements. When used in combination with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection), HDMI provides a secure audio/ video interface that meets the security requirements of content providers and system operators. For further information on HDMI, visit the HDMI website at “http://www.hdmi.org/.” S-video signal With the S-video signal system, the video signal normally transmitted using a pin cable is separated and transmitted as the Y signal for the luminance and the C signal for the chrominance through the S-video cable. Using the S VIDEO jack eliminates video signal transmission loss and allows recording and playback of even more beautiful images. “x.v.Color” A color space standard supported by HDMI version 1.3. It is a more extensive color space than sRGB, and allows the expression of colors that were not hitherto possible. While remaining compatible with the color gamut of sRGB standards, “x.v.Color” expands the color space, and can thus produce more vivid, natural images. It is particularly effective for still pictures and computer graphics. En 129 ■ Video conversion table Video signal flow Video signals input from a video device to this unit are output to a TV as shown below. (solid line) is always available. (dotted line) is available only when “Analog to Analog Conversion” (p.102) in the “Setup” menu is set to “On” (default). • You can select a resolution and an aspect ratio applied to HDMI-output video processing. • This unit does not convert 480-line and 576-line video signals interchangeably. HDMI out Video device This unit COMPONENT VIDEO out TV Resolution 480i/ 576i 480p/ 576p 720p 1080i 1080p 480i/ 576i 480p/ 576p 720p 1080i S VIDEO out VIDEO out 480i/ 576i 480i/ 576i 480i/576i 480p/576p HDMI in HDMI HDMI out HDMI HDMI HDMI HDMI in 720p 1080i 1080p COMPONENT VIDEO in COMPONENT VIDEO COMPONENT VIDEO 480i/576i COMPONENT VIDEO out COMPONENT VIDEO COMPONENT VIDEO PR PR PR PR PB PB PB PB Y Y Y Y S VIDEO in S VIDEO S VIDEO VIDEO in VIDEO VIDEO COMPONENT VIDEO in 720p 1080i S VIDEO out S VIDEO 480p/576p S VIDEO S VIDEO in 480i/576i VIDEO in 480i/576i VIDEO out VIDEO VIDEO En 130 To use HDMI Control, you need to perform the following HDMI Control link setup after connecting the TV and playback devices. Information on HDMI HDMI Control • This setup is required every time when you add a new HDMI Control-compatible device to your system. HDMI Control allows you to operate external devices via HDMI. If you connect a TV that supports HDMI Control to this unit with an HDMI cable, you can control this unit (power, volume, etc.) in conjunction with TV remote control operations. You can also control playback devices (HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD players, etc.) connected to this unit with an HDMI cable. For details on connections, see “Connecting a TV” (p.25) and “Connecting video devices (BD/DVD players, etc.)” (p.31). Operations available from the TV’s remote control - Standby synchronization - Volume control including mute - Switching to input audio from the TV when the TV input is switched to its built-in tuner - Switching to input video/audio from the selected playback device and output the video to the TV - Switching between audio output devices (this unit or TV speaker) (Example) HDMI Control HDMI Control This unit turns off (standby) Playback device also turns off Turn off the TV Operations available from this unit’s remote control - Starting playback on the playback device and turning on the TV in conjunction with a scene selection (p.49) - Switching the TV input to display the on-screen menu (when ON SCREEN is pressed) - Controlling the playback device (playback and menu operations) without registering remote control codes (p.115) • To use HDMI Control, connect the TV to the HDMI OUT 1 jack. 1 Turn on this unit, TV and playback devices. HDMI Control on this unit, TV and playback devices (HDMI 2 Enable Control-compatible BD/DVD players, etc). To enable HDMI Control on this unit, set “HDMI Control” (p.103) in the “Setup” menu to “On” and configure the related items (“TV Audio Input”, “ARC” and “Standby Sync”). off the main power of the TV and then turn off this unit and 3 Turn playback devices. on this unit and playback devices and then turn on the main 4 Turn power of the TV. 5 Switch the TV input to display the video from this unit. 6 Check the followings. On this unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected. If not, select the input source manually. On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed. that this unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning 7 Check off the TV or adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control. (Example) HDMI Control HDMI Control • If HDMI Control does not work properly, try unplugging the TV in step 2 and re-plugging the TV in step 3. It may solve the problem. Also, HDMI Control may not work if the number of connected devices is over the limit. In this case, disable HDMI Control on the devices not in use. • If the unit is not synchronized to the TV's power operations, check the priority of the audio output setting on the TV. Turns on and displays video from the playback device Playback starts • We recommend using TV and playback devices from the same manufacturer so that HDMI Control works more effectively. Press SCENE (BD/DVD) En 131 HDMI signal compatibility Audio signals Audio signal type Audio signal format Compatible media (example) 2ch Linear PCM 2ch, 32 to 192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit CD, DVD-Video, DVD-Audio Multi-channel Linear PCM 8ch, 32 to 192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit DVD-Audio, BD (Blu-ray disc), HD DVD DSD 2/5.1ch, 2.8224 MHz, 1 bit SACD Bitstream Dolby Digital, DTS DVD-Video Bitstream (High definition audio) Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus, DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio, DTS Express BD (Blu-ray disc), HD DVD Video signals This unit is compatible with the video signals of the following resolutions: - 480i/60 Hz - 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz - 576i/50 Hz - 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz - 480p/60 Hz - 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 24 Hz - 576p/50 Hz • When CPPM copy-protected DVD-Audio is played back, video/audio signals may not be output, depending on the type of the DVD player. • This unit is not compatible with HDCP-incompatible HDMI or DVI devices. For details, refer to the instruction manual of each device. • To decode audio bitstream signals on this unit, set the input source device appropriately so that the device outputs the bitstream audio signals directly (does not decode the bitstream signals on the playback device). For details, refer to the instruction manual of the playback device. • This unit is not compatible with the audio commentary features (for example, the special audio contents downloaded via Internet) of BD or HD DVD. This unit does not playback the audio commentaries of the BD or HD DVD content. En 132 Reference diagram (rear panel) DOCK NETWORK HDMI HDMI OUT 1 2 AV 1 ARC AV 1 (1 BD/DVD) AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT AV OUT AV 2 AV 3 RS-232C AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV 7 (1 BD/DVD) Y PB COMPONENT VIDEO PR Y AV 3 PB C TRIGGER OUT PR AV 1 A PHONO Y GND MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT PR PB 1 REMOTE IN OUT AV 2 2 B D AV 4 AUDIO 1 (2 TV) L AUDIO 2 (3 CD) AUDIO 3 AUDIO 4 MULTI CH INPUT +12V 0.1A MAX. PRE OUT ZONE OUT CENTER (SINGLE) 1 R 2 1 COAXIAL 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL 5 OPTICAL 6 COAXIAL FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER ZONE 2 FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER CENTER SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R SURROUND BACK L CENTER R FRONT L ZONE 2/F.PRESENCE/ R BI–AMP EXTRA SP L AC IN ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AM FM 75Ω SINGLE • The area around the video/audio output jacks is marked in white on the actual product. En 133 Trademarks Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby, Pro Logic and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories. “HDMI,” the “HDMI” logo and “High-Definition Multimedia Interface” are trademarks, or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC. x.v.Color™ “x.v.Color” is a trademark of Sony Corporation. Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent #’s: 5,451,942; 5,956,674; 5,974,380; 5,978,762; 6,226,616; 6,487,535; 7,212,872; 7,333,929; 7,392,195; 7,272,567 & other U.S. and worldwide patents issued & pending. DTS and the Symbol are registered trademarks, & DTS-HD, DTS-HD Master Audio, and the DTS logos are trademarks of DTS, Inc. Product includes software. © DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved. iPod™, iPhone™ “SILENT CINEMA” is a trademark of Yamaha Corporation. DLNA Certified is a trademark of the Digital Living Network Alliance in the United States and other countries. “Made for iPod” and “Made for iPhone” mean that an electronic accessory has been designed to connect specifically to iPod or iPhone, respectively, and has been certified by the developer to meet Apple performance standards. Apple is not responsible for the operation of this device or its compliance with safety and regulatory standards. Please note that the use of this accessory with iPod or iPhone may affect wireless performance. iPhone, iPod, iPod classic, iPod nano, and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. Windows is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and other countries. Windows XP, Windows Vista, Windows 7, Windows Media Audio, Windows Media Connect and Windows Media Player are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft corporation in the United States and/or other countries. MPEG Layer-3 audio coding technology licensed from Fraunhofer IIS and Thomson. This receiver supports network connections. Bluetooth™ Bluetooth is a registered trademark of the Bluetooth SIG and is used by Yamaha in accordance with a license agreement. En 134 Specifications ❑ Input jacks • Analog Audio Audio x 10 (AV1~4, AUDIO1~4, PHONO, V-AUX) MULTI CH INPUT (8ch) x 1 (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R, SUBWOOFER) • Video MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT - Composite x 1 - S-video x 1 - Component x 1 AV OUT - Composite x 1 • Digital Audio (Support fs: 32 kHz to 96 kHz) - S-video x 1 Optical x 4 (AV3~4, AUDIO1, V-AUX) Coaxial x 3 (AV1~2, AUDIO2) • HDMI Output HDMI OUT x 2 (HDMI OUT1~2) • Video ❑ TUNER • Analog Tuner [Europe model] FM/AM with RDS x 1 (TUNER) [Other models] FM/AM x 1 (TUNER) ❑ USB • Capable of iPod, Mass Storage Class USB Memory, MTP (Media Transfer Protocol) • Current Supply Capacity: 1 A Composite x 5 (AV1~4, V-AUX) ❑ Remote jacks S-video x 5 (AV1~4, V-AUX) • REMOTE IN x 1 ❑ Network Component x 4 (AV1~4) • REMOTE OUT x 1 • PC Client Function • HDMI Input • TRIGGER OUT x 2 HDMI (Front Panel) x 1 (V-AUX) • RS-232C x 1 HDMI (Rear Panel) x 7 (AV1~7) ❑ HDMI • HDMI Specification: Deep Color, “x.v.Color,” Auto Lip Sync, • Other DOCK x 1 (Audio, Composite Video, S-video) USB x 1 (USB2.0) NETWORK x 1 (100Base-TX/10Base-T) ❑ Output jacks • Analog Audio Speaker out x 9 (7 ch) (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R, EXTRA SP L/R*1) *1 Note: assignment is possible. [ZONE2, F.PRESENCE, BI-AMP (FRONT L/R)] Pre Out x 7 (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R) HDMI Control (CEC), ARC (Audio Return Channel), 3D • Video Format (Repeater Mode) - VGA - 480i/60 Hz - 576i/50 Hz - 480p/60 Hz - 576p/50 Hz ❑ Compatible Decoding Formats • Decoding Format - Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus - DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD High Resolution, DTS Express - Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital EX - DTS, DTS 96/24, DTS-ES Matrix 6.1, DTS-ES Discrete 6.1 • Post Decoding Format - Dolby Pro Logic - 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz - Dolby Pro Logic II Music, Dolby Pro Logic II Movie, - 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 24 Hz • Audio Format - Dolby Digital Audio x 1 (AV OUT) - DTS ZONE OUT x 1 - DSD 6ch Optical x 1 (AV OUT) • Internet Radio - 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz Subwoofer Out x 2 (SUBWOOFER 1~2, mono) • Digital Audio • Compatible with Windows 7, DLNA ver. 1.5 Dolby Pro Logic II Game - Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music, Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie, Dolby Pro Logic IIx Game - DTS Neo:6 Music, DTS Neo:6 Cinema - Dolby Digital Plus - Dolby TrueHD - DTS-HD - PCM 2ch-8ch (Max 192 kHz/24 bit) • Content Protection: HDCP compatible En 135 ❑ Audio Section • Rated Output Power (20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.06% THD, 8Ω) Front L/R .............................................................110 W+110 W Center ............................................................................. 110 W Surround L/R.......................................................110 W+110 W • Frequency Response AUDIO2 etc. to Front (Pure Direct, 10 kHz to 100 kHz) ....................................................................................+0/-3 dB • RIAA Equalization Deviation PHONO (20 Hz to 20 kHz) ......................................... 0±0.5 dB • Total Harmonic Distortion Surround Back L/R .............................................110 W+110 W PHONO to AV OUT.............................................. 0.02% or less (1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8Ω) MULTI CH INPUT to SP OUT (Pure Direct, 70W, 8Ω) Front L/R .......................................... 135 W/ch (120 W+120 W) ............................................................................ 0.04% or less Center ...........................................................135 W/ch (120 W) Surround L/R.................................... 135 W/ch (120 W+120 W) Surround Back L/R .......................... 135 W/ch (120 W+120 W) (1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 4Ω) [Europe model] Front L/R .................................................................... 170 W/ch • Maximum Effective Output Power (JEITA, 1 kHz, 10% THD, 8 Ω) [China model] Front L/R .................................................................... 165 W/ch Center ........................................................................ 165 W/ch Surround L/R.............................................................. 165 W/ch Surround Back L/R .................................................... 165 W/ch • Dynamic Power (IHF) Front L/R (8/6/4/2 Ω) .................................. 135/165/210/280 W • Damping Factor Front L/R, 1 kHz, 8 Ω ............................................. 150 or more • Input Sensitivity / Input Impedance PHONO (1 kHz, 100 W/8 Ω) ................................3.5 mV/47 kΩ AUDIO2 etc. (1 kHz, 100 W/8 Ω)........................200 mV/47 kΩ • Maximum Input Signal PHONO (1 kHz, 0.5% THD)............................... 60 mV or more AUDIO2 etc. (1 kHz, 0.5% THD) ......................... 2.4 V or more • Output Level / Output Impedance AV OUT ..............................................................200 mV/1.2 kΩ HEADPHONE OUT .............................................150 mV/100 Ω PRE OUT SUBWOOFER (50 Hz) ...........................................1.0 V/1.2 kΩ • Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network) PHONO to AV OUT (Input shorted 5 mV) [Canada and China models].............................. 86 dB or more [Other models] ................................................... 81 dB or more AUDIO2 etc. to SP OUT (Pure Direct, Input shorted 250 mV) ......................................................................... 100 dB or more • Residual Noise (IHF-A Network) Front L/R (SP OUT)............................................. 150 µV or less • Channel Separation PHONO (Input Shorted, 1 kHz/10 kHz)... 60 dB/55 dB or more AUDIO2 etc. (Input 5.1 kΩ Shorted, 1 kHz/10 kHz) ..... 60 dB/45 dB or more • Volume Control Main Zone ................. MUTE, -80 dB to +16.5dB (0.5 dB step) Zone2 ........................ MUTE, -80 dB to +16.5dB (0.5 dB step) • Tone Control Characteristics (Front L/R) Main Zone Bass Boost/Cut......................... ±6.0 dB/50 Hz (0.5 dB step) Bass Turnover............................................................. 350 Hz Treble Boost/Cut ......................±6.0 dB/20 kHz (0.5 dB step) Treble Turnover...........................................................3.5 kHz Zone2 Bass Boost/Cut............................. ±10 dB/50 Hz (2 dB step) Bass Turnover............................................................. 350 Hz Treble Boost/Cut ........................... ±10 dB/50 Hz (2 dB step) Treble Turnover...........................................................3.5 kHz ❑ Video Section • Video Signal Type [Canada model] ...............................................................NTSC [Other models] ....................................................................PAL • Video Signal Type (Video Conversion)..................... NTSC/PAL • Video Signal Level Composite..............................................................1 Vp-p/75 Ω S-Video Y ..........................................................................1 Vp-p/75 Ω C (NTSC) [Canada model]...........................0.286 Vp-p/75 Ω C (PAL) [Other models]....................................0.3 Vp-p/75 Ω Component Y ..........................................................................1 Vp-p/75 Ω Pb/Pr ................................................................0.7 Vp-p/75 Ω • Video Maximum Input Level (Video Conversion Off) ....................................................................... 1.5 Vp-p or more • Signal to Noise Ratio (Video Conversion Off) .... 60 dB or more • Monitor Out Frequency Response (Video Conversion Off) Component (MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT) ........................................................... 5 Hz to 100 MHz, ±3 dB ❑ FM Section • Tuning Range [Canada model] .................................. 87.5 MHz to 107.9 MHz [Other models] ................................ 87.50 MHz to 108.00 MHz • 50 dB Quiet Sensitivity (IHF, 1 kHz, 100% MOD.) Mono ................................................................. 3 µV (20.8 dBf) • Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF) Mono/Stereo.......................................................... 72 dB/70 dB • Harmonic Distortion (IHF, 1 kHz) Mono/Stereo.............................................................0.3%/0.5% • Antenna Input................................................ 75 Ω unbalanced • Filter Characteristics Except SUBWOOFER (1 kHz) ...............................1.0 V/1.2 kΩ (fc=40/60/80/90/100/110/120/160/200 Hz) ZONE OUT.............................................................1.0 V/1.2 kΩ H.P.F. (Front, Center, Surround, Surround Back: Small) ................................................................................. 12 dB/oct. L.P.F. (Subwoofer)..................................................... 24 dB/oct. En 136 ❑ AM section • Tuning Range [Canada model]....................................... 530 kHz to 1710 kHz [Other models]......................................... 531 kHz to 1611 kHz ❑ General • Power Supply [Canada model]............................................. AC 120 V, 60 Hz [China model] ................................................. AC 220 V, 50 Hz [Australia model] ............................................ AC 240 V, 50 Hz [Europe model]............................................... AC 230 V, 50 Hz • Power Consumption [Canada model].................................................. 400 W/510 VA [Other models]................................................................ 490 W • Standby Power Consumption HDMI Control Off / Standby Through Off..............0.3 W or less HDMI Control On/Standby Through On (Typical) ............ 2.0 W Network Standby On (Typical)......................................... 2.5 W • Dimensions (W x H x D)............................ 435 x 182 x 430 mm (17-1/8” x 7-1/8” x 16-7/8”) • Weight........................................................... 15.1 kg (33.3 lbs) * Specifications are subject to change without notice. En 137 © 2011 Yamaha Corporation YD504A0/OMEN
  • Page 1 1
  • Page 2 2
  • Page 3 3
  • Page 4 4
  • Page 5 5
  • Page 6 6
  • Page 7 7
  • Page 8 8
  • Page 9 9
  • Page 10 10
  • Page 11 11
  • Page 12 12
  • Page 13 13
  • Page 14 14
  • Page 15 15
  • Page 16 16
  • Page 17 17
  • Page 18 18
  • Page 19 19
  • Page 20 20
  • Page 21 21
  • Page 22 22
  • Page 23 23
  • Page 24 24
  • Page 25 25
  • Page 26 26
  • Page 27 27
  • Page 28 28
  • Page 29 29
  • Page 30 30
  • Page 31 31
  • Page 32 32
  • Page 33 33
  • Page 34 34
  • Page 35 35
  • Page 36 36
  • Page 37 37
  • Page 38 38
  • Page 39 39
  • Page 40 40
  • Page 41 41
  • Page 42 42
  • Page 43 43
  • Page 44 44
  • Page 45 45
  • Page 46 46
  • Page 47 47
  • Page 48 48
  • Page 49 49
  • Page 50 50
  • Page 51 51
  • Page 52 52
  • Page 53 53
  • Page 54 54
  • Page 55 55
  • Page 56 56
  • Page 57 57
  • Page 58 58
  • Page 59 59
  • Page 60 60
  • Page 61 61
  • Page 62 62
  • Page 63 63
  • Page 64 64
  • Page 65 65
  • Page 66 66
  • Page 67 67
  • Page 68 68
  • Page 69 69
  • Page 70 70
  • Page 71 71
  • Page 72 72
  • Page 73 73
  • Page 74 74
  • Page 75 75
  • Page 76 76
  • Page 77 77
  • Page 78 78
  • Page 79 79
  • Page 80 80
  • Page 81 81
  • Page 82 82
  • Page 83 83
  • Page 84 84
  • Page 85 85
  • Page 86 86
  • Page 87 87
  • Page 88 88
  • Page 89 89
  • Page 90 90
  • Page 91 91
  • Page 92 92
  • Page 93 93
  • Page 94 94
  • Page 95 95
  • Page 96 96
  • Page 97 97
  • Page 98 98
  • Page 99 99
  • Page 100 100
  • Page 101 101
  • Page 102 102
  • Page 103 103
  • Page 104 104
  • Page 105 105
  • Page 106 106
  • Page 107 107
  • Page 108 108
  • Page 109 109
  • Page 110 110
  • Page 111 111
  • Page 112 112
  • Page 113 113
  • Page 114 114
  • Page 115 115
  • Page 116 116
  • Page 117 117
  • Page 118 118
  • Page 119 119
  • Page 120 120
  • Page 121 121
  • Page 122 122
  • Page 123 123
  • Page 124 124
  • Page 125 125
  • Page 126 126
  • Page 127 127
  • Page 128 128
  • Page 129 129
  • Page 130 130
  • Page 131 131
  • Page 132 132
  • Page 133 133
  • Page 134 134
  • Page 135 135
  • Page 136 136
  • Page 137 137
  • Page 138 138

Yamaha RX-V1071 de handleiding

Categorie
AV-ontvangers
Type
de handleiding